UNITED STATES
SECURITIES
AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
FORM 8-K
CURRENT REPORT
Pursuant
to Section 13 or 15(d)
of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
Date of Report (Date of Earliest Event Reported): April 14, 2015
Dendreon Corporation
(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)
|
|
|
|
|
Delaware |
|
001-35546 |
|
22-3203193 |
(State or Other Jurisdiction
of Incorporation) |
|
(Commission
File Number) |
|
(IRS Employer
Identification No.) |
|
|
|
|
|
601 Union Street, Suite 4900,
Seattle, Washington |
|
98101 |
(Address of Principal Executive Offices) |
|
(Zip Code) |
Registrants telephone number, including area code: (206) 256-4545
Not applicable.
(Former
Name or Former Address, if Changed Since Last Report)
Check the appropriate box below if the Form 8-K filing is intended to simultaneously satisfy the filing obligation of the registrant under any of the
following provisions (see General Instruction A.2. below):
|
¨ |
Written communications pursuant to Rule 425 under the Securities Act (17 CFR 230.425) |
|
¨ |
Soliciting material pursuant to Rule 14a-12 under the Exchange Act (17 CFR 240.14a-12) |
|
¨ |
Pre-commencement communications pursuant to Rule 14d-2(b) under the Exchange Act (17 CFR 240.14d-2(b)) |
|
¨ |
Pre-commencement communications pursuant to Rule 13e-4(c) under the Exchange Act (17 CFR 240.13e-4(c)) |
Item 7.01. Regulation FD Disclosure.
As previously announced, on November 10, 2014, Dendreon Corporation (the Company) and its wholly owned subsidiaries, Dendreon
Holdings, LLC, Dendreon Distribution, LLC and Dendreon Manufacturing, LLC (collectively, together with the Company, the Debtors) filed voluntary petitions for relief (the Chapter 11 Cases) under Chapter 11 of Title 11 of
the United States Code (the Bankruptcy Code) in the United States Bankruptcy Court for the District of Delaware (the Bankruptcy Court).
On November 9, 2014, as previously disclosed, the Debtors and (i) certain holders representing approximately 47.8% and
(ii) certain other holders representing approximately 35.9% (collectively, the Supporting Noteholders) of the outstanding principal amount of the Companys 2.875% Convertible Senior Notes due 2016 (the 2016 Notes)
entered into two separate Plan Support Agreements, which were amended and restated on December 15, 2015 (the PSAs). Under the terms of the PSAs, the parties agreed to work to effectuate a restructuring of the Debtors
obligations pursuant to a stand-alone plan of reorganization in Chapter 11 under which holders of the 2016 Notes would receive new shares of common stock in the reorganized Company, subject to the outcome of the competitive process contemplated in
the PSAs. On February 19, 2015, the Debtors, Valeant Pharmaceuticals International, Inc. (Valeant) and Drone Acquisition Sub Inc., a wholly-owned direct subsidiary of Valeant (the Purchaser), entered into a second
amended and restated acquisition agreement pursuant to which the Purchaser agreed to acquire substantially all of the assets (including $80 million in cash of the Debtors) and certain liabilities of the Debtors (the Sale Transaction) for
an aggregate purchase price of $495 million. On February 23, 2015, the Company completed the Sale Transaction.
On March 10,
2015, as previously disclosed, the Debtors filed with the Bankruptcy Court (1) a proposed plan of liquidation for the resolution of the outstanding claims against and interests in the Debtors pursuant to section 1121(a) of the Bankruptcy Code
and (2) a related proposed disclosure statement.
On April 14, 2015, the Bankruptcy Court entered an order (the
Order) approving a modified version of the previously filed disclosure statement (the Disclosure Statement), a copy of which is attached hereto as Exhibit 99.1. A modified version of the previously filed proposed plan of
liquidation (as may be amended, modified or supplemented from time to time, the Proposed Plan), a copy of which is attached hereto as Exhibit 99.2, was filed with the Bankruptcy Court as an exhibit to the Disclosure Statement. The Order,
a copy of which is attached hereto as Exhibit 99.3, also authorized the offer and sale of Valeant shares exempt from registration under securities laws pursuant to Section 1145 of the Bankruptcy Code and pursuant to the safe harbor contained in
Section 1125(e) of the Bankruptcy Code, scheduled the hearing on the confirmation of the Proposed Plan to occur on June 2, 2015, established deadlines and procedures for filing objections to confirmation of the Proposed Plan, established
deadlines and procedures for voting on the Proposed Plan, approved solicitation procedures with respect to the Proposed Plan, established procedures for tabulation of votes with respect to the Proposed Plan and granted related relief.
Information contained in the Proposed Plan is subject to change, whether as a result of amendments to the Proposed Plan, third-party actions,
or otherwise. The Proposed Plan is subject to acceptance by certain of the Debtors creditors (as and to the extent required under the Bankruptcy Code) and confirmation by the Bankruptcy Court. The Supporting Noteholders have agreed to
support the Proposed Plan, subject to the terms and conditions of their respective PSAs, however, there can be no assurances that other creditors of the Debtors will accept the Proposed Plan, or that the Bankruptcy Court will confirm the Proposed
Plan. This Current Report on Form 8-K is not intended to be, nor should it be construed as, a solicitation for a vote on the Proposed Plan.
Cautionary Statements Regarding the Chapter 11 Cases
The Companys securityholders are cautioned that trading in the Companys securities during the pendency of the Chapter 11 Cases
will be highly speculative and will pose substantial risks. Trading prices for the Companys securities may bear little or no relationship to the actual recovery, if any, by holders thereof in the Companys Chapter 11 Cases. Accordingly,
the Company urges extreme caution with respect to existing and future investments in its securities. The Bankruptcy Court has entered an order that places limitations on trading in the Companys common stock, including options and certain other
rights to acquire common stock, and certain instruments convertible into common stock, during the pendency of the bankruptcy proceedings.
The Proposed Plan contemplates that the holders of the Companys capital stock will receive
no distribution on account of their interests and cancellation of their existing stock. If certain requirements of the Bankruptcy Code are met, a Chapter 11 plan can be confirmed notwithstanding its rejection by the Companys equity
securityholders and notwithstanding the fact that such equity securityholders do not receive or retain any property on account of their equity interests under the plan.
Cautionary Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Statements
Certain information in this Current Report on Form 8-K and the exhibits attached hereto (collectively, this Current Report) may
constitute forward-looking statements within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. All statements contained in this Current Report that are not statements of historical fact, including estimates, projections, future
trends and the outcome of events that have not yet occurred referenced in this Current Report should be considered forward-looking statements. Words such as anticipate, estimate, expect, project,
intend, plan, believe, may, predict, will, would, could, should, target and similar expressions are often used to identify
forward-looking statements. Actual results or events could differ materially from those indicated in forward-looking statements as a result of risks and uncertainties, including, among others, the potential adverse impact of the Chapter 11 Cases on
the Companys liquidity or results of operations, changes in the Companys ability to meet financial obligations during the Chapter 11 process or to maintain contracts that are critical to the Companys wind-down of its affairs, the
outcome or timing of the Chapter 11 process, the effect of the Chapter 11 Cases or the Sale Transaction on the Companys relationships with third parties, regulatory authorities and employees in connection with the Companys wind-down of
its affairs, proceedings that may be brought by third parties in connection with the Chapter 11 process, the ability of the Company to fund the wind-down of its affairs and the timing or amount of any distributions to the Companys
stakeholders. For a discussion of some of the additional risks and important factors that the Company believes could cause actual results or events to differ from the forward-looking statements that it makes, see the sections entitled Risk
Factors and Managements Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations in the Companys Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2014. In addition, new risks and
uncertainties emerge from time to time, and it is not possible for the Company to predict or assess the impact of every factor that may cause its actual results or events to differ from those contained in any forward-looking statements. Accordingly,
you should not place undue reliance on any forward-looking statements contained in this Current Report. Any forward-looking statements speak only as of the date of this Current Report. The Company undertakes no obligation to publicly update
forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise.
Limitation on Incorporation by Reference
In accordance with General Instruction B.2 of Form 8-K, the information in Item 7.01 (including Exhibits 99.1, 99.2 and
99.3) of this Current Report is being furnished for informational purposes only and shall not be deemed filed for purposes of Section 18 of the Exchange Act, or otherwise subject to the liabilities of that section, nor shall such
information be deemed incorporated by reference in any filing under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, except as otherwise expressly stated in such filing. The filing of this Current Report will not be deemed an admission as to the materiality
of any information required to be disclosed solely by Regulation FD.
Additional Information Regarding the Chapter 11 Cases
Information about the Chapter 11 process, as well as court filings and other documents related to the reorganization proceedings, is available
through the Companys claims agent, Prime Clerk, at https://cases.primeclerk.com/dendreon or 844-794-3479. Information contained on, or that can be accessed through, such web site or the Bankruptcy Courts web site is not part of this
Current Report.
2
Item 9.01. Financial Statements and Exhibits.
(d) Exhibits:
|
|
|
99.1 |
|
Disclosure Statement with Respect to Proposed Plan of Liquidation of Dendreon Corporation, et al., dated April 16, 2015 |
99.2 |
|
Proposed Plan of Liquidation of Dendreon Corporation, et al., dated April 16, 2015 |
99.3 |
|
Order entered by the Bankruptcy Court on April 14, 2015 |
3
SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned
hereunto duly authorized.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
DENDREON CORPORATION |
|
|
|
|
Date: April 17, 2015 |
|
|
|
By: |
|
/s/ Robert L. Crotty |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Name: |
|
Robert L. Crotty |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Title: |
|
President, General Counsel and Secretary |
INDEX TO EXHIBITS
|
|
|
Exhibit No. |
|
Description |
|
|
99.1 |
|
Disclosure Statement with Respect to Proposed Plan of Liquidation of Dendreon Corporation, dated April 16, 2015 |
99.2 |
|
Proposed Plan of Liquidation of Dendreon Corporation, et al., dated April 16, 2015 |
99.3 |
|
Order entered by the Bankruptcy Court on April 14, 2015 |
Exhibit 99.1
Solicitation Version
IN THE UNITED STATES BANKRUPTCY COURT
FOR THE DISTRICT OF DELAWARE
|
|
|
|
|
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - |
|
x |
|
|
In re:
DENDREON CORPORATION, et al.,
Debtors.1 |
|
:
: :
: :
: :
: |
|
Chapter 11
Case No. 14-12515 (LSS)
Jointly Administered |
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - |
|
x |
|
|
DISCLOSURE STATEMENT WITH RESPECT TO
FIRST AMENDED PLAN OF LIQUIDATION PURSUANT TO CHAPTER 11
OF THE BANKRUPTCY CODE PROPOSED BY THE DEBTORS
|
|
|
|
|
SKADDEN, ARPS, SLATE, MEAGHER & FLOM LLP |
|
|
|
Anthony W. Clark (I.D. No. 2051)
Sarah E. Pierce (I.D. No. 4648)
One Rodney Square
P.O. Box 636
Wilmington, DE 19899
Telephone: (302) 651-3000
Fax: (302) 651-3001 |
|
Kenneth S. Ziman Raquelle L. Kaye
Four Times Square New York, NY 10036
Telephone: (212) 735-3000 Fax: (212) 735-2000 |
|
Felicia Gerber Perlman Candice Korkis
155 N. Wacker Dr. Chicago, IL 60606
Telephone: (312) 407-0700 Fax: (312) 407-0411 |
Counsel for Debtors and Debtors in Possession
Dated: Wilmington, DE
April 16, 2015
1 |
The Debtors and the last four digits of their respective taxpayer identification numbers are as follows: Dendreon Corporation (3193), Dendreon Holdings, LLC (8047), Dendreon Distribution, LLC (8598) and Dendreon
Manufacturing, LLC (7123). The address of the Debtors corporate headquarters is 601 Union Street, Suite 4900, Seattle, Washington 98101. |
DISCLAIMER2
THE INFORMATION SET FORTH IN THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT IS INCLUDED FOR PURPOSES OF SOLICITING ACCEPTANCES OF THE PLAN OF LIQUIDATION PURSUANT
TO CHAPTER 11 OF THE BANKRUPTCY CODE PROPOSED BY THE DEBTORS AND MAY NOT BE RELIED UPON FOR ANY PURPOSE OTHER THAN TO DETERMINE HOW TO VOTE ON THE PLAN. NO PERSON MAY PROVIDE ANY INFORMATION OR MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS, OTHER THAN THE INFORMATION
AND REPRESENTATIONS CONTAINED IN THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT, REGARDING THE PLAN OR THE SOLICITATION OF ACCEPTANCES OF THE PLAN.
ALL
HOLDERS OF CLAIMS AND INTERESTS ARE ADVISED AND ENCOURAGED TO READ THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT AND THE PLAN IN THEIR ENTIRETIES BEFORE VOTING TO ACCEPT OR REJECT THE PLAN. PLAN SUMMARIES AND STATEMENTS MADE IN THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT WITH RESPECT TO
THE PLAN ARE QUALIFIED IN THEIR ENTIRETIES BY REFERENCE TO THE PLAN, THE EXHIBITS ATTACHED TO THE PLAN AND ANY PLAN SUPPLEMENT(S). THE STATEMENTS CONTAINED IN THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT ARE MADE ONLY AS OF THE DATE HEREOF AND THERE CAN BE NO
ASSURANCE THAT THE STATEMENTS CONTAINED HEREIN WILL BE CORRECT ANY TIME AFTER THE DATE HEREOF.
THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT HAS BEEN
PREPARED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 1125 OF THE BANKRUPTCY CODE AND RULE 3016(b) OF THE FEDERAL RULES OF BANKRUPTCY PROCEDURE AND NOT IN ACCORDANCE WITH FEDERAL OR STATE SECURITIES LAWS OR OTHER NON-APPLICABLE BANKRUPTCY LAWS. THIS DISCLOSURE
STATEMENT HAS NEITHER BEEN APPROVED NOR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION (THE SEC), AND THE SEC HAS NOT PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THE STATEMENTS CONTAINED HEREIN. PERSONS OR ENTITIES TRADING IN
OR OTHERWISE PURCHASING, SELLING OR TRANSFERRING SECURITIES OR CLAIMS OF THE DEBTORS SHOULD EVALUATE THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT AND THE PLAN IN LIGHT OF THE PURPOSES FOR WHICH THEY WERE PREPARED.
AS TO CONTESTED MATTERS, ADVERSARY PROCEEDINGS AND OTHER ACTIONS OR THREATENED ACTIONS, THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT WILL NOT CONSTITUTE OR BE
CONSTRUED AS AN ADMISSION OF ANY FACT OR LIABILITY, STIPULATION OR WAIVER, BUT RATHER AS A STATEMENT MADE IN SETTLEMENT NEGOTIATIONS. THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT WILL NOT BE ADMISSIBLE IN ANY NON-BANKRUPTCY PROCEEDING NOR WILL IT BE CONSTRUED TO
CONSTITUTE ADVICE ON THE TAX, SECURITIES OR OTHER
2 |
Terms used in this Disclaimer that are not otherwise defined will have the meanings ascribed to such terms elsewhere in the Disclosure Statement.
|
LEGAL EFFECTS OF THE PLAN AS IT RELATES TO HOLDERS OF CLAIMS AGAINST, OR INTERESTS IN, THE DEBTORS.
THE INFORMATION CONTAINED IN THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT REGARDING VALEANT PHARMACEUTICALS INTERNATIONAL, INC. (VALEANT) HAS
BEEN PROVIDED BY VALEANT SPECIFICALLY FOR INCLUSION IN THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT. THE DEBTORS PROVIDE NO ASSURANCES AS TO THE ACCURACY OF THIS INFORMATION.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE I |
|
|
INTRODUCTION |
|
|
|
|
A. |
|
Purpose of the Disclosure Statement |
|
|
1 |
|
B. |
|
Disclosure Statement Enclosures |
|
|
2 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Order Approving the Disclosure Statement |
|
|
2 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Ballot |
|
|
2 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Notice |
|
|
2 |
|
C. |
|
Confirmation of the Plan |
|
|
2 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Requirements |
|
|
2 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Approval of the Plan and Confirmation Hearing |
|
|
2 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Only Impaired Classes Vote |
|
|
2 |
|
D. |
|
Treatment and Classification of Claims and Interests; Impairment |
|
|
3 |
|
E. |
|
Voting Procedures and Voting Deadline |
|
|
6 |
|
F. |
|
Confirmation Hearing |
|
|
7 |
|
|
|
ARTICLE II |
|
|
|
|
|
|
GENERAL INFORMATION REGARDING THE DEBTORS |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A. |
|
Overview |
|
|
7 |
|
B. |
|
The Debtors Formation |
|
|
8 |
|
C. |
|
The Debtors Business and Employees |
|
|
8 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
PROVENGE® |
|
|
8 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
The Debtors Corporate Headquarters |
|
|
9 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
The Debtors Employees |
|
|
9 |
|
D. |
|
The Debtors Corporate and Capital Structure |
|
|
9 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
The 2016 Notes |
|
|
10 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Dendreon Common Stock |
|
|
10 |
|
E. |
|
Summary of Events Leading to the Chapter 11 Filings |
|
|
11 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Challenges Faced by the Debtors and Restructuring Efforts |
|
|
11 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Consideration of Strategic Alternatives and Discussions with Creditors |
|
|
12 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
The Pre-filing Marketing Process |
|
|
13 |
|
|
|
4. |
|
The Plan Support Agreements and the Competitive Process |
|
|
14 |
|
F. |
|
Summary of Material Pre-Petition Legal Proceedings |
|
|
15 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
GSK Litigation |
|
|
15 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Bolling Securities Action and Related Actions and Investigations |
|
|
16 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Bolling Securities Action |
|
|
16 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
Stockholder Derivative Complaints |
|
|
17 |
|
|
|
|
|
c. |
|
SEC Investigation |
|
|
18 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Quintal Stockholder Derivative Complaint |
|
|
18 |
|
i
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE III |
|
|
THE CHAPTER 11 CASES |
|
|
|
|
A. |
|
Commencement of the Chapter 11 Cases |
|
|
18 |
|
B. |
|
First Day Motions and Related Applications |
|
|
19 |
|
C. |
|
Retention of Professionals and Appointment of the Committee |
|
|
20 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Retention of Debtors Professionals |
|
|
20 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Retention of Claims and Noticing Agent and Administrative Agent |
|
|
20 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Appointment of Committee and Retention of Committee Professionals |
|
|
20 |
|
D. |
|
Significant Events During the Chapter 11 Cases |
|
|
21 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Approval of Plan Support Agreements |
|
|
21 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Approval of Key Employee Incentive Program |
|
|
21 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Derivative Litigation Settlement |
|
|
22 |
|
|
|
4. |
|
Sale to Valeant |
|
|
23 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
A Brief Summary of the Sale Process |
|
|
23 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
The Sale Motion and Bidding Procedures Order |
|
|
23 |
|
|
|
|
|
c. |
|
Selection of a Stalking Horse Bidder |
|
|
24 |
|
|
|
|
|
d. |
|
The Subsequent Bidding and Selection of a Successful Bidder |
|
|
25 |
|
|
|
|
|
e. |
|
The Second Amended Acquisition Agreement, the Sale Hearing and Closing |
|
|
26 |
|
|
|
5. |
|
The Claims Process |
|
|
27 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Schedules |
|
|
27 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
Bar Date Order |
|
|
27 |
|
|
|
|
|
c. |
|
Claims Objections |
|
|
27 |
|
|
|
|
|
d. |
|
Deerfield Substantial Contribution Claim |
|
|
28 |
|
|
|
|
|
e. |
|
Committee Members Substantial Contribution Claim |
|
|
28 |
|
|
|
6. |
|
Extension of Time to Remove Actions |
|
|
28 |
|
|
|
7. |
|
Motion to Extend Exclusivity |
|
|
29 |
|
|
ARTICLE IV |
|
|
SUMMARY OF PLAN |
|
|
|
|
A. |
|
Classification and Treatment of Claims and Interests |
|
|
30 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Unclassified Claims |
|
|
31 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Administrative Claims |
|
|
31 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
Priority Tax Claims |
|
|
32 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Unimpaired Claims |
|
|
32 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Class 1: Priority Non-Tax Claims |
|
|
32 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
Class 2: Secured Claims |
|
|
32 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Impaired Claims |
|
|
33 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Class 3: 2016 Noteholder Claims |
|
|
33 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
Class 4: General Unsecured Claims |
|
|
33 |
|
|
|
|
|
c. |
|
Class 5: Intercompany Claims |
|
|
34 |
|
|
|
|
|
d. |
|
Class 6: Subordinated Claims |
|
|
34 |
|
|
|
4. |
|
Impaired Interests |
|
|
34 |
|
ii
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Class 7: Interests |
|
|
34 |
|
|
|
5. |
|
Unimpaired Interests |
|
|
35 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Class 8: Intercompany Interests |
|
|
35 |
|
|
|
6. |
|
Special Provision Regarding Unimpaired Claims |
|
|
35 |
|
|
|
7. |
|
Allowed Claims |
|
|
35 |
|
|
|
8. |
|
Special Provisions Regarding Insured Claims |
|
|
35 |
|
B. |
|
Means for Implementation of the Plan |
|
|
36 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Substantive Consolidation |
|
|
36 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Consolidation of the Chapter 11 Estates |
|
|
36 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
Substantive Consolidation Order |
|
|
36 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Corporate Action |
|
|
37 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Merger and Dissolution of Debtors |
|
|
37 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
Certificate of Incorporation and By-laws |
|
|
38 |
|
|
|
|
|
c. |
|
Cancellation of Existing Securities and Agreements |
|
|
39 |
|
|
|
|
|
d. |
|
No Further Action |
|
|
39 |
|
|
|
|
|
e. |
|
Effectuating Documents |
|
|
40 |
|
|
|
|
|
f. |
|
Directors and Officers; Further Transactions |
|
|
40 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Compliance with the Asset Purchase Agreement |
|
|
40 |
|
|
|
4. |
|
Privilege Matters |
|
|
40 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Legal Representation of the Debtors and Committee After the Effective Date |
|
|
40 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
Transfer of Evidentiary Privileges; Document Requests |
|
|
40 |
|
|
|
5. |
|
Dissolution of the Committee |
|
|
41 |
|
|
|
6. |
|
The Plan Administrator |
|
|
41 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Appointment of the Plan Administrator |
|
|
41 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
The Plan Administrator Agreement |
|
|
42 |
|
|
|
|
|
c. |
|
Rights, Powers and Duties of the Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator |
|
|
42 |
|
|
|
|
|
d. |
|
Compensation of the Plan Administrator |
|
|
42 |
|
|
|
|
|
e. |
|
Indemnification |
|
|
42 |
|
|
|
|
|
f. |
|
Insurance |
|
|
43 |
|
|
|
|
|
g. |
|
Revesting of Assets. |
|
|
43 |
|
|
|
7. |
|
Distributions to Holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims and General Unsecured Claims |
|
|
43 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Initial Distributions |
|
|
43 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
Interim Distributions |
|
|
43 |
|
|
|
|
|
c. |
|
Final Distributions |
|
|
44 |
|
|
|
8. |
|
Limited Release of Liens |
|
|
44 |
|
|
|
9. |
|
Accounts and Reserves |
|
|
44 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Professional Fee Reserve |
|
|
44 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve |
|
|
45 |
|
|
|
|
|
c. |
|
Disputed Claims Reserve |
|
|
46 |
|
|
|
|
|
d. |
|
Wind-down Reserve |
|
|
46 |
|
|
|
|
|
e. |
|
Other Reserves and Modifications to Reserves |
|
|
46 |
|
|
|
10. |
|
Exemption from Certain Transfer Taxes |
|
|
46 |
|
|
|
11. |
|
Exemption from Securities Laws |
|
|
46 |
|
iii
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
12. |
|
Preservation of Causes of Action |
|
|
47 |
|
|
|
13. |
|
Effectuating Documents; Further Transactions |
|
|
48 |
|
|
|
14. |
|
2016 Notes Trustee Fee Claims |
|
|
48 |
|
|
|
15. |
|
Oversight Committee |
|
|
48 |
|
C. |
|
Provisions Governing Distributions |
|
|
49 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Distributions for Claims Allowed as of the Effective Date |
|
|
49 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Disbursing Agent |
|
|
49 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Delivery of Distributions and Undeliverable or Unclaimed Distributions |
|
|
49 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Delivery of Distributions in General |
|
|
49 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
Undeliverable and Unclaimed Distributions |
|
|
50 |
|
|
|
4. |
|
Prepayment |
|
|
51 |
|
|
|
5. |
|
Means of Cash Payment |
|
|
51 |
|
|
|
6. |
|
Interest on Claims |
|
|
51 |
|
|
|
7. |
|
Withholding and Reporting Requirements |
|
|
51 |
|
|
|
8. |
|
Setoffs |
|
|
51 |
|
|
|
9. |
|
Procedure for Treating and Resolving Disputed, Contingent and/or Unliquidated Claims |
|
|
52 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Objection Deadline; Prosecution of Objections |
|
|
52 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
No Distributions Pending Allowance |
|
|
52 |
|
|
|
|
|
c. |
|
Disputed Claims Reserve |
|
|
53 |
|
|
|
|
|
d. |
|
Distributions After Allowance or Disallowance |
|
|
53 |
|
|
|
|
|
e. |
|
De Minimis Distributions |
|
|
53 |
|
|
|
|
|
f. |
|
Fractional Dollars |
|
|
54 |
|
|
|
|
|
g. |
|
Allocation of Plan Distributions Between Principal and Interest |
|
|
54 |
|
|
|
|
|
h. |
|
Distribution Record Date |
|
|
54 |
|
D. |
|
Treatment of Executory Contracts and Unexpired Leases |
|
|
54 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Rejected Contracts and Leases |
|
|
54 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Rejection Damages Bar Date |
|
|
55 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Assumed Contracts and Leases |
|
|
55 |
|
|
|
4. |
|
Indemnification Obligations |
|
|
55 |
|
E. |
|
Conditions Precedent to Confirmation and Consummation of the Plan |
|
|
56 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Conditions to Confirmation |
|
|
56 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Conditions to Effective Date |
|
|
56 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Waiver of Conditions |
|
|
57 |
|
|
|
4. |
|
Consequences of Non-Occurrence of Effective Date |
|
|
57 |
|
F. |
|
Allowance and Payment of Certain Administrative Claims |
|
|
58 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Professional Fee Claims |
|
|
58 |
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Final Fee Applications |
|
|
58 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
Employment of Professionals after the Effective Date |
|
|
58 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Substantial Contribution Compensation and Expenses Bar Date |
|
|
58 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Other Administrative Claims |
|
|
58 |
|
G. |
|
Effects of Confirmation |
|
|
59 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Satisfaction of Claims |
|
|
59 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Binding Effect |
|
|
59 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Effects of Confirmation |
|
|
59 |
|
|
|
4. |
|
Releases |
|
|
59 |
|
iv
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
a. |
|
Releases by the Debtors |
|
|
59 |
|
|
|
|
|
b. |
|
Release by Holders of Claims |
|
|
60 |
|
|
|
5. |
|
Exculpation and Limitation of Liability |
|
|
60 |
|
|
|
6. |
|
Injunction |
|
|
61 |
|
|
|
7. |
|
Satisfaction of Subordination Rights |
|
|
61 |
|
H. |
|
Retention of Jurisdiction |
|
|
62 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Retention of Jurisdiction by the Court |
|
|
62 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Retention of Non-Exclusive Jurisdiction by the Court |
|
|
64 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Failure of Court to Exercise Jurisdiction |
|
|
64 |
|
I. |
|
Miscellaneous Provisions |
|
|
64 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Modifications and Amendments |
|
|
64 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Severability of Plan Provisions |
|
|
64 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Successors and Assigns |
|
|
65 |
|
|
|
4. |
|
Payment of Statutory Fees |
|
|
65 |
|
|
|
5. |
|
Revocation, Withdrawal or Non-Consummation |
|
|
65 |
|
|
|
6. |
|
Insurance Policies |
|
|
65 |
|
|
|
7. |
|
Service of Documents |
|
|
65 |
|
|
|
8. |
|
Plan Supplement(s) |
|
|
67 |
|
|
ARTICLE V |
|
|
ISSUANCE OF VALEANT SHARES UNDER THE PLAN |
|
|
|
|
A. |
|
Valuation of Valeant Shares |
|
|
68 |
|
B. |
|
Delivery of Valeant Shares to the Debtors |
|
|
68 |
|
C. |
|
Information Concerning Valeant |
|
|
68 |
|
|
ARTICLE VI |
|
|
VOTING REQUIREMENTS; |
|
ACCEPTANCE AND CONFIRMATION OF THE PLAN |
|
|
|
|
A. |
|
General |
|
|
69 |
|
B. |
|
Parties in Interest Entitled to Vote |
|
|
69 |
|
C. |
|
Classes Impaired and Entitled to Vote under the Plan |
|
|
69 |
|
D. |
|
Voting Procedures and Requirements |
|
|
70 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Ballots |
|
|
70 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Returning Ballots |
|
|
70 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Voting |
|
|
70 |
|
E. |
|
Acceptance of Plan |
|
|
71 |
|
F. |
|
Confirmation Without Necessary Acceptances; Cramdown |
|
|
71 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
No Unfair Discrimination |
|
|
72 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Fair and Equitable Test |
|
|
72 |
|
v
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE VII |
|
|
FEASIBILITY AND BEST INTERESTS OF CREDITORS |
|
|
|
|
A. |
|
Best Interests Test |
|
|
73 |
|
B. |
|
Liquidation Analysis |
|
|
73 |
|
C. |
|
Feasibility |
|
|
74 |
|
|
ARTICLE VIII |
|
|
EFFECT OF CONFIRMATION |
|
|
|
|
A. |
|
Binding Effect of Confirmation |
|
|
74 |
|
B. |
|
Good Faith |
|
|
74 |
|
|
ARTICLE IX |
|
|
RELEASES |
|
|
ARTICLE X |
|
|
CERTAIN RISK FACTORS TO BE CONSIDERED |
|
|
|
|
A. |
|
Plan May Not Be Accepted |
|
|
77 |
|
B. |
|
Certain Bankruptcy Law Considerations |
|
|
77 |
|
C. |
|
Distributions to Holders of Allowed Claims Under The Plan |
|
|
78 |
|
D. |
|
Classification and Treatment of Claims and Equity Interests |
|
|
78 |
|
E. |
|
Conditions Precedent to Consummation of the Plan |
|
|
79 |
|
F. |
|
Certain Tax Considerations |
|
|
79 |
|
|
ARTICLE XI |
|
|
CERTAIN FEDERAL AND SECURITIES LAW MATTERS |
|
|
|
|
A. |
|
Offer and Sale of Valeant Shares: Bankruptcy Code Exemption |
|
|
79 |
|
B. |
|
Subsequent Transfers of Valeant Shares Received under the Plan |
|
|
80 |
|
|
ARTICLE XII |
|
|
CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES OF THE PLAN |
|
|
|
|
A. |
|
Tax Consequences to Certain Creditors |
|
|
83 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims |
|
|
83 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Holders of General Unsecured Claims |
|
|
83 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Character of Gain or Loss |
|
|
84 |
|
|
|
4. |
|
Distributions with Respect to Accrued but Unpaid Interest. |
|
|
84 |
|
|
|
5. |
|
Non-United States Persons |
|
|
85 |
|
B. |
|
Tax Consequences to the Debtors |
|
|
86 |
|
vi
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
C. |
|
Tax Treatment of Liquidating Trusts |
|
|
86 |
|
|
|
1. |
|
Classification of Liquidating Trusts |
|
|
87 |
|
|
|
2. |
|
General Tax Reporting by Trusts and Beneficiaries |
|
|
87 |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Allocations of Taxable Income and Loss |
|
|
88 |
|
D. |
|
Importance of Obtaining Professional Tax Assistance |
|
|
88 |
|
|
ARTICLE XIII |
|
|
RECOMMENDATION AND CONCLUSION |
|
vii
TABLE OF ANNEXES AND EXHIBITS
|
|
|
Annex |
|
Title |
|
|
1 |
|
GlaxoSmithKline LLCs Addendum Regarding 2016 Notes |
|
|
|
Exhibit |
|
Title |
|
|
A |
|
Plan of Liquidation Pursuant to Chapter 11 of the Bankruptcy Code Proposed by the Debtors |
|
|
B |
|
Form 10-K for the Fiscal Year Ended December 31, 2014 for Valeant Pharmaceuticals International, Inc. |
|
|
C |
|
Hypothetical Liquidation Analysis |
i
ARTICLE I
INTRODUCTION
A. |
Purpose of the Disclosure Statement |
On November 10, 2014 (the Petition
Date), Dendreon Corporation, Dendreon Holdings, LLC, Dendreon Distribution, LLC and Dendreon Manufacturing, LLC (together, the Debtors) filed voluntary petitions for relief, thereby commencing cases (together, the
Chapter 11 Cases) under chapter 11 of title 11 of the United States Code, 11 U.S.C. §§ 101 - 1532 (the Bankruptcy Code), in the United States Bankruptcy Court for the District of Delaware (the
Court or Bankruptcy Court).
The Debtors have filed the Plan Of Liquidation Pursuant To Chapter 11
Of The Bankruptcy Code Proposed By The Debtors (including all exhibits and schedules attached thereto, and as may be amended, altered, modified or supplemented from time to time, the Plan) with the Court. A copy of the Plan is
attached hereto as Exhibit A.
Capitalized terms used but not otherwise defined herein have the meanings ascribed to such terms
in the Plan; provided, however, that any capitalized term used herein that is not defined herein or in the Plan, but is defined in the Bankruptcy Code or the Federal Rules of Bankruptcy Procedure (the Bankruptcy
Rules) will have the meaning ascribed to that term in the Bankruptcy Code or the Bankruptcy Rules, as applicable.
The
Debtors submit this disclosure statement (as may be amended, altered, modified, revised or supplemented from time to time, the Disclosure Statement) pursuant to section 1125 of the Bankruptcy Code to Holders of Claims against the
Debtors in connection with (i) the solicitation of acceptances of the Plan and (ii) the hearing to consider confirmation of the Plan.
The purpose of this Disclosure Statement is to describe the Plan and its provisions and to provide certain information, as required under
section 1125 of the Bankruptcy Code, to creditors who will have the right to vote on the Plan so they can make informed decisions in doing so. Creditors entitled to vote to accept or reject the Plan will receive a Ballot (as defined herein) together
with this Disclosure Statement to enable them to vote on the Plan.
This Disclosure Statement includes, among other things, information
pertaining to the Debtors prepetition business operations and financial history and the events leading to the filing of the Chapter 11 Cases. This Disclosure Statement also contains information regarding significant events that have occurred
during the Chapter 11 Cases. In addition, an overview of the Plan is included, which overview sets forth certain terms and provisions of the Plan, the effects of confirmation of the Plan, certain risk factors associated with the Plan, and the manner
in which distributions will be made under the Plan. This Disclosure Statement also discusses the confirmation process and the procedures for voting, which procedures must be followed by the Holders of Claims entitled to vote under the Plan for their
votes to be counted.
B. |
Disclosure Statement Enclosures |
Accompanying this Disclosure Statement are:
1. Order Approving the Disclosure Statement. A copy of the Courts order (the
Solicitation Procedures Order) approving this Disclosure Statement and, among other things, establishing procedures for voting on the Plan, setting the deadline for objecting to the Plan and scheduling the Confirmation Hearing (as
defined herein).
2. Ballot. A ballot (the Ballot) for voting to
accept or reject the Plan, if you are the record Holder of a Claim in a Class entitled to vote on the Plan (each, a Voting Class).
3. Notice. A notice setting forth: (i) the deadline for casting Ballots either
accepting or rejecting the Plan; (ii) the deadline for filing objections to confirmation of the Plan; and (iii) the date, time and location of the Confirmation Hearing (the Notice).
C. |
Confirmation of the Plan |
1.
Requirements. The requirements for confirmation of the Plan are set forth in section 1129 of the Bankruptcy Code. The requirements for the Disclosure Statement are set forth in section 1125 of
the Bankruptcy Code.
2. Approval of the Plan and Confirmation Hearing. To confirm
the Plan, the Court must hold a hearing to determine whether the Plan meets the requirements of section 1129 of the Bankruptcy Code.
3.
Only Impaired Classes Vote. Pursuant to the provisions of the Bankruptcy Code, only classes of claims or interests that are impaired under a plan may vote to accept or reject such
plan. Generally, a claim or interest is impaired under a plan if the holders legal, equitable or contractual rights are changed under such plan. In addition, if the holders of claims or interests in an impaired class do not receive or retain
any property under a plan on account of such claims or interests, such impaired class is deemed to have rejected such plan under section 1126(g) of the Bankruptcy Code and, therefore, such holders do not need to vote on such plan.
Under the Plan, Holders of Claims in Classes 1, 2, and 8 are Unimpaired and therefore deemed to accept the Plan.
Under the Plan, Holders of Claims in Classes 3 and 4 are Impaired and are entitled to vote on the Plan.
Under the Plan, Holders of Claims and Interests in Classes 5, 6, and 7 are deemed to reject the Plan and are not entitled to vote on the Plan.
ACCORDINGLY, A BALLOT FOR ACCEPTANCE OR REJECTION OF THE PLAN IS BEING PROVIDED ONLY TO HOLDERS OF CLAIMS IN CLASSES 3 AND 4.
2
D. |
Treatment and Classification of Claims and Interests; Impairment |
The categories of
Claims and Interests listed below classify Claims and Interests for all purposes, including voting, confirmation and distribution pursuant to the Plan and pursuant to sections 1122 and 1123(a)(1) of the Bankruptcy Code. For a summary of the
treatment of each Class of Claims and Interests, see Article IV, Summary of Plan, below.
|
|
|
|
|
Class Description |
|
Status |
|
Proposed Treatment |
Administrative Claims
Estimated Recovery: 100% |
|
Unclassified |
|
On the later of (i) the Distribution Date or (ii) the date such Administrative Claim becomes an Allowed
Administrative Claim (or as soon as reasonably practicable thereafter), a Holder of an Allowed Administrative Claim (other than a Professional) will receive, in full satisfaction, settlement and discharge of, and in exchange for, such Allowed
Administrative Claim, (a) Cash equal to the unpaid portion of the Face Amount of such Allowed Administrative Claim or (b) such other lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, will have agreed
upon in writing. |
Priority Tax Claims
Estimated Recovery: 100% |
|
Unclassified |
|
On the later of (i) the Distribution Date or (ii) the date such Priority Tax Claim becomes an Allowed Priority
Tax Claim (or as soon as reasonably practicable thereafter), a Holder of an Allowed Priority Tax Claim will receive, in full satisfaction, settlement and discharge of, and in exchange for, such Allowed Priority Tax Claim, (a) Cash equal to the
unpaid portion of the Face Amount of such Allowed Priority Tax Claim or (b) such other lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, will have agreed upon in writing. For the avoidance of doubt,
any payments made by the Plan Administrator on account of Allowed Priority Tax Claims will be paid solely from the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve. |
Class 1: Priority Non-Tax Claims
Estimated Recovery: 100% |
|
Unimpaired |
|
On the later of (i) the Distribution Date or (ii) the date such Priority Non-Tax Claim becomes an Allowed
Priority Non-Tax |
3
|
|
|
|
|
Class Description |
|
Status |
|
Proposed Treatment |
|
|
|
|
Claim (or as soon as reasonably practicable thereafter), a Holder of an Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim will
receive, in full satisfaction, settlement and discharge of, and in exchange for, such Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim, (a) Cash equal to the unpaid portion of the Face Amount of such Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim or (b) such other treatment as to
which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, will have agreed upon in writing. |
Class 2: Secured Claims
Estimated Recovery: 100% |
|
Unimpaired |
|
On the later of (i) the Distribution Date or (ii) the date such Secured Claim becomes an Allowed Secured Claim
(or as soon as reasonably practicable thereafter), a Holder of an Allowed Secured Claim will receive, in full satisfaction, settlement, and discharge of, and in exchange for, such Allowed Secured Claim, (a) Cash equal to the value of such Allowed
Secured Claim, (b) a return of the Collateral securing the Secured Claim, (c) such treatment required under section 1124(2) of the Bankruptcy Code for such Claim to be rendered Unimpaired or (d) such other lesser treatment as to which such Holder
and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, will have agreed upon in writing. |
Class 3: 2016 Noteholder Claims
Estimated Amount of Claims: $625,694,097 Estimated Recovery: 72%
to 75% |
|
Impaired |
|
On the Distribution Date, and from time to time thereafter in accordance with the Plan, each Holder of an
Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claim will receive, in full satisfaction of, and in exchange for, such Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claim, (i) its Pro Rata share of 100% of the Valeant Shares (which will be distributed immediately upon the occurrence of the
Effective Date) and (ii) its Pro Rata share of Available Cash in the amount necessary to provide such Holder its Pro Rata share of Total Distributable Value |
4
|
|
|
|
|
Class Description |
|
Status |
|
Proposed Treatment |
|
|
|
|
available to Holders of Class 3 Claims and Class 4 Claims, or (iii) such other lesser treatment as to which
such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, will have agreed upon in writing. |
Class 4: General Unsecured Claims
Estimated Amount of Claims: $4,261,000 to $32,292,000 Estimated
Recovery: 72% to 75%3 |
|
Impaired |
|
On the Distribution Date, and from time to time thereafter in accordance with the Plan, each Holder of an
Allowed General Unsecured Claim will receive, in full satisfaction of, and in exchange for, such Allowed General Unsecured Claim, (i) its Pro Rata share of Total Distributable Value available to Holders of Class 3 Claims and Class 4 Claims, solely
in the form of Available Cash or (ii) such other lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, will have agreed upon in writing. |
Class 5: Intercompany Claims
Estimated Recovery: 0% |
|
Impaired |
|
In connection with, and as a result of, the substantive consolidation of the Debtors Estates and the
Chapter 11 Cases, on the Effective Date, all Intercompany Claims will be eliminated and the Holders of Intercompany Claims will not be entitled to, and will not receive or retain, any property or interest in property on account of such
Claims. |
Class 6: Subordinated Claims
Estimated Recovery: 0% |
|
Impaired |
|
On the Effective Date, all Subordinated Claims will be eliminated and the Holders of Subordinated Claims will
not be entitled to, and will not receive or retain, any property or interest in property on account of such Claims. |
Class 7: Interests
Estimated Recovery: 0% |
|
Impaired |
|
On the Effective Date, the Interests will be deemed eliminated, cancelled and/or extinguished and each Holder
thereof will not be entitled to, and will not receive or retain, any property under the Plan |
3 |
As noted, the amount of claims provided is only an estimate. The variation in the range of the estimated amount of claims provided is largely due to the unknown value of the claim asserted by GSK. For further discussion
of the GSK claim, see Article IIF.1. |
5
|
|
|
|
|
Class Description |
|
Status |
|
Proposed Treatment |
|
|
|
|
on account of such
Interest. |
Class 8:
Intercompany Interests Estimated Recovery: 100% |
|
Unimpaired |
|
On the Effective Date, the Intercompany Interests will be reinstated and rendered Unimpaired in accordance with section 1124 of the
Bankruptcy Code. |
E. |
Voting Procedures and Voting Deadline |
If you are entitled to vote to accept or reject
the Plan, a Ballot is enclosed for the purpose of voting on the Plan. To ensure your vote is counted, you must (i) complete the Ballot, (ii) indicate your decision either to accept or reject the Plan in the boxes provided, and
(iii) sign and return the Ballot(s) in the envelope provided.
The Ballot also contains an election to opt out of the release
provisions contained in Section 10.4 of the Plan for those who vote to reject the Plan. Unless you vote to reject the Plan and indicate your decision to opt-out of the releases described in Section 10.4 of the Plan on the
Ballot, you will be deemed to consent to such releases.
TO BE COUNTED, YOUR BALLOT WITH YOUR ORIGINAL SIGNATURE INDICATING YOUR ACCEPTANCE
OR REJECTION OF THE PLAN MUST BE RECEIVED NO LATER THAN 4:00 P.M. (EASTERN TIME) ON MAY 19, 2015 (THE VOTING DEADLINE).
The following Ballots will not be counted or considered for any purpose in determining whether the Plan has been accepted or rejected:
|
(i) |
any Ballot or Master Ballot (as defined in the Solicitation Procedures Order) received after the Voting Deadline (unless extended by the Debtors); |
|
(ii) |
any Ballot or Master Ballot that is illegible or contains insufficient information to permit the identification of the claimant; |
|
(iii) |
any Ballot cast by a person or entity that does not hold a Claim in a Class that is entitled to vote to accept or reject the Plan; |
|
(iv) |
any Ballot cast for a scheduled Claim designated as contingent, unliquidated or disputed or as zero or unknown in amount and for which no Rule 3018(a) Motion has been filed by the Rule 3018(a) Motion Deadline (as such
terms are defined in the Solicitation Procedures Order); |
|
(v) |
any Ballot that indicates neither an acceptance nor a rejection, or indicates both an acceptance and a rejection, of the Plan; |
|
(vi) |
any Ballot (other than a Master Ballot) that casts part of its vote in the same Class to accept the Plan and part to reject the Plan; |
|
(vii) |
any form of Ballot or Master Ballot other than the official form sent by Prime Clerk LLC (Prime Clerk or the Voting Agent), or a copy thereof; |
6
|
(viii) |
any Ballot received that the Voting Agent cannot match to an existing database record; |
|
(ix) |
any Ballot or Master Ballot that does not contain an original signature; or |
|
(x) |
any Ballot or Master Ballot that is submitted by facsimile, email or by other electronic means. |
In order for the Plan to be accepted by an Impaired Class of Claims, a majority in number and two-thirds in dollar amount of the Claims voting
in such Class must vote to accept the Plan. At least one Voting Class, excluding the votes of insiders, must actually vote to accept the Plan.
YOU ARE URGED TO COMPLETE, DATE, SIGN AND PROMPTLY MAIL THE BALLOT ENCLOSED WITH THE NOTICE. PLEASE BE SURE TO COMPLETE THE BALLOT PROPERLY
AND LEGIBLY, AND IDENTIFY THE EXACT AMOUNT OF YOUR CLAIM AND THE NAME OF THE CREDITOR. IF YOU ARE A HOLDER OF A CLAIM ENTITLED TO VOTE ON THE PLAN AND YOU DID NOT RECEIVE A BALLOT, YOU RECEIVED A DAMAGED BALLOT OR YOU LOST YOUR BALLOT, OR IF YOU
HAVE ANY QUESTIONS CONCERNING THE DISCLOSURE STATEMENT, THE PLAN OR PROCEDURES FOR VOTING ON THE PLAN, PLEASE CONTACT THE VOTING AGENT PRIME CLERK, AT 844-794-3479 OR AT DENDREONINFO@PRIMECLERK.COM. THE VOTING AGENT IS NOT AUTHORIZED TO AND WILL NOT
PROVIDE LEGAL ADVICE.
The Court has scheduled a hearing to consider confirmation of the
Plan for June 2, 2015 at 10:00 a.m. (Eastern Time) in the United States Bankruptcy Court for the District of Delaware, 824 North Market Street, 6th Floor, Courtroom No. 2, Wilmington, Delaware 19801 (the Confirmation
Hearing). The Court has directed that objections, if any, to confirmation of the Plan be filed and served on or before May 19, 2015 at 4:00 p.m. (Eastern Time) in the manner described in the Notice accompanying this Disclosure
Statement. The Confirmation Hearing may be adjourned from time to time by way of announcement of such continuance in open Court or otherwise, without further notice to parties in interest.
THE DEBTORS URGE ALL HOLDERS OF CLAIMS ENTITLED TO VOTE ON THE PLAN TO VOTE TO ACCEPT THE PLAN.
ARTICLE II
GENERAL
INFORMATION REGARDING THE DEBTORS
As described in further detail herein, prior to the filing of the Chapter 11
Cases, the Debtors entered into Plan Support Agreements with their Supporting Noteholders (each as defined herein). The keystone of the Plan Support Agreements was a competitive process pursuant to which the Debtors would sell all or
substantially all of their assets. This competitive
7
process resulted in the sale of substantially all of their assets to a subsidiary of Valeant. The premise of this Plan is to distribute the proceeds of that sale.
B. |
The Debtors Formation |
Dendreon was incorporated in Delaware in 1992 as Activated
Cell Therapy, Inc. and changed its corporate name to Dendreon Corporation in June 2000. Dendreon Holdings, LLC, Dendreon Distribution, LLC and Dendreon Manufacturing, LLC were each organized in Delaware in 2010.
C. |
The Debtors Business and Employees |
The Company4 was a biotechnology company focused on the discovery, development and commercialization of novel cellular immunotherapies to significantly improve treatment options for cancer patients. The Company
was primarily focused on commercializing PROVENGE® in the United States (the U.S.) and around the world. PROVENGE is the first and only Food and Drug Administration (the
FDA) approved personalized immunotherapy. It is a first-in-class immunotherapy used to treat patients suffering from advanced-stage prostate cancer. PROVENGE is designed to target a certain prostate cancer antigen (prostatic acid
phosphatase), an antigen that is expressed in more than 90% of all prostate cancers. The Company engineered these antigens to be used as key agents for the production of immunotherapies to fight the disease in which the antigen presents itself.
While a typical immune response from the body triggers antibodies to help fight disease, the Company designed these agents to trigger and maximize cell-mediated immunity by activating the cells to deliver a signal to other components of the immune
system to fight the antigen. This was achieved in part by fusing the antigen to an immune-stimulatory protein in the Companys proprietary Antigen Delivery Cassette. To obtain antigen-presenting cells, the Company acquired white blood
cells removed from a patient via a standard blood collection process called leukapheresis. The cells were processed using the Companys proprietary cell separation technology, and the final product was re-infused into the patient. The process
required less than three days from cell collection to the administration of the active immunotherapy product.
The primary market for
PROVENGE is the U.S., where the drug was approved for marketing by the FDA and became commercially available for the treatment of men with asymptomatic or minimally symptomatic castrate-resistant (hormone-refractory) prostate cancer in April 2010.
While most prostate cancer initially responds to hormone ablation therapy, the majority of these patients will experience disease progression after 18 to 24 months, as the cancer becomes resistant to hormone treatment. PROVENGE is used to treat
patients in this advanced stage of prostate cancer.
While the Company was focused on the commercialization of PROVENGE, the Company had
several other product candidates in research and development. These included: (i)
4 |
References to the Company include the Debtors together with their non-debtor subsidiaries and affiliates.
|
8
DN24-02, the Companys investigational active cellular immunotherapy that potentially may be used for the treatment of patients with bladder, breast, ovarian and other solid tumors
expressing the antigen HER2/neu; (ii) CA-9 antigen, which is a transmembrane protein highly expressed in over 75% of primary metastatic renal cell carcinomas, as well as other cancers, such as non-small cell lung and breast tumors; and
(iii) CEA, an antigen found to be present on 70% of lung cancers, virtually all cases of colon cancers and approximately 65% of breast cancers. The Company was also exploring the application of small molecules for the treatment of a variety of
cancers.
|
2. |
The Debtors Corporate Headquarters |
The Companys principal research,
development and administrative facilities were located at its corporate headquarters in Seattle, Washington, where the Company leased approximately 112,915 square feet of office space and in Bridgewater, New Jersey, where the Company leased 39,937
square feet. The Company now maintains offices at 601 Union Street, Suite 4900, Seattle, WA 98101.
|
3. |
The Debtors Employees |
As of the Petition Date, the Debtors had approximately 700
employees. The employees provided a variety of essential functions, including: (i) sales and marketing, (ii) research and development (including clinical, regulatory, quality assurance and control, and manufacturing or production), and
(iii) general and administrative (including executive, finance, legal, human resources, investor relations, information technology and operations). The employees were each offered a position with Valeant or one of Valeants affiliates
effective as of the closing of the sale of substantially all of the Debtors assets (as further outlined below). Two employees accepted offers to return to Dendreon Corporation: Gregory R. Cox as Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer and Robert
L. Crotty as President, General Counsel and Secretary.
D. |
The Debtors Corporate and Capital Structure |
The Debtors in the Chapter 11 Cases
are Dendreon Corporation, Dendreon Holdings, Inc., Dendreon Distribution, LLC and Dendreon Manufacturing, LLC. Dendreon is the parent of Dendreon Holdings, Inc., which in turn is the parent of Dendreon Distribution, LLC and Dendreon Manufacturing,
LLC. Dendreon Corporation was also the parent of its wholly-owned, non-Debtor subsidiary, Dendreon Holdings (Netherlands) B.V., which in turn is the parent of non-debtors Dendreon UK Limited, Dendreon Germany GmbH and Dendreon Operations B.V. The
equity interests in Dendreon Holdings (Netherlands) B.V. were transferred to the Purchaser (as defined herein) as part of the sale of substantially all of the Debtors assets (as further outlined herein).
9
As of the Petition Date, the Debtors had one issuance of debt
outstanding: the 2016 Notes.5 Pursuant to a First Supplemental Indenture dated January 20, 2011, Dendreon Corporation issued $620 million aggregate principal amount of unsecured
2.875% Convertible Senior Notes with a maturity date of January 15, 2016 (the 2016 Notes).6 The 2016 Notes were issued as part of an underwritten offer and sale, which
included an initial issuance of $540 million of 2016 Notes and, after the exercise of an overallotment option by the underwriter, an additional issuance of $80 million of 2016 Notes. The Company received net cash proceeds of $607.1 million from the
sale of the 2016 Notes, after deducting underwriting fees and expenses. The 2016 Notes are convertible at the option of the holder at an initial conversion price of $51.24 per share. As of the Petition Date, there were $620 million of 2016
Notes outstanding and accrued and unpaid interest thereon of $5,694,097.22, for an aggregate Allowed Claim in respect of the 2016 Notes of $625,694,097.22. In entering into the Plan Support Agreements and again in formulating the Plans
treatment of Class 3, the Debtors evaluated whether the 2016 Note Claims should be allowed at the face amount or whether the fact that the 2016 Note Claims were issued with a conversion feature should result in the 2016 Note Claims being allowed at
something less than face amount. The Debtors determined that the 2016 Note Claims are not subject to any legitimate defenses, counterclaims or offsets and are properly Allowed at their full face amount plus accrued and unpaid interest.
GlaxoSmithKline LLC (GSK) asserts that the 2016 Noteholder Claim should not be allowed in the full amount. See GlaxoSmithKline
LLCs Addendum Regarding 2016 Notes, attached to this Disclosure Statement as Annex 1. The statements and views set forth in GSKs Annex 1 to this Disclosure Statement are GSKs own arguments and contentions and do not represent the
Debtors analysis of the 2016 Noteholder Claim. The Debtors disagree with GSKs legal analysis and conclusions as set forth in Annex 1 and are unaware of any precedent supporting GSKs contentions.
As of September 30, 2014, there were 158,716,893 shares of
common stock in Dendreon Corporation outstanding.7 On November 7, 2014, the closing price of Dendreon Corporations stock was $0.942 per share. Dendreon Corporations stock was
traded on The NASDAQ Global Market.
5 |
On June 17, 2014, Company timely paid the final principal and interest payment on its 4.75% Convertible Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014. |
6 |
This indenture supplemented the indenture Dendreon Corporation entered into on March 16, 2007 for the issuance of debt securities in an unlimited amount. |
7 |
The Company currently has 10,000,000 shares, $0.01 par value, of authorized preferred stock, of which 2,500,000 shares have been designated as Series A Junior Participating Preferred Stock. As of the Petition Date, no
preferred stock was issued or outstanding. |
10
On December 11, 2014, NASDAQ filed a Form 25 with the SEC to remove Dendreon
Corporations securities from listing and registration on NASDAQ, effective at the opening of the trading session on December 22, 2014. While shares of common stock of the Company are currently traded on the OTC Pink Marketplace under the
trading symbol DNDNQ, the Plan does not provide for any distributions on account of the shares of common stock of Dendreon Corporation and effects the cancellation of the stock on the effective date of the Plan (the Effective
Date).
E. |
Summary of Events Leading to the Chapter 11 Filings |
|
1. |
Challenges Faced by the Debtors and Restructuring Efforts |
When PROVENGE was officially
launched after receiving FDA approval in April 2010, expectations for the pioneering drug were high. It received a substantial amount of market attention and certain market analyst projections estimated that PROVENGE could generate over $4 billion
of revenue by 2020. To support its efforts to commercialize PROVENGE and create a platform through which it could ultimately support the revenues predicted by the market, early in 2011, the Company raised capital through the issuance of the 2016
Notes, among other securities. Consistent with management and market expectations, the Companys operating structure and footprint was developed to support billions in revenue: at that time the Company employed nearly 1,500 individuals and had
significantly invested in manufacturing facilities and related operations, including facilities in New Jersey, Georgia and California. However, with the passage of time after launch and by August 2011, it became apparent to the Company that revenue
growth would take more time than initially anticipated and the Company predicted a more gradual adoption of use by physicians. While the Company remained optimistic about its potential for significant growth in the long term, it decided to
aggressively manage its costs in the interim.
In furtherance of its efforts to increase revenue and manage costs, in September of 2011,
the Company implemented a reduction of 25% of its workforce. Then, in July of 2012, the Board of Directors (the Board) directed the Company to engage in additional efforts to reduce costs. To that end, the Company announced a
12-month strategic restructuring plan that included a re-configuration of the Companys manufacturing model, a restructuring of its administrative functions and a strengthening of the Companys marketing and sales operations. The Company
hoped that the restructuring would allow a reduction in costs by approximately $150 million annually. In addition, the Company reduced headcount by more than 600 full-time and contractor positions and sold its manufacturing facility in Morris
Plains, New Jersey. The Company projected that it would be able to continue to reduce cost of goods sold through, among other things, the implementation of certain automated manufacturing processes. The Company expected to see net benefits
associated with this restructuring as early as the first half of 2013.
During the second half of 2013, after the 2012 restructuring was
completed, the Debtors decided to begin exploring potential strategic alternatives for maximizing value and managing its debt load, including exploring exchange transactions and a potential sale. To that end, the Company worked with outside advisors
to explore a potential debt exchange transaction. Further, in September of 2013 the Debtors retained J.P. Morgan Securities LLC (JPM) and
11
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated (Merrill) to assist the Company with a potential sale or other transaction. At this time, the Company again assessed
and evaluated its overall strategy and cost-structure to identify additional expense reductions. As a result, on November 13, 2013, at the direction of the Board, the Company announced that it was implementing additional cost reduction
measures, including a reduction of cash operating expenses by approximately $125 million or 20% and a reduction in workforce of approximately 150 full-time employees.
Between October and December 2013, JPM and Merrill conducted a broad confidential auction process to solicit potential buyers for the Company.
A significant number of parties conducted due diligence; however, no bids were ultimately submitted.
Although the Company remained
positive about its longer-term prospects and its ability to ultimately maximize value, the Company continued to be concerned with its highly levered capital structure and inability to generate positive free cash flow in the near term. Therefore, in
February 2014, the Debtors retained Lazard Frères & Co. LLC (Lazard) as their investment banker to provide general financial advisory services and evaluate potential strategic alternatives, including assisting the
Company in any potential restructuring, sale transaction or financing transaction. The Companys initial goal in hiring Lazard was to gain assistance with addressing the 2016 Notes, possibly through a refinancing, an extension of the maturity
or a conversion of the 2016 Notes to new debt or equity. Soon thereafter, the Board directed the Company to hire AlixPartners, LLP (AlixPartners) to, among other things, work with management to identify further cost reductions.
Additionally, the Company engaged Trinity Partners, LLC, a life science strategic consulting firm, to prepare a valuation report and develop independent revenue forecast models. In March and April 2014, the Company discussed the possibility of a
strategic combination with two separate third-parties, however, these discussions did not advance beyond the preliminary stages.
|
2. |
Consideration of Strategic Alternatives and Discussions with Creditors |
The Company
continued to consider its strategic alternatives, refine its business plan, and examine the possibility of further cost reductions throughout the spring and summer of 2014. While the Company had concluded (and disclosed in its Form 10-Q for the
second quarter of 2014) that absent executing an alternative transaction there was significant risk that it would be unable to repay or refinance the 2016 Notes, it remained hopeful that such a transaction would occur and would provide value for all
stakeholders, including equity.
In early summer 2014, the Company had completed its revised business plan and its analysis with respect
to cost reductions and, as a result, came to several conclusions. First, the Company determined that its previously-held view that it would ultimately be able to increase revenues through an increase in its volume of units sold was unlikely to occur
in the next few years. Second, while the Company had managed to cut costs significantly over the last several years, and AlixPartners has identified certain additional areas for cost reduction, the Company determined that cost reductions alone would
not make the Company independently viable with its existing capital structure. Finally, the manufacturing process for PROVENGE has a relatively high cost because it is made manually by skilled lab technicians. The Company had begun to implement
plans for automated manufacturing in 2012 to increase quality control and came to
12
believe that automation would also result in significant cost savings. However, after analysis by AlixPartners and investigation by the Companys automation group, the results of which were
presented to the Board, it became clear that while automation could improve quality control, there would be no meaningful cost savings resulting from automation.
As a result, the Company concluded that given that it was highly levered and faced significant challenges in achieving positive free cash
flows in the near term, the business likely would not be viable on a stand-alone basis absent a strategic transaction or a restructuring of its debt.
To that end, and beginning in July of 2014, the Board authorized Lazard, on behalf of the Company, to initiate discussions with the largest
holder of the 2016 Notes, Deerfield Management Company, L.P. (Deerfield) pursuant to a nondisclosure agreement (NDA) regarding, among other things, a restructuring of the debt or a potential sale process.8 Given that the 2016 Notes constitute the Companys only outstanding institutional debt and the overwhelming majority of the unsecured claims against the Debtors, the Debtors believed that it
would be desirable to obtain input from the holders of such notes or their representatives. In August 2014, the Debtors executed an NDA with Brown Rudnick LLP as counsel to certain unaffiliated holders of approximately 48% of the 2016 Notes
(collectively, the Unaffiliated Noteholders). The Debtors, subject to these NDAs, informed Deerfield and its counsel as well as counsel to the Unaffiliated Noteholders of the Companys investigation of strategic alternatives.
In September 2014, the Company, Deerfield and the Unaffiliated Noteholders mutually agreed that, among the strategic alternatives considered, the appropriate path for the Company would involve pursuing a sale process that would be implemented
through the filing of these Chapter 11 Cases.
|
3. |
The Pre-filing Marketing Process |
The Company believed that, on account of the
significant investments the Company had made in commercializing PROVENGE, the cutting edge technology, equipment and process it had developed and the intellectual know-how, the Companys assets might be of additional value to a
purchaser, particularly one with synergies. Therefore, the Board directed the Company to conduct a marketing process, in parallel with discussions with Deerfield and counsel to the Unaffiliated Noteholders as an additional option to
maximize value. To that end, and acknowledging that the in-court process would include a marketing process toward a potential sale, Lazard identified and developed a list of potentially interested parties and solicited such parties interest in
a sale transaction. Beginning in mid-September 2014, Lazard contacted approximately forty (40) potential buyers, a number of which had been contacted in the auction process conducted by JPM and Merrill in the third quarter of 2013. The goal in
this pre-filing marketing process was to sign up potential buyers to NDAs and afford them time to evaluate the opportunity in advance of any in-court sale process. A virtual data room was made available containing extensive information about the
Company, including documents describing the
8 |
Deerfield is represented by Willkie Farr & Gallagher LLP. Katten Muchin Rosenman LLP has also acted as counsel to Deerfield during the pendency of the Chapter 11 Cases. |
13
Companys business and financial results in considerable detail, and Lazard gave potential purchasers the opportunity to conduct due diligence via the electronic data room.
|
4. |
The Plan Support Agreements and the Competitive Process |
Contemporaneous with the
pre-filing marketing process, the Company continued discussions with Deerfield and counsel to the Unaffiliated Noteholders, as well as their financial advisors. In September and October of 2014, the Debtors entered into NDAs with individual
Unaffiliated Noteholders. The Debtors periodically updated counsel to the Unaffiliated Noteholders and Deerfield regarding the process and strategic alternatives.
The Company continued discussions with the Unaffiliated Noteholders and Deerfield regarding a consensual stand-alone restructuring to
right-size the Companys balance sheet. Good faith, arms length negotiations culminated in the execution of two substantially similar agreements dated November 9, 2014 (the Plan Support Agreements) one among the
Debtors and the Unaffiliated Noteholders and the other among the Debtors and certain funds managed by Deerfield (the Deerfield Noteholders and, together with the Unaffiliated Noteholders, the Supporting
Noteholders). Pursuant to the Plan Support Agreements, the Debtors and the Supporting Noteholders agreed to a restructuring in accordance with the terms of a term sheet attached to each of the Plan Support Agreements (the PSA Term
Sheet). The Plan Support Agreements contemplated that the Debtors would, with the support of the Supporting Noteholders, pursue a dual path of third-party sale or plan transaction with a stand-alone plan backstop (the
Stand-Alone Plan). Pursuant to the PSA Term Sheet, under the Stand-Alone Plan, the reorganized Debtors would issue new common stock in the reorganized entity, and holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims would receive, on a pro rata
basis with holders of general unsecured claims, shares of the new common stock.
Specifically, the Plan Support Agreements provided the
framework for a competitive process (the Competitive Process) whereby prospective buyers could bid to purchase all or substantially all of the Debtors non-cash assets either (i) in a sale pursuant to Bankruptcy Code
section 363, or (ii) in the form of a recapitalization transaction effectuated through a plan of reorganization. Simultaneously with the filing of the Chapter 11 Cases, the Debtors filed the Sale and Bidding Procedures Motion (as defined
herein) seeking approval of the Bidding Procedures (as defined herein) pursuant to which the Competitive Process would take place. A Qualified Bid (as defined in the Bidding Procedures Order, as defined herein) in the Competitive Process had to have
a value in excess of $275 million as determined in accordance with the Bidding Procedures.
Pursuant to the PSA Term Sheet, whether the
Competitive Process resulted in a sale pursuant to Bankruptcy Code section 363 followed by a plan of liquidation or in a recapitalization transaction followed by a plan of reorganization, the result would be the same for the Debtors two
largest creditor constituencies, holders of claims pursuant to the 2016 Notes and holders of general unsecured claims. In either case, these constituencies would share pro rata in the distributable cash or other assets of the Debtors Estates.
The PSA Term Sheet also contemplated that if the Competitive Process did not result in any Qualified Bid being received, the Debtors would prosecute the Stand-Alone Plan and emerge from bankruptcy as a reorganized entity whose equity would be owned
by the Supporting Noteholders and other unsecured
14
creditors. As such, the transaction contemplated by the Plan Support Agreements allowed the Debtors to pursue a competitive sale process that ensured that the value of their Estates would be
maximized for the benefit of all stakeholders.
The Board met bi-weekly throughout the Debtors process of considering strategic
alternatives and was kept fully apprised of the status of proposals and options available to the Debtors. The Board directed the Companys actions throughout this process and was kept regularly informed of all actions taken by the Company in
connection therewith. In addition to the numerous other meetings that were regularly held throughout the strategic alternatives process, at a meeting of the Board held on November 5, 2014, the Board was updated and advised regarding the Plan
Support Agreements negotiated with the Supporting Noteholders and other matters relevant to the Competitive Process and the Debtors strategic options. At the meeting (and in prior meetings throughout the process), the Board was advised by Lazard and
by counsel regarding these matters. After full deliberation, on November 9, 2014, the Board determined that entering into the Plan Support Agreements, filing these Chapter 11 Cases and pursuing the Competitive Process contemplated in the Plan
Support Agreements as part of these Chapter 11 Cases, was the best way to maximize value.
F. |
Summary of Material Pre-Petition Legal Proceedings |
Dendreon Corporation received notice in November 2011 of a lawsuit
filed in the Durham County Superior Court of North Carolina (the Superior Court) against Dendreon Corporation by GSK. The lawsuit, captioned GlaxoSmithKline LLC v. Dendreon Corporation, Case No. 11 CVS 5458, asserts
claims for monies due and owing and breach of Dendreon Corporations obligations under the Development and Supply Agreement, effective September 15, 2010, between GSK and Dendreon Corporation. Under the agreement, GSK was to be Dendreon
Corporations second source antigen provider. The agreement was terminated by Dendreon Corporation as of October 31, 2011.
Dendreon Corporation filed a Counterclaim and Answer on January 6, 2012. On April 9, 2013, GSK amended its complaint to add a claim
for breach of North Carolinas unfair and deceptive trade practices act. On November 4, 2014, the Superior Court issued an opinion and order on GSKs motion for summary judgment on its breach of contract claim and Dendreon
Corporations cross motion for summary judgment on GSKs breach of contract, breach of the covenant of good faith and fair dealing, and unfair and deceptive trade practices act claims, both of which had been fully briefed since March 2014.
In its opinion and order, the Superior Court found that GSK is entitled to be paid for a firm order placed by Dendreon Corporation before it terminated the parties agreement, but otherwise dismissed GSKs remaining claims. On its breach
of contract claim GSK is seeking approximately $17.6 million in damages, plus interest and extension fees, but the Superior Court has not yet made any determination of amounts that may be owed for the firm order or whether any offsets, including
amounts recoverable on the Companys counterclaims, would reduce any amounts owed. On June 11, 2014, GSK filed a second motion for summary judgment on Dendreon Corporations counterclaims, which Dendreon Corporation opposed and is now
fully briefed. The Superior Court has not yet scheduled oral argument or issued a ruling on Dendreon Corporations second motion for
15
summary judgment. There is currently no date set for trial. Dendreon Corporations position remains that no monies are owed under the agreement.
GSK filed a proof of claim in the Chapter 11 Cases asserting a claim for $26,089,724. The Debtors filed an objection to GSKs proof of
claim on March 30, 2015 [Docket No. 536]. The Debtors assert that the claim should be disallowed in full. The litigation surrounding the agreement with GSK is still pending and no final judgment determining amounts due, if any, has been
rendered. The Debtors believe that the summary judgment decision reached by the Superior Court would be overturned on appeal. In addition, the Debtors assert that GSKs proof of claim includes amounts expressly disallowed by the Superior Court.
As a consequence of the bankruptcy filings (as discussed below), all pending litigation against the Debtors was stayed automatically by
section 362 of the Bankruptcy Code and, absent further order of the Court, no party may take any action in any such litigation to recover on prepetition Claims against the Debtors.
|
2. |
Bolling Securities Action and Related Actions and Investigations |
|
a. |
Bolling Securities Action |
Dendreon Corporation and three of its former officers
are named defendants in a securities action pending in the United States District Court for the Western District of Washington (the District Court) that was brought by a group of individual investors who elected to opt out of a
securities class action lawsuit that was settled for $40 million in August 2013. The pending action, filed May 16, 2013, is captioned Christoph Bolling, et al. v. Dendreon Corporation, et al., Case No. 2:13-cv-0872 JLR. Plaintiffs
allege generally that Dendreon Corporation made various false or misleading statements between April 29, 2010 and August 3, 2011 concerning Dendreon Corporation, its finances, business operations and prospects with a focus on the market
launch of PROVENGE and related forecasts concerning physician adoption, and revenue from sales of PROVENGE. Based on information provided by plaintiffs counsel, the plaintiff group, which totals approximately thirty (30) persons, purports
to have purchased approximately 250,000 shares of Dendreon Corporation common stock during the relevant period. The Bolling plaintiffs filed an amended complaint on July 16, 2013, alleging both violations of certain provisions of the
federal Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and provisions of Washington state law and seeking unspecified damages. In response to a motion by defendants, the federal claims were dismissed with leave to amend in January 2014. On February 17, 2014,
plaintiffs filed a Second Amended Complaint which defendants moved to dismiss on March 24, 2014. After briefing, the District Court, by order dated June 5, 2014, again dismissed the federal claims, but denied the motion as to the
plaintiffs Washington state law claims for fraudulent and negligent misrepresentation. The case is now in the discovery phase. On September 4, 2014, the District Court entered an order setting a trial date of February 22, 2016 with
discovery cut-off of October 26, 2015. On February 23, 2015, the plaintiffs filed motions to sever their claims against Dendreon from those against the individual defendants.
16
|
b. |
Stockholder Derivative Complaints |
Dendreon Corporation is also the subject of
stockholder derivative complaints first filed in August 2011 generally arising out of the facts and circumstances that are alleged to underlie the above-referenced previously settled securities class action. Derivative suits filed in the District
Court were consolidated into a proceeding captioned In re Dendreon Corp. Derivative Litigation, Master Docket No. C 11-1345 JLR; others were filed in the Superior Court of Washington for King County and were consolidated into a proceeding
captioned In re Dendreon Corporation Shareholder Derivative Litigation, Lead Case No. 11-2-29626-1 SEA. On June 22, 2012, another derivative action was filed in the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware, captioned Herbert
Silverberg, derivatively on behalf of Dendreon Corporation v. Mitchell H. Gold, et al., Case No. 7646-VCP. The various derivative complaints name as defendants various current and former officers and directors of Dendreon Corporation
(the Individual Defendants). While the complaints assert various legal theories of liability, the lawsuits generally allege that the defendants breached fiduciary duties owed to Dendreon Corporation in connection with the launch
of PROVENGE and by purportedly subjecting Dendreon Corporation to potential liability for securities fraud. The complaints also include claims against certain defendants for supposed misappropriation of Dendreon Corporations information and
insider trading; the Silverberg complaint asserts only this latter claim. On July 18, 2014, a new derivative complaint was filed in the District Court captioned Liu v. Gold et al., Case No. 2-14cv1087. The allegations in the
Liu complaint are substantially the same as those in the existing consolidated actions pending in the District Court. Plaintiffs have requested that the Liu action be consolidated into the existing consolidated federal actions.
After a formal mediation on June 24, 2014, and further post-mediation negotiations, the parties to the various derivative actions reached
a tentative settlement of the actions, the terms of which are set out in a Memorandum of Understanding dated as of July 18, 2014. On November 6, 2014, the parties entered into a stipulation of settlement, which settlement required court
approval, with respect to the litigation. While the derivative lawsuits do not seek relief against Dendreon Corporation, Dendreon Corporation has certain indemnification obligations, including obligations to advance legal expenses to the named
defendants for defense of these lawsuits.
The stipulation of settlement provides that in connection with the settlement and in
consideration of certain releases set forth in the stipulation, the Individual Defendants would cause to be paid $4,500,000 (the Settlement Payment) into an escrow account. In recognition of certain coverage disputes and their
obligation to fund the defense of the Individual Defendants in these derivative cases should the cases not settle, the insurers under certain remaining excess insurance policies have agreed to a buyback payment that will be used by the Individual
Defendants to fund the Settlement Payment. In consideration of the buyback payment, certain remaining excess insurance policies will receive releases with regard to this derivative litigation. The Settlement Payment will be used to pay any
attorneys fees and expenses awarded by the Chancery Court to plaintiffs counsel as well as any costs of notice. Such fees and costs may not exceed $1,250,000 in the aggregate. The remaining amount of the Settlement Payment will be paid
from the escrow account to Dendreon Corporation. In addition, as part of the Stipulation, the Debtor has agreed to implement certain corporate governance measures. As is customary, in exchange for the Settlement Payment and agreement to settle these
actions, the Individual Defendants
17
will receive certain releases from the plaintiffs and Dendreon Corporation, and the plaintiffs and Dendreon Corporation will receive certain releases from the Individual Defendants.
The Bankruptcy Court entered an order lifting the automatic stay to the extent necessary to allow the insurers to advance and/or to reimburse
defense costs, settlements, and/or losses on December 17, 2014 [Docket No. 196]. On March 30, 2015, the Delaware Court of Chancery entered an order approving the proposed settlement. For additional details, see Article IIID.3.
The SEC has been conducting a formal investigation of Dendreon
Corporation, which Dendreon Corporation believed related to some of the same issues raised in the aforementioned securities and derivative actions. Dendreon Corporation cooperated fully with the SEC investigation. On March 23, 2015, Dendreon
Corporation received written notice from the SEC indicating that the SEC had concluded its investigation of Dendreon Corporation and that the SEC did not intend to recommend an enforcement action by the SEC.
|
3. |
Quintal Stockholder Derivative Complaint |
On March 7, 2014, a stockholder
derivative complaint was filed in United States District Court for the District of Delaware (the Delaware District Court). The lawsuit, captioned Quintal v. Bayh, et al., No. 1:14-cv-00311-LPS, names as defendants both
present and former members of Dendreon Corporations Board. This derivative litigation is separate and apart from the stockholder litigation referenced in Article IIF.2.b. Plaintiffs purported derivative complaint alleges that members of
Dendreon Corporations Board violated the terms of Dendreon Corporations 2009 equity incentive plan by granting to non-employee directors shares of Dendreon Corporation stock that vested immediately upon grant as part of the non-employee
directors annual compensation package. Defendants filed a motion to dismiss the complaint on April 14, 2014. The Delaware District Court heard oral argument on Defendants motion on July 29, 2014, and the motion is now under
submission. While Dendreon Corporation has certain indemnification obligations, including obligations to advance legal expense to the named defendants for defense of this lawsuit, the lawsuit does not seek monetary relief against Dendreon
Corporation.
ARTICLE III
THE CHAPTER 11 CASES
A. |
Commencement of the Chapter 11 Cases |
As set forth above, on the Petition Date the
Debtors filed voluntary petitions for relief under chapter 11 of the Bankruptcy Code in the Court. By order dated November 12, 2014 [Docket No. 49], the Debtors cases are being jointly administered for procedural purposes only. No
trustee or examiner has been appointed in the Chapter 11 Cases.
Since the Petition Date, the Debtors have continued to operate their
businesses and manage their properties as debtors and debtors-in-possession.
18
B. |
First Day Motions and Related Applications |
On the Petition Date, the
Debtors filed a number of first-day motions and applications designed to ease the Debtors transition into chapter 11, maximize the Debtors assets and minimize the effects of the commencement of the Chapter 11 Cases.9 On November 12, 2014, the Court entered orders providing various first-day relief, including:
(i) authorizing the Debtors to continue use of their existing cash management system and bank accounts, business forms and
deposit and investment practices; pay related prepetition obligations; waiver of certain operating guidelines relating to bank accounts; and continue intercompany transactions (final order entered December 9, 2014) [Docket No. 160];
(ii) authorizing the Debtors to pay prepetition wages, compensation and employee benefits; continue certain employee benefit
programs in the ordinary course; and direct banks to honor prepetition checks for the payment of prepetition employee obligations (final order entered December 9, 2014) [Docket No. 157];
(iii) enforcing the automatic stay protections of 11 U.S.C. § 362 and the bankruptcy termination provisions
of 11 U.S.C. § 365 [Docket No. 55];
(iv) authorizing the Debtors to honor certain prepetition obligations to
customers; continue customer programs; and pay Medicaid and other obligations (final order entered December 9, 2014) [Docket No. 158];
(v) authorizing the Debtors to maintain existing insurance policies; pay all insurance obligations arising thereunder; and
renew, revise, extend, supplement, change or enter into new insurance policies [Docket No. 53];
(vi) authorizing
the Debtors to pay certain prepetition taxes and related obligations [Docket No. 54];
(vii) approving the
Debtors proposal for adequate assurance of payment; establishing procedures for resolving objections by utility companies; and prohibiting utility companies from altering, refusing or discontinuing service (final order entered December 9,
2014) [Docket No. 161];
9 |
In addition to the first-day motions, the Debtors filed certain other motions that are described more fully herein. |
19
(viii) extending the deadline for the Debtors to file their schedules of assets
and liabilities and statements of financial affairs [Docket No. 59];
(ix) establishing notice and hearing
procedures for trading in equity securities of the Debtors (final order entered December 9, 2014) [Docket No. 162]; and
(x) authorizing payment of prepetition claims of certain critical vendors [Docket No. 57].
C. |
Retention of Professionals and Appointment of the Committee |
|
1. |
Retention of Debtors Professionals |
By orders entered December 9, 2014, the
Debtors were authorized to retain (i) Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP as their bankruptcy counsel [Docket No. 152], (ii) AlixPartners as their restructuring advisor [Docket No. 155], and (iii) Lazard as
their investment banker [Docket No. 156].
The Debtors also were authorized to retain certain professionals utilized by the Debtors
in the ordinary course of business prior to the Petition Date pursuant to an order [Docket No. 159] entered by the Court on December 9, 2014.
|
2. |
Retention of Claims and Noticing Agent and Administrative Agent |
By order entered on
November 12, 2014 [Docket No. 60], the Court authorized the Debtors to retain Prime Clerk as their claims and noticing agent in the Chapter 11 Cases. By order entered December 9, 2014 [Docket No. 154], the Court also authorized
the Debtors to retain Prime Clerk as their administrative agent in the Chapter 11 Cases.
|
3. |
Appointment of Committee and Retention of Committee Professionals |
On November 19,
2014, the Office of the United States Trustee for the District of Delaware (the U.S. Trustee) appointed an Official Committee of Unsecured Creditors in the Chapter 11 Cases (the Committee) pursuant to section
1102(a) of the Bankruptcy Code [Docket No. 92]. The initial members of the Committee (the Committee Members) were: (i) American Red Cross, (ii) Document Technologies, LLC, (iii) New York Blood Center, Inc.,
(iv) Piedmont Bridgewater NJ, LLC and (v) GSK. On March 3, 2015, the U.S. Trustee filed an Amended Notice of Appointment of Committee of Unsecured Creditors [Docket No. 452], reflecting the resignation of New York Blood
Center, Inc. from the Committee. On March 12, 2015, the U.S. Trustee filed a second Amended Notice of Appointment of Committee of Unsecured Creditors [Docket No. 480], reflecting the resignation of the American Red Cross from the
Committee.
By orders entered January 28, 2015, the Committee was authorized to retain (i) Sullivan & Cromwell LLP as
its counsel [Docket No. 322], (ii) Young Conaway Stargatt & Taylor, LLP as its co-counsel [Docket No. 323], and (iii) Centerview Partners LLP as its investment banker
20
[Docket No. 324]. By an order entered January 26, 2015, the Committee was authorized to retain Deloitte Financial Advisory Services LLP as its financial advisor [Docket No. 312].
D. |
Significant Events During the Chapter 11 Cases |
In addition to the first-day relief
sought and received in the Chapter 11 Cases, the Debtors have sought and received authority with respect to various matters designed to assist in the administration of the Chapter 11 Cases and to maximize the value of the Debtors Estates.
Material events since the commencement of the Chapter 11 Cases are summarized below and include:
|
1. |
Approval of Plan Support Agreements |
As noted in Article IIE.4, the Debtors negotiated
and entered into the Plan Support Agreements with the Supporting Noteholders, which contemplated that the Debtors would, with the support of the Supporting Noteholders, pursue a dual path of a third-party sale or plan transaction with the
Stand-Alone Plan backstop. On November 10, 2014, the Debtors filed a motion seeking authorization to assume the Plan Support Agreements [Docket No. 20]. Following its formation, the Committee raised certain concerns and potential
objections to the assumption of the Plan Support Agreements. The Debtors, the Supporting Noteholders, and the Committee negotiated in good faith the resolution of those concerns and objections and reached a settlement. The Debtors and the Supporting
Noteholders entered into amended plan support agreements as part of that settlement (the Amended and Restated Plan Support Agreements). The payment of professional fees was outlined pursuant to the UCC Settlement Term Sheet (the
Settlement Term Sheet) agreed to by the Debtors, the Committee, and the Supporting Noteholders for the consensual assumption of the Amended and Restated Plan Support Agreements. According to the Settlement Term Sheet,
reimbursement of legal fees is limited to the reasonable fees and expenses of one counsel per group, plus local counsel per group. In addition, the Debtors and Supporting Noteholders agreed not to object to a substantial contribution fee award for
counsel to members of the UCC, provided that the fees did not exceed $100,000 in the aggregate. The Court entered an order, over the U.S. Trustees objection, authorizing the Debtors to assume the Amended and Restated Plan Support Agreements on
December 23, 2014 (the PSA Order) [Docket No. 215].
|
2. |
Approval of Key Employee Incentive Program |
Prior to the Petition Date, the Debtors
recognized a need to address the concerns of their employees and their creditors and to align the interests of these respective constituencies. With these objectives in mind, the Debtors, after extensive consultation with, and benchmarking analysis
by, their employee benefits consultant, Mercer (US) Inc., developed the Key Employee Incentive Plan (KEIP) to properly incentivize certain key employees identified by the Debtors.
The KEIP was designed to provide incentives to nine (9) eligible executives (the Participants) to pursue a timely and
successful reorganization or sale. The KEIP provided for variable payouts to the Participants based upon the distributable value of the Debtors assets upon the occurrence of a qualifying sale (a Qualifying Sale) or
recapitalization of the Debtors business effectuated through the Stand-Alone Plan.
21
The minimum threshold was a distributable value of (i) $50 million in the case of a
Stand-Alone Plan and (ii) $325 million in the case of a Qualifying Sale (the Minimum Threshold). Participants were not eligible to receive a KEIP payment unless the Minimum Threshold was exceeded. A $250,000 discretionary
pool was available at the Minimum Threshold and could be distributed to any employee if the Board determined that an employees efforts in effecting the transaction merited some reward. The maximum threshold was a Distributable Value of
(i) $345 million in the case of a Stand-Alone Plan and (ii) $620 million in the case of a Qualifying Sale (the Maximum Threshold). At the Maximum Threshold, the aggregate amount of the KEIP would be approximately $3.1
million. There were no additional amounts available if the Maximum Threshold was exceeded.
Therefore, a Payment Event would
be triggered upon the earlier of (a) the effective date of a confirmed Plan of Reorganization if (i) in the case of a Stand-Alone Plan, the Debtors had distributable value of at least $50 million or (ii) if a Qualifying Sale was
consummated, the Debtors had distributable value of at least $325 million or (b) on the ninetieth (90th) day following the consummation of a Qualifying Sale with distributable value of at least $325 million.
In the event that a Qualifying Sale was consummated and a Participant (i) commenced employment with the acquiror or (ii) did not
receive an employment offer from the acquiror and was terminated by the Company without cause prior to the Payment Event (a Sale Termination), the Company was to pay such Participant his or her full bonus amount on the date such
Participants employment was so terminated.
The KEIP was not a pay to stay retention plan. Absent achievement of the
Minimum Thresholds, Participants were not eligible for a KEIP payment. Accordingly, the KEIP successfully aligned the interests of the Debtors, their employees, and their creditors and was a true incentive plan.
The Debtors received comments from the Committee regarding the KEIP, which were resolved. By order entered December 17, 2014, the Court
approved the implementation of the KEIP [Docket No. 194].
As a result of the Sale (as defined herein), which constituted a
Qualifying Sale, a Payment Event under the KEIP was triggered. The Debtors are currently in the process of calculating the amount of such payments, which fall within the range of $1.6 million to $2.0 million.
|
3. |
Derivative Litigation Settlement |
As noted in Article IIF.2.b., after a formal
mediation on June 24, 2014, and further post-mediation negotiations, the parties to the certain derivative actions reached a tentative settlement, the terms of which are set out in a Memorandum of Understanding dated as of July 18, 2014.
The settlement has been memorialized in a formal stipulation of settlement. The Debtors filed a motion in the Bankruptcy Court for an order (I) approving the stipulation; (II) authorizing the advancement and reimbursement of defense costs and
other loss related thereto; (III) authorizing the advancement and reimbursement of defense costs and other loss by the remaining excess
22
insurers; and (IV) granting related relief [Docket No. 93]. The Bankruptcy Court entered an order approving the motion (the 9019 Order) on December 17, 2014 [Docket
No. 196]. Pursuant to the 9019 Order, the Bankruptcy Court lifted the automatic stay to the extent necessary to allow insurers to advance and/or to reimburse defense costs, settlements, and/or losses. The Bankruptcy Court also found pursuant to
the 9019 Order, that the stipulation was a reasonable exercise of the Debtors business judgment and could be presented to the Chancery Court for approval. On March 30, 2015, the Chancery Court entered an order approving the proposed
settlement.
|
a. |
A Brief Summary of the Sale Process |
As described in further detail in this Article
IIE.4, prior to the filing of the Chapter 11 Cases, the Debtors entered into Plan Support Agreements with their Supporting Noteholders. The keystone of the Plan Support Agreements was a competitive process pursuant to which the Debtors would
sell all or substantially all of their assets. As described more fully below, on the Petition Date, the Debtors filed the Sale and Bidding Procedures Motion (as defined herein). Following several rounds of bidding between Valeant and another
bidder, the Debtors selected Valeant as the stalking horse bidder. The Debtors did not receive any additional qualifying bids prior to the deadline for submitting such bids. The auction was, therefore, cancelled and Valeant became the successful
bidder. Prior to the hearing to approve the sale to Valeant as the successful bidder, the Debtors and Valeant entered into the Second Amended Acquisition Agreement (as defined herein) that would provide the Debtors with an additional $15 million in
incremental value. The Court entered an order approving the sale of substantially all of the Debtors assets to a subsidiary of Valeant on February 20, 2015, and the sale transaction was consummated on February 23, 2015.
|
b. |
The Sale Motion and Bidding Procedures Order |
On the Petition Date, the Debtors filed a
motion [Docket No. 17] (the Sale and Bidding Procedures Motion) seeking entry of an order (the Bidding Procedures Order) (A)(i) establishing bidding procedures (the Bidding Procedures)
relating to the sale of substantially all of the Debtors assets; (ii) establishing procedures for the Debtors to enter into stalking horse agreement with bid protections in connection with a sale of substantially all of the Debtors
assets (the Acquired Assets); (iii) establishing procedures for the assumption and assignment of executory contracts and unexpired leases, including notice of proposed cure amounts; (iv) approving the form and manner of
notice of all procedures, protections, schedules and agreements; and (v) scheduling a hearing (the Sale Hearing) to approve such sale (the Sale); and (B)(i) approving the Sale of the Debtors assets
free and clear of all liens, claims, encumbrances and interests; (ii) authorizing the assumption and assignment of certain executory contracts and unexpired leases; and (iii) granting certain related relief.
On December 17, 2014, the Court entered the Bidding Procedures Order [Docket No. 195] approving the Debtors proposed bidding
procedures. Among other things, the Bidding Procedures Order allowed the Debtors, in consultation with the Supporting Noteholders, the Committee, and any other official committee appointed in the Chapter 11 Cases, to select a
23
stalking horse bidder (the Stalking Horse Bidder) for the Acquired Assets for the purposes of establishing a minimum acceptable bid with which to begin an auction (the
Auction). The Bidding Procedures Order set (i) December 29, 2014, as the deadline by which the Debtors were required to select a stalking horse bidder (the Stalking Horse Deadline); and
(ii) January 27, 2015, as the deadline to submit qualified bids (the Bid Deadline). As the initial Stalking Horse Deadline approached, the Debtors had active participation in the sale process by a number of bidders and
determined, in light of all of the circumstances, not to select a Stalking Horse Bidder at that time.
|
c. |
Selection of a Stalking Horse Bidder |
As the original Bid Deadline approached, the
Debtors received both conforming and non-conforming bids relative to the bid standards, seeking to qualify as Qualified Bids. As such, Lazard and the Debtors continued to work with interested parties. On January 23, 2015, just prior to the Bid
Deadline, the Debtors became aware that Valeant, a large pharmaceutical company with a market capitalization exceeding $55 billion, was interested in participating in the process. On January 26, 2015, Valeant requested that the bid deadline be
extended for approximately two weeks. In order to balance the Debtors interest in accommodating Valeants participation with the complaints that surfaced of others that had participated throughout the process, the Debtors agreed to work
closely with one other interested party (the Alternative Bidder) towards becoming a Stalking Horse Bidder. To that end, the Debtors determined to extend the Bid Deadline for two days until January 29, 2015.
After making the determination to extend the Bid Deadline, the Debtors further determined to retain certain assets previously offered for
sale, including the Debtors assets related to their enteric coated D-3263 hydrochloride product candidate (the D-3263 Assets), with the prospect that the Debtors could be reorganized around the development of the retained
assets and the utilization of the Debtors U.S. federal income tax attributes. The Debtors informed bidders of the determination to retain certain assets and that the Debtors would not entertain bids for the retained assets until the primary
bidding process was completed.
Subsequently, Valeant also informed the Debtors that it was interested in becoming the Stalking Horse
Bidder. Over the ensuing two days, from January 27, 2015 to January 29, 2015, significant negotiations occurred between the Debtors and each of the parties interested in becoming the Stalking Horse Bidder. The Debtors ultimately determined
that Valeant submitted the highest and best offer at the time to become the Stalking Horse Bidder for the Acquired Assets. Notably, the Valeant contract included preferable contract provisions, including offers of employment for all employees. The
Alternative Bidders contract did not include such provisions.
On January 29, 2015, the Debtors filed the Emergency Motion for
Order (A) Approving Stalking Horse Bidder and Authorizing Bid Protections in Connection with the Sale of Substantially All of the Debtors Assets, (B) Rescheduling the Hearing to Approve Such Sale and (C) Granting Related Relief
[Docket No. 330] (the Stalking Horse Selection Motion). Pursuant to this motion, the Debtors sought approval of Valeant as the Stalking Horse Bidder at a purchase price of $296 million.
24
|
d. |
The Subsequent Bidding and Selection of a Successful Bidder |
Subsequent negotiations
and bidding occurred after the filing of the Stalking Horse Selection Motion. The subsequent bidding began on February 3, 2015 when the Alternative Bidder informed the Debtors that it would be submitting a new bid later that day or the
following morning. It did in fact submit a fully executed and financed bid late in the evening on February 3, 2015. The net value of that bid (after deductions from the face value of the bid due to terms in the contract that differed from the
Valeant contract) was materially higher than the value of Valeants bid.
The Debtors engaged in numerous rounds of bidding with the
Stalking Horse Bidder and the Alternative Bidder over the course of the day on February 4, 2015. At the conclusion of this bidding, Valeants last bid was materially higher and better than the last bid received from the Alternative Bidder.
The Alternative Bidder advised the Debtors that it would not bid again. The final Valeant bid provided a purchase price of $400 million, reflecting an increase of more than $100 million of value over the original bid filed with the Court in the
Stalking Horse Selection Motion.
After a hearing on February 5, 2015, the Court entered an order granting the relief sought in the
Stalking Horse Selection Motion, namely approving Valeant as the Stalking Horse Bidder [Docket No. 355] (the Stalking Horse Order). Following entry of the Stalking Horse Order, the Debtors filed a Notice of Selection of
Stalking Horse Bidder and Rescheduled Sale Hearing [Docket No. 356], rescheduling the Sale Hearing for February 20, 2015 at 10:00 a.m. and setting out the Bid Deadline as February 10, 2015 at 5:00 p.m. The Notice of Selection of
Stalking Horse Bidder and Rescheduled Sale Hearing was served on (i) the U.S. Trustee; (ii) counsel to the indenture trustee for the 2.875% Convertible Senior Notes due 2016; (iii) counsel to the Unaffiliated Noteholders;
(iv) counsel to the Deerfield Noteholders; (v) the Committee; (vi) all entities known to have expressed an interest in a transaction with respect to some or all of the Acquired Assets at any time; (vii) all entities known to have
asserted any lien, claim, interest or encumbrance in or upon any of the Debtors assets to be acquired; (viii) all federal, state and local regulatory or taxing authorities or recording offices which have a reasonably known interest in the
relief requested by the Stalking Horse Selection Motion; (ix) the United States Attorneys office; (x) the SEC; (xi) the Internal Revenue Service; (xii) the Debtors full creditor matrix; (xiii) all known equity
holders and noteholders; and (xiv) all parties entitled to notice pursuant to Bankruptcy Rule 2002. As of the Bid Deadline, the Debtors did not receive any Qualified Bids other than that submitted by Valeant as the Stalking Horse Bidder.
Therefore, the Debtors cancelled the Auction and accepted the bid of Valeant for the purchase of all or substantially all of the Debtors assets. On February 12, 2015, the Debtors filed a proposed order approving the sale to Valeant on the
terms agreed to in the Amended and Restated Acquisition Agreement, dated as of February 4, 2015 (the Amended Acquisition Agreement) [Docket No. 380].
Subsequent to entering into the Amended Acquisition Agreement, the Debtors were willing to entertain bids for the assets retained by the
Debtors, including the D-3263 Assets, pursuant to a transaction that would allow for the transfer to the purchaser of the Debtors U.S. federal income tax attributes. Valeant and the Debtors engaged in negotiations regarding the acquisition by
Valeant of such assets retained by the Debtors, including the D-3263 Assets.
25
|
e. |
The Second Amended Acquisition Agreement, the Sale Hearing and Closing |
Prior to the
Sale Hearing, the Debtors and Valeant entered into a Second Amended and Restated Acquisition Agreement among the Debtors, Valeant and Valeants wholly-owned subsidiary, Drone Acquisition Sub Inc. (the Purchaser), dated as of
February 19, 2015 (the Second Amended Acquisition Agreement or, as referred to in the Plan, the Asset Purchase Agreement). The Second Amended Acquisition Agreement provided for a higher purchase price,
consisting of common shares of Valeant, having an aggregate value of $49.5 million as of the close of the market on the Trading Day immediately prior to the Effective Date, paid to the Debtors as partial consideration for the assets acquired by the
Purchaser pursuant to the Sale Order (the Valeant Shares), plus $445.5 million in cash to be delivered at closing of the sale transaction. Pursuant to the Second Amended Acquisition Agreement, if the amount of the allowed
prepetition general unsecured claims (other than the 2016 Noteholder Claims) did not exceed $200 million in the aggregate, then the Valeant Shares could be distributed proportionately in respect of the 2016 Noteholder Claims. The consideration under
the Second Amended Acquisition Agreement provided an additional $15 million in incremental value to the Debtors Estates over that provided for under the Amended Acquisition Agreement, and $140 million more than the minimum Qualified Bid. The
Acquired Assets under the Second Amended Acquisition Agreement included all of the assets contemplated under the Amended Acquisition Agreement, plus the D-3263 Assets and $80 million of cash and cash equivalents of the Debtors. In addition, the
parties agreed that the agreement will constitute a plan of reorganization of Dendreon and the Purchaser for purposes of sections 368 and 354 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the Tax Code) (which plan
includes the liquidation of Dendreon and the distribution of the Valeant Shares).
As the Courts electronic filing system was
unexpectedly unavailable, the Debtors first served and posted on the Debtors website hosted by the Debtors claims and noticing agent, Prime Clerk, a Notice of Filing of Second Amended Acquisition Agreement and Proposed Sale Orders on
February 19, 2015, which included a chart with the key differences between the Amended Acquisition Agreement and the Second Amended Acquisition Agreement (the Notice of Second Amended APA). The Debtors filed the Notice of
Second Amended APA once the electronic filing system became available later on February 19, 2015 [Docket No. 400]. The Court found that notice of the Second Amended Acquisition Agreement was sufficient under the circumstances, relying in
part on the fact that the Supporting Noteholders and the Committee were kept involved and informed throughout the negotiation of the Second Amended Acquisition Agreement and were supportive of its terms.
An order was entered on February 20, 2015 (the Sale Order), approving the sale of substantially all of the
Debtors assets to the Purchaser pursuant to the terms of the Second Amended Acquisition Agreement as it may be amended, authorizing the assumption and assignment of certain executory contracts and unexpired leases, and granting related relief
[Docket No. 410] (the Sale Transaction). On February 23, 2015, the Sale Transaction was consummated.
26
On January 9, 2015 the Debtors filed their Schedules of Assets and
Liabilities [Docket Nos. 246 through 249] and Statements of Financial Affairs [Docket Nos. 250 through 253] (collectively, the Schedules). Among other things, the Schedules set forth the claims of known creditors against the
Debtors as of the Petition Date, based upon the Debtors books and records. The Debtors retain the right to amend the Schedules during the pendency of the Chapter 11 Cases. On February 20, 2015, the Debtors filed an Amended Schedule B23
for Dendreon Corporation, to list additional licenses and permits of the Debtors [Docket No. 413].
On February 5, 2015, an order establishing bar dates for filing
claims against the Debtors and approving the form and manner of notice was entered [Docket No. 352] (the Bar Date Order). The Bar Date Order establishes the below deadlines for filing claims against the Debtors (the
Bar Dates).
General Bar Date. Each person or entity (including, without limitation, each individual,
partnership, joint venture, corporation, limited liability company, estate, trust or governmental unit) holding or asserting a claim against one or more of the Debtors that arose (or is deemed to have arisen) on or before the Petition Date
(including any claims arising under section 503(b)(9) of the Bankruptcy Code) is required to file a proof of claim form so that it is actually received by Prime Clerk on or before March 16, 2015 at 4:00 p.m. (Eastern Time) (the General
Bar Date).
Governmental Bar Date. Each governmental unit holding or asserting a claim against one or more of the
Debtors that arose (or is deemed to have arisen) on or before the Petition Date must file a proof of claim form so that it is actually received by Prime Clerk on or before May 11, 2015 at 4:00 p.m. (Eastern Time) (the Governmental Bar
Date).
Rejection Bar Date. If the Debtors reject pursuant to section 365 of the Bankruptcy Code any executory contract
or unexpired lease, each person or entity holding or asserting a claim arising from such rejection must file a proof of claim form so that it is actually received by Prime Clerk on or before the later of (i) the General Bar Date or
(ii) thirty (30) days after entry of any order authorizing the rejection of an executory contract or unexpired lease (the Rejection Bar Date).
The Debtors and their professionals are investigating claims filed
against the Debtors to determine the validity of such claims and anticipate filing objections or have already filed objections to claims that are filed in improper amounts or classifications, or are otherwise subject to objection under the
Bankruptcy Code or other applicable law. As of the filing of this Disclosure Statement, the Debtors have filed objections to the claim of GSK [Docket No. 536];
27
the plaintiffs in the Bolling securities action [Docket No. 537]; and William K. Jenkinson [Docket No. 538]. The Debtors have also filed two omnibus objections to claims [Docket
Nos. 539, 540].
|
d. |
Deerfield Substantial Contribution Claim |
Section 503(b)(3)(D) allows as an
administrative expense costs a creditor incurs in making a substantial contribution in a case under
chapter 11 of the Bankruptcy Code. Section 503(b)(4), in turn, allows reasonable compensation for professional services of an
attorney of a creditor whose expense is allowable under section 503(b)(3)(D). In making a substantial contribution determination, courts consider whether the efforts of the applicant resulted in an actual and demonstrable benefit to the
debtors estate and creditors. As noted, subsequent bidding occurred after the filing of the Stalking Horse Selection Motion. In addition to Valeant, there was one additional bidder, i.e., the Alternative Bidder. Deerfield provided
committed financing to the Alternative Bidder. As counsel to Deerfield, Katten Muchin Rosenman LLP (Katten Muchin) expended significant time and resources during this period drafting the financing documents to support the
Alternative Bidders bid. As a result of this competitive bidding process, the purchase price increased to $400 million, $125 million or 45.5% above the minimum for Qualified Bids. Thus, the Debtors believe Deerfield made a substantial
contribution within the meaning of section 503. Pursuant to Section 9.2 of the Plan, the Deerfield Substantial Contribution Claim will be deemed allowed if there are no objections received by the deadline to object to confirmation of the Plan.
|
e. |
Committee Members Substantial Contribution Claim |
The Debtors also believe that the
Committee Members made a substantial contribution within the meaning of section 503. The Committee Members worked closely with their counsel (i) in evaluating materials related to the sale of substantially all of the Debtors assets,
including bids submitted to the Debtors, (ii) in negotiating with the Debtors and the Supporting Noteholders the terms of the potential plans for disposition of those assets, and (iii) in facilitating compromise among the various parties.
In approving the Sale Transaction and in finding sufficient notice of the Second Amended Acquisition Agreement had been provided, the Court noted the variety of the claimants that the Committee had as part of its constituency. The Court also noted
that the Committee was kept involved and informed throughout the negotiation of the Second Amended Acquisition Agreement. In part based upon this, the Court was able to find sufficient notice and to approve the Sale Transaction, which brought an
effective $415 million of value to the Debtors Estates. The efforts of the Committee Members resulted in an actual and demonstrable benefit to the Debtors Estates and all creditors. Pursuant to Section 9.2 of the Plan, the Committee
Members Substantial Contribution Claims will be deemed allowed if there are no objections received by the deadline to object to confirmation of the Plan.
|
6. |
Extension of Time to Remove Actions |
As of the Petition Date, the Debtors were party to
certain judicial and/or administrative proceedings in various courts and/or administrative agencies (collectively, the Actions). Some of the Actions may be subject to removal to the Court pursuant to 28 U.S.C. § 1452, which
applies to claims relating to bankruptcy cases. Although the Debtors may find it appropriate and
28
beneficial to remove certain of the Actions to federal court, the Debtors had not completed their analysis with respect to desirability or feasibility of removing the Actions as of mid-January
2015. As such, on January 15, 2015, the Debtors filed a motion [Docket No. 274] seeking to extend the February 9, 2015 removal deadline by 150 days through and until July 9, 2015. An order was entered granting the extension of
time for removing the Actions on February 5, 2015 [Docket No. 350].
|
7. |
Motion to Extend Exclusivity |
On March 6, 2015, the Debtors filed the Motion for
Order Under Bankruptcy Code Section 1121(d) Extending Exclusive Periods During Which Debtors May File and Solicit Acceptances of a Chapter 11 Plan (the Motion to Extend Exclusivity) [Docket No. 461]. Bankruptcy Code
section 1121(b) provides for an initial 120-day period after the Petition Date within which a debtor has the exclusive right to file a chapter 11 plan (the Plan Period). Bankruptcy Code section 1121(c) further provides for an
initial 180-day period after the Petition Date within which a debtor has the exclusive right to solicit and obtain acceptances of a plan filed by the debtor during the Plan Period (the Solicitation Period and, together with the
Plan Period, the Exclusive Periods). In the Chapter 11 Cases, the Plan Period is set to expire on March 10, 2015, and the Solicitation Period is set to expire on May 9, 2015. By the Motion to Extend Exclusivity, the
Debtors requested entry of an order (i) extending each of the Exclusive Periods for 110 days, whereby the Plan Period would be extended through June 29, 2015, and the Solicitation Period would be extended through August 27, 2015, and
(ii) prohibiting any party, other than the Debtors, from filing a competing plan or soliciting acceptances of a competing plan during the extended Exclusive Periods.
ARTICLE IV
SUMMARY OF
PLAN
THIS SECTION PROVIDES A SUMMARY OF THE STRUCTURE AND MEANS FOR IMPLEMENTATION OF THE PLAN AND THE CLASSIFICATION AND TREATMENT
OF CLAIMS AND INTERESTS UNDER THE PLAN. THIS SECTION IS QUALIFIED IN ITS ENTIRETY BY AND IS SUBJECT TO THE PLAN AS WELL AS THE EXHIBITS THERETO AND DEFINITIONS THEREIN. THE PLAN IS ATTACHED TO THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT AS EXHIBIT A.
THE STATEMENTS CONTAINED IN THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT INCLUDE SUMMARIES OF THE PROVISIONS CONTAINED IN THE PLAN AND IN DOCUMENTS REFERRED TO
THEREIN. THE STATEMENTS CONTAINED IN THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT DO NOT PURPORT TO BE PRECISE OR COMPLETE STATEMENTS OF ALL THE TERMS AND PROVISIONS OF THE PLAN OR DOCUMENTS REFERRED TO THEREIN. REFERENCE IS MADE TO THE PLAN AND TO SUCH DOCUMENTS FOR
THE FULL AND COMPLETE STATEMENTS OF SUCH TERMS AND PROVISIONS.
THE PLAN ITSELF AND THE DOCUMENTS REFERRED TO THEREIN CONTROL THE ACTUAL
TREATMENT OF CLAIMS AGAINST AND INTERESTS IN THE DEBTORS UNDER THE PLAN. UPON OCCURRENCE OF THE EFFECTIVE DATE, THE PLAN
29
AND ALL SUCH DOCUMENTS WILL BE BINDING UPON ALL HOLDERS OF CLAIMS AGAINST AND INTERESTS IN THE DEBTORS AND THEIR ESTATES AND ALL OTHER PARTIES IN INTEREST. IN THE EVENT OF ANY CONFLICT BETWEEN
THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT, ON THE ONE HAND, AND THE PLAN, THE PLAN ADMINISTRATOR AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER OPERATIVE DOCUMENT, ON THE OTHER HAND, THE TERMS OF THE PLAN, THE PLAN ADMINISTRATOR AGREEMENT AND SUCH OTHER OPERATIVE DOCUMENT WILL CONTROL.
A. |
Classification and Treatment of Claims and Interests |
Section 1123 of the
Bankruptcy Code provides that a plan must classify the claims and interests of a debtors creditors and equity interest holders. In accordance with section 1123 of the Bankruptcy Code, the Plan divides Claims and Interests into Classes and sets
forth the treatment for each Class (other than Administrative Claims and Priority Tax Claims, which pursuant to section 1123(a)(1) of the Bankruptcy Code need not be and have not been classified. The Debtors also are required, under section 1122 of
the Bankruptcy Code, to classify Claims against and Interests in, the Debtors (except for certain claims classified for administrative convenience) into Classes that contain Claims and Interests that are substantially similar to the other Claims and
Interests in such Class.
The Bankruptcy Code also requires that a plan provide the same treatment for each claim or interest of a
particular class unless the claim holder or interest holder agrees to a less favorable treatment of its claim or interest. The Debtors believe that they have complied with such standard. If the Court finds otherwise, however, it could deny
confirmation of the Plan if the Claimholders and Interest Holders affected do not consent to the treatment afforded them under the Plan.
A Claim or Interest is placed in a particular Class only to the extent that the Claim or Interest falls within the description of that Class,
and is classified in other Classes to the extent that any portion of the Claim or Interest falls within the description of such other Classes. A Claim also is placed in a particular Class for the purpose of receiving Distributions pursuant to the
Plan only to the extent that such Claim is an Allowed Claim in that Class and such Claim has not been paid, released or otherwise settled prior to the Effective Date.
The Debtors believe that the Plan has classified all Claims and Interests in compliance with the provisions of section 1122 of the Bankruptcy
Code and applicable case law. It is possible that a holder of a Claim or Interest may challenge the Debtors classification of Claims and Interests and that the Court may find that a different classification is required for the Plan to be
confirmed. If such a situation develops, the Debtors intend, in accordance with the terms of the Plan, to make such permissible modifications to the Plan as may be necessary to permit its confirmation. Any such reclassification could adversely
affect holders of Claims by changing the composition of one or more Classes and the vote required of such Class or Classes for approval of the Plan. UNLESS SUCH MODIFICATION OF CLASSIFICATION MATERIALLY ADVERSELY AFFECTS THE TREATMENT OF A HOLDER OF
A CLAIM AND REQUIRES RESOLICITATION, ACCEPTANCE OF THE PLAN BY ANY HOLDER OF A CLAIM OR INTEREST PURSUANT TO THIS SOLICITATION WILL BE DEEMED TO BE A CONSENT TO THE PLANS TREATMENT OF SUCH HOLDER OF A CLAIM
30
REGARDLESS OF THE CLASS AS TO WHICH SUCH HOLDER ULTIMATELY IS DEEMED TO BE A MEMBER.
The amount of any Impaired Claim that ultimately is Allowed by the Court may vary from any estimated Allowed amount of such Claim and,
accordingly, the total Claims that are ultimately Allowed by the Court with respect to each Impaired Class of Claims may also vary from any estimates contained herein with respect to the aggregate Claims in any Impaired Class. Thus, the value of
property that ultimately will be received by a particular Holder of an Allowed Claim may be adversely or favorably affected by the aggregate amount of Claims Allowed in the applicable Class.
The classification of Claims and Interests and the nature of Distributions to members of each Class are summarized below. The Debtors believe
that the consideration, if any, provided under the Plan to holders of Claims and Interests reflects an appropriate resolution of their Claims and Interests, taking into account the differing nature and priority (including applicable contractual
subordination) of such Claims and Interests. The Court must find, however, that a number of statutory tests are met before it may confirm the Plan. Many of these tests are designed to protect the interests of holders of Claims or Interests who are
not entitled to vote on the Plan, or do not vote to accept the Plan, but who will be bound by the provisions of the Plan if it is confirmed by the Court.
An Administrative Claim means a Claim for payment of an
administrative expense of a kind specified in sections 503(b) or 1114(e)(2) of the Bankruptcy Code and entitled to priority in payment under sections 507(a)(2) or 507(b) of the Bankruptcy Code, including: (a) the actual and necessary costs and
expenses incurred after the Petition Date of preserving the Estates and operating the businesses of the Debtors (such as wages, salaries or commissions for services and payments for goods and other services and leased premises) and Claims by
Governmental Units for taxes accruing after the Petition Date (but excluding Claims related to taxes accruing on or before the Petition Date); (b) Professional Fee Claims; (c) all fees and charges assessed against the Estates under 28
U.S.C. § 1930; (d) obligations designated as Administrative Claims pursuant to an order of the Court; and (e) Claims under section 503(b)(9) of the Bankruptcy Code.
On the later of (i) the Distribution Date or (ii) the date such Administrative Claim becomes an Allowed Administrative Claim (or as
soon as reasonably practicable thereafter), a Holder of an Allowed Administrative Claim (other than a Professional) will receive, in full satisfaction, settlement and discharge of, and in exchange for, such Allowed Administrative Claim,
(a) Cash equal to the unpaid portion of the Face Amount of such Allowed Administrative Claim or (b) such other lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, will have agreed upon in
writing; provided, however, that Allowed Administrative Claims with respect to liabilities incurred by a Debtor in the ordinary course of business during the Chapter 11 Cases may be paid in the ordinary course of business in accordance
with the terms and conditions of any agreements relating thereto (x) on or prior to the
31
Effective Date, by the Debtors, and (y) after the Effective Date, by the Disbursing Agent. Allowed Professional Fee Claims will be paid from the Professional Fee Reserve pursuant to
Section 5.9(a) of the Plan. For the avoidance of doubt, any payments made by the Plan Administrator on account of Allowed Administrative Claims (other than Professional Fee Claims) will be paid solely from the Administrative and Priority Claims
Reserve.
A Priority Tax Claim means any Claim accorded priority in right of
payment under section 507(a)(8) of the Bankruptcy Code.
On the later of (i) the Distribution Date or (ii) the date such
Priority Tax Claim becomes an Allowed Priority Tax Claim (or as soon as reasonably practicable thereafter), a Holder of an Allowed Priority Tax Claim will receive, in full satisfaction, settlement and discharge of, and in exchange for, such Allowed
Priority Tax Claim, (a) Cash equal to the unpaid portion of the Face Amount of such Allowed Priority Tax Claim or (b) such other lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, will have
agreed upon in writing. For the avoidance of doubt, any payments made by the Plan Administrator on account of Allowed Priority Tax Claims will be paid solely from the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve.
|
a. |
Class 1: Priority Non-Tax Claims |
A Priority Non-Tax Claim means any Claim accorded
priority in right of payment under section 507(a) of the Bankruptcy Code, other than a Priority Tax Claim or an Administrative Claim.
On
the later of (i) the Distribution Date or (ii) the date such Priority Non-Tax Claim becomes an Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim (or as soon as reasonably practicable thereafter), a Holder of an Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim will receive, in
full satisfaction, settlement, release and discharge of, and in exchange for, such Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim, (a) Cash equal to the unpaid portion of the Face Amount of such Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim or (b) such other treatment
as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, will have agreed upon in writing.
|
b. |
Class 2: Secured Claims |
A Secured Claim means a Claim (a) that is secured by a
Lien on property in which an Estate has an interest, which Lien is valid, perfected and enforceable under applicable law or by reason of a Final Order, or (b) that is subject to setoff under section 553 of the Bankruptcy Code and such right of
setoff has been asserted by the holder of such right prior to the Confirmation Date in a properly filed motion for relief from the automatic stay, to the extent of the value of the Claimholders interest in the Estates interest in such
property or to the extent of the amount subject to setoff, as applicable, as determined pursuant to section 506(a) of the Bankruptcy Code.
32
On the later of (i) the Distribution Date or (ii) the date such Secured Claim becomes
an Allowed Secured Claim (or as soon as reasonably practicable thereafter), a Holder of an Allowed Secured Claim will receive, in full satisfaction, settlement and discharge of, and in exchange for, such Allowed Secured Claim, (a) Cash equal to
the value of such Allowed Secured Claim, (b) a return of the Collateral securing the Secured Claim, (c) such treatment required under section 1124(2) of the Bankruptcy Code for such Claim to be rendered Unimpaired or (d) such other
lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, will have agreed upon in writing.
Any
Holder of a Secured Claim will retain its Lien in the Collateral or the proceeds of the Collateral (to the extent that such Collateral is sold by the Debtors or the Plan Administrator free and clear of such Lien) to the same extent and with the same
priority as such Lien held as of Petition Date until such time as (A) the Holder of such Secured Claim (i) has been paid Cash equal to the value of its Allowed Secured Claim, (ii) has received a return of the Collateral securing the
Secured Claim, (iii) has received such treatment required under section 1124(2) of the Bankruptcy Code for such Claim to be rendered Unimpaired, or (iv) has been afforded such other lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors
or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, will have agreed upon in writing; or (B) such purported Lien has been determined by an order of the Court to be invalid or otherwise avoidable.
|
a. |
Class 3: 2016 Noteholder Claims |
A 2016 Noteholder Claim means, individually, a Claim
of a holder of the 2016 Notes arising under or as a result of such notes and, collectively, the Claims of all such holders arising under or as a result of such notes, which Claims will be deemed Allowed in the aggregate amount of $625,694,097.22 as
of the Effective Date.
On the Distribution Date, and from time to time thereafter in accordance with the Plan, each Holder of an Allowed
2016 Noteholder Claim will receive, in full satisfaction of, and in exchange for, such Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claim, (i) its Pro Rata share of 100% of the Valeant Shares (which will be distributed immediately upon the occurrence of the
Effective Date) and (ii) its Pro Rata share of Available Cash in the amount necessary to provide such Holder its Pro Rata share of Total Distributable Value available to Holders of Class 3 Claims and Class 4 Claims, or (iii) such other
lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, will have agreed upon in writing; provided, however, that each Holder of an Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claim will not receive an amount
that exceeds 100% of the amount of such Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claim.
|
b. |
Class 4: General Unsecured Claims |
A General Unsecured Claim means a Claim against any
or all of the Debtors that is not an Administrative Claim, Priority Tax Claim, Secured Claim, Priority Non-Tax Claim, Intercompany Claim, Subordinated Claim or 2016 Noteholder Claim.
On the Distribution Date, and from time to time thereafter in accordance with the Plan, each Holder of an Allowed General Unsecured Claim will
receive, in full satisfaction of, and in
33
exchange for, such Allowed General Unsecured Claim, (i) its Pro Rata share of Total Distributable Value available to Holders of Class 3 and Class 4 Claims, solely in the form of Available
Cash or (ii) such other lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, will have agreed upon in writing; provided, however, that each Holder of an Allowed General Unsecured Claim
will not receive an amount that exceeds 100% of the amount of such Allowed General Unsecured Claim.
|
c. |
Class 5: Intercompany Claims |
An Intercompany Claim means any Claim, if any, held by a
Debtor against another Debtor, including, without limitation: (i) any account reflecting intercompany book entries by a Debtor with respect to another Debtor, (ii) any Claim not reflected in such book entries that is held by a Debtor
against another Debtor, and (iii) any derivative Claim asserted by or on behalf of one Debtor against another Debtor.
In connection
with, and as a result of, the substantive consolidation of the Debtors Estates and the Chapter 11 Cases, on the Effective Date, all Intercompany Claims will be eliminated and the Holders of Intercompany Claims will not be entitled to, and will
not receive or retain, any property or interest in property on account of such Claims.
|
d. |
Class 6: Subordinated Claims |
A Subordinated Claim means any Claim subordinated
pursuant to sections 510(b) or 510(c) of the Bankruptcy Code.
On the Effective Date, all Subordinated Claims will be eliminated and the
Holders of Subordinated Claims will not be entitled to, and will not receive or retain, any property or interest in property on account of such Claims.
Interest means the legal interests, equitable interests,
contractual interests, equity interests or ownership interests, or other rights of any Person in the Debtors, including all capital stock, stock certificates, common stock, preferred stock, partnership interests, limited liability company or
membership interests, rights, treasury stock, options, warrants, contingent warrants, convertible or exchangeable securities, investment securities, subscriptions or other agreements and contractual rights to acquire or obtain such an interest or
share in the Debtors, partnership interests in the Debtors stock appreciation rights, conversion rights, repurchase rights, redemption rights, dividend rights, preemptive rights, subscription rights and liquidation preferences, puts, calls,
awards or commitments of any character whatsoever relating to any such equity, common stock, preferred stock, ownership interests or other shares of capital stock of the Debtors or obligating the Debtors to issue, transfer or sell any shares of
capital stock whether or not certificated, transferable, voting or denominated stock or a similar security.
34
On the Effective Date, the Interests will be deemed eliminated, cancelled and/or extinguished and
each Holder thereof will not be entitled to, and will not receive or retain, any property under the Plan on account of such Interest.
|
a. |
Class 8: Intercompany Interests |
Intercompany Interest means an Interest in a Debtor
held by another Debtor.
On the Effective Date, the Intercompany Interests will be reinstated and rendered Unimpaired in accordance with
section 1124 of the Bankruptcy Code.
|
6. |
Special Provision Regarding Unimpaired Claims |
Except as otherwise provided in the
Plan, the Confirmation Order, any other order of the Court or any document or agreement enforceable pursuant to the terms of the Plan, nothing will affect the rights and defenses, both legal and equitable, of the Debtors and the Plan Administrator
with respect to any Unimpaired Claims, including, but not limited to, all rights with respect to legal and equitable defenses to setoffs or recoupments against Unimpaired Claims and the rights to assert all Causes of Action against the holders of
such Unimpaired Claims that the Debtors had immediately prior to the Petition Date as if the Chapter 11 Cases had not been commenced.
Notwithstanding any provision in the Plan to the contrary, the
Disbursing Agent will only make Distributions to Holders of Allowed Claims. No Holder of a Disputed Claim will receive any Distribution on account thereof until (and then only to the extent that) its Disputed Claim becomes an Allowed Claim. The
Debtors and/or the Plan Administrator may, in their discretion, withhold Distributions otherwise due under the Plan to any Claimholder until the Claims Objection Deadline, to enable a timely objection thereto to be filed. Any Holder of a Claim that
becomes an Allowed Claim after the Effective Date will receive its Distribution in accordance with the terms and provisions of the Plan.
|
8. |
Special Provisions Regarding Insured Claims |
Distributions under the Plan to each
Holder of an Insured Claim will be in accordance with the treatment provided under the Plan for the Class in which such Insured Claim is classified; provided, however, that the maximum amount of any Distribution under the Plan on
account of an Allowed Insured Claim will be limited to an amount equal to: (a) the applicable deductible or self-insured retention under the relevant insurance policy minus (b) any reimbursement obligations of the Debtors to the insurance
carrier for sums expended by the insurance carrier on account of such Claim (including defense costs); provided further, however, that, to the extent that a Claimholder has an Allowed Insured Claim, the amount of which exceeds
the total coverage available from the relevant insurance policies of the Debtors, such Claimholder will have an Allowed General Unsecured Claim in the amount by which such Allowed Insured Claim exceeds the coverage available from the relevant
Debtors insurance
35
policies. Nothing in this Section will constitute a waiver of any Cause of Action the Debtors may hold against any Person, including the Debtors insurance carriers, or is intended to, will
or will be deemed to preclude any Holder of an Allowed Insured Claim from seeking and/or obtaining a distribution or other recovery from any insurer of the Debtors in addition to any Distribution such Holder may receive under the Plan;
provided, however, that the Debtors do not waive, and expressly reserve their rights to assert that any insurance coverage is property of the Estates to which they are entitled.
The Plan will not expand the scope of, or alter in any other way, the obligations of the Debtors insurers under their policies, and the
Debtors insurers will retain any and all defenses to coverage that such insurers may have. The Plan will not operate as a waiver of any other Claims the Debtors insurers have asserted or may assert in any Proof of Claim or the
Debtors rights and defenses to such Proofs of Claim.
B. |
Means for Implementation of the Plan |
|
1. |
Substantive Consolidation |
|
a. |
Consolidation of the Chapter 11 Estates |
The Plan contemplates and is predicated upon
entry of an order substantively consolidating the Debtors Estates and Chapter 11 Cases for all purposes, including voting, Distribution and Confirmation. On the Effective Date, (i) all Intercompany Claims, if any, between the Debtors will
be eliminated, (ii) all assets and liabilities of the Affiliate Debtors will be merged or treated as if they were merged with the assets and liabilities of Dendreon, (iii) any obligation of a Debtor and any guarantee thereof by the other
Debtor will be deemed to be one obligation of Dendreon, and any such guarantee will be eliminated, (iv) the issued and outstanding Intercompany Interests will be reinstated, (v) each Claim Filed or to be Filed against any Debtor will be
deemed Filed only against Dendreon and will be deemed a single Claim against and a single obligation of Dendreon, and (vi) any joint or several liability of the Debtors will be deemed one obligation of Dendreon. On the Effective Date, and in
accordance with the terms of the Plan and the consolidation of the assets and liabilities of the Debtors, all Claims based upon guarantees of collection, payment or performance made by one Debtor as to the obligations of another Debtor will be
released and of no further force and effect.
The substantive consolidation effected pursuant to Section 5.1(a) of the Plan
(x) will not affect the rights of any Holder of a Secured Claim with respect to the Collateral securing such Claims and (y) will not, and will not be deemed to, prejudice the Causes of Action and the Avoidance Actions (subject to the
releases set forth in Section 10.4 of the Plan), which will survive entry of the Substantive Consolidation Order, as if there had been no substantive consolidation. Notwithstanding the substantive consolidation provided for herein, each and
every Debtor will remain responsible for the payment of fees pursuant to 28 U.S.C. § 1930 until a particular case is closed, dismissed or converted.
|
b. |
Substantive Consolidation Order |
The Plan will serve as, and will be deemed to be, a
motion for entry of an order substantively consolidating the Debtors Chapter 11 Cases. If no objection to substantive
36
consolidation is timely Filed and served by any Holder of an Impaired Claim affected by the Plan as provided in the Plan on or before the deadline to object to Confirmation of the Plan, or such
other date as may be fixed by the Court, the Substantive Consolidation Order (which may be the Confirmation Order) may be approved by the Court. If any such objections are timely Filed and served, a hearing with respect to the substantive
consolidation of the Chapter 11 Cases and the objections thereto will be scheduled by the Court, which hearing may, but is not required to, coincide with the Confirmation Hearing.
|
a. |
Merger and Dissolution of Debtors |
Immediately following the occurrence of the
Effective Date, (a) the respective boards of directors of the Debtors will be terminated and the members of the boards of directors of the Debtors will be deemed to have resigned and (b) the Debtors will continue to exist as the
Liquidating Debtors after the Effective Date in accordance with the laws of the State of Delaware and pursuant to their respective certificates of incorporation, by-laws, articles of formation, operating agreements, and other organizational
documents in effect prior to the Effective Date, except to the extent such organizational documents are amended under the Plan, for the limited purposes of liquidating all of the assets of the Estates and making Distributions in accordance with the
Plan.
On December 31, 2015 (the Outside Date), and without further order of the Court, the Affiliate Debtors will
be deemed merged with and into Dendreon, without the necessity of any other or further actions to be taken by or on behalf of the Debtors or payments to be made in connection therewith; provided, however, that the Debtors, the
Liquidating Debtors or the Plan Administrator may execute and file documents and take all other actions as they deem appropriate relating to the foregoing corporate actions under the laws of the State of Delaware and, in such event, all applicable
regulatory or governmental agencies will take all steps necessary to allow and effect the prompt merger of the Affiliate Debtors as provided in the Plan, without the payment of any fee, Tax or charge and without need for the filing of reports or
certificates.
Moreover, on and after the first day following the Outside Date, the Affiliate Debtors (i) will be deemed to have
withdrawn their business operations from any state in which they were previously conducting, or are registered or licensed to conduct, their business operations, and will not be required to file any document, pay any sum or take any other action in
order to effectuate such withdrawal, and (ii) will not be liable in any manner to any taxing or other authority for franchise, business, license or similar Taxes accruing on or after the Outside Date.
As soon as practicable after the Plan Administrator exhausts substantially all of the assets of the Debtors Estates by making the final
Distribution of Cash under the Plan, the Plan Administrator will at the expense of the Debtors Estates (i) provide for the retention and storage of the books, records and files that will have been delivered to or created by the Plan
Administrator until such time as all such books, records and files are no longer required to be retained under applicable law, and File a certificate informing the Court of the location at which such books, records and files are being stored;
provided that any Tax records will be turned over
37
to the Purchaser in accordance with the Asset Purchase Agreement no later than the issuance of the final decree in the Chapter 11 Cases; (ii) File a certification stating that the assets of
the Debtors Estates have been exhausted and final Distributions of Cash have been made under the Plan; (iii) File the necessary paperwork in the state of Delaware to effectuate the dissolution of Dendreon in accordance with the laws of
such jurisdiction; and (iv) resign as the sole shareholder, officer, director and manager, as applicable, of the Liquidating Debtors. Upon the Filing of the certificate described in clause (ii) of the preceding sentence, Dendreon will be
deemed dissolved for all purposes without the necessity for any other or further actions to be taken by or on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors or payments to be made in connection therewith other than the filing of a motion for final decree.
In furtherance of the liquidation of the Liquidating Debtors and as necessary to comply with section 8.1(h) of the Asset Purchase Agreement,
on or prior to December 31, 2015, a liquidating trust may be established pursuant to documentation, including a liquidating trust agreement, approved by the Liquidating Debtors, the Plan Administrator and the Oversight Committee, for the
primary purpose of receiving assets of the Estates, continuing the wind down of such Estates in a commercially reasonable but expeditious manner, and distributing any such assets pursuant to this Plan, with no objective to continue or engage in the
conduct of a trade or business except to the extent reasonably necessary to and consistent with, the liquidating purpose of the trust (any such trust, the Liquidating Trust).
If established, the Liquidating Trust will be structured to qualify as a liquidating trust within the meaning of Treasury
Regulations Section 301.7701-4(d) and in compliance with Revenue Procedure 94-45, 1994-2 C.B. 684, and, thus, as a grantor trust within the meaning of Sections 671 through 679 of the Tax Code to the Holders of Claims, consistent
with the terms of the Plan; provided, however, that the Plan Administrator in its role as liquidating trustee, after consultation with the Oversight Committee, may make an election under Treasury Regulations
Section 1.468B-9(c)(2)(ii) to treat the Liquidating Trust (or any portion thereof) as a disputed ownership fund. Accordingly, unless an election is made to treat the Liquidating Trust as a disputed ownership fund, such Holders will be
treated for U.S. federal income tax purposes, (i) as direct recipients of an undivided interest in the assets transferred to the Liquidating Trust and as having immediately contributed such assets to the Liquidating Trust, and
(ii) thereafter, as the grantors and deemed owners of the Liquidating Trust and thus, the direct owners of an undivided interest in the assets held by the Liquidating Trust. All parties (including Claimholders) will report consistent with
the valuation of the assets transferred to the Liquidating Trust as established by the Plan Administrator or its designee. The Plan Administrator will be deemed appointed in such instance pursuant to section 1123(b)(3)(B) of the Bankruptcy Code
to handle all of the Debtors tax matters, including without limitation, the filing of all tax returns, and the handling of tax audits and proceedings, of the Debtors. The liquidating trustee will be responsible for filing information on behalf
of the Liquidating Trust as grantor trust pursuant to Treasury Regulation Section 1.671-4(a) or as a disputed ownership fund.
|
b. |
Certificate of Incorporation and By-laws |
The certificate and articles of incorporation
and by-laws of each Debtor will be amended as necessary to satisfy the provisions of the Plan and the Bankruptcy Code and will include, among other things, a provision (a) prohibiting the issuance of non-voting equity securities under
38
section 1123(a)(6) of the Bankruptcy Code and (b) limiting the activities of the Liquidating Debtors to matters authorized under the Plan. The amended certificate of incorporation and
by-laws of each Debtor will be reasonably acceptable to the Committee, the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders and the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders and will be Filed on or before the date of the Confirmation Hearing.
|
c. |
Cancellation of Existing Securities and Agreements |
Except as otherwise provided in the
Plan, and in any contract, instrument or other agreement or document created in connection with the Plan, on the Effective Date and concurrently with the applicable Distributions made pursuant to Article III of the Plan, any promissory notes, share
certificates, whether for preferred or common stock (including treasury stock), other instruments evidencing any Claims or Interests, other than a Claim or Interest that is being reinstated and rendered unimpaired, and all options, warrants, calls,
rights, puts, awards, commitments or any other agreements of any character to acquire such Interests will be deemed cancelled and of no further force and effect, without any further act or action under any applicable agreement, law, regulation,
order or rule, and the obligations of the Debtors under the notes, share certificates and other agreements and instruments governing such Claims and Interests will be discharged; provided, however, that certain instruments, documents
and credit agreements related to Claims will continue in effect solely for the purposes of allowing the agents to make distributions to the beneficial holders and lenders thereunder. The holders of or parties to such cancelled notes, share
certificates and other agreements and instruments will have no rights arising from or relating to such notes, share certificates and other agreements and instruments or the cancellation thereof, except the rights provided pursuant to the Plan.
The Final Order Pursuant to Bankruptcy Code Sections 105(a), 362(a)(3) and 541 and Bankruptcy Rule 3001 Establishing Notice and Hearing
Procedures for Trading in Equity Securities in Debtors [Docket No. 162], entered on December 9, 2014, will remain in full force and effect on and after the Effective Date to enforce any violations of such order that occurred prior to the
Effective Date.
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the Plan, on the Effective Date and concurrently with the applicable
Distributions made pursuant to Article III of the Plan, the 2016 Notes Indenture will be cancelled except to the extent required for the purposes of permitting the 2016 Notes Trustee to enforce its right to compensation and related lien rights under
section 6.07 of the 2016 Notes Indenture, subject to Section 5.14 of the Plan.
Each of the matters provided for under the Plan involving the
corporate structure of the Debtors or corporate action to be taken by or required of the Debtors will, as of the Effective Date, be deemed to have occurred and be effective as provided in the Plan, and will be authorized and approved in all respects
without any requirement of further action by any Person, including but not limited to, the Plan Administrator, Holders of Claims or Interests against or in the Debtors, or directors or officers of the Debtors, as permitted by section 303 of the
Delaware General Corporation Law.
39
|
e. |
Effectuating Documents |
Prior to the Effective Date, any appropriate officer of
Dendreon or the Affiliate Debtors, as the case may be, will be authorized to execute, deliver, file or record such contracts, instruments, releases, indentures and other agreements or documents, and take such actions as may be necessary or
appropriate to effectuate and further evidence the terms and conditions of the Plan. The secretary of Dendreon or the Affiliate Debtors, as the case may be, will be authorized to certify or attest to any of the foregoing actions.
|
f. |
Directors and Officers; Further Transactions |
Immediately upon the occurrence of the
Effective Date, the Plan Administrator will serve as the sole shareholder, officer, director or manager of each of the Liquidating Debtors. The Plan Administrator will be authorized to execute, deliver, file or record such documents, instruments,
releases and other agreements and to take such actions as may be necessary or appropriate to effectuate and further evidence the terms and conditions of the Plan.
|
3. |
Compliance with the Asset Purchase Agreement |
Notwithstanding anything in the Plan to
the contrary, nothing in the Plan will eliminate any post-closing obligations of the Debtors under the Asset Purchase Agreement, including, without limitation, that (i) the Valeant Shares may be distributed proportionately solely to the Holders
of the Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims provided that the total amount of Allowed General Unsecured Claims does not exceed $200 million, and (ii) Dendreon will liquidate as determined for U.S. federal income tax purposes no later than
December 31, 2015.
|
a. |
Legal Representation of the Debtors and Committee After the Effective Date |
Upon the
Effective Date, the attorney-client relationship between (i) the Debtors and their current counsel, Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP, and (ii) the Committee and its current counsel, Sullivan & Cromwell LLP, and
Young Conaway Stargatt & Taylor, LLP, will be deemed terminated. No successor to the Debtors and/or the Committee, whether under the Plan or otherwise, including but not limited to the Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator, will be
deemed to succeed to the attorney-client relationship that currently exists between the Debtors and its counsel and the Committee and its counsel. Subject only to the applicable ethical rules governing attorneys, their receipt of confidential
information and their relationship with former clients, current counsel for the Debtors or the Committee will not be precluded from representing any party in any action that might be brought by or against the Liquidating Debtors and/or the Plan
Administrator.
|
b. |
Transfer of Evidentiary Privileges; Document Requests |
On the Effective Date, the
Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator will succeed to the evidentiary privileges, including attorney-client privilege, formerly held by the Debtors.
40
Accordingly, to the extent that documents are requested from current counsel to the Debtors by
any Person, after the Effective Date, only the Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator will have the ability to waive such attorney-client or other privileges. In addition, unless otherwise ordered by the Court, current counsel to the Debtors
will have no obligation to produce any documents currently in their possession as a result of or arising in any way out of their representation of the Debtors unless (i) the Person requesting such documents serves their request on the Plan
Administrator; (ii) the Plan Administrator consents in writing to such production and any waiver of the attorney-client or other privilege such production might cause; and (iii) the Plan Administrator or the Person requesting such
production, agrees to pay the reasonable costs and expenses incurred by current counsel for the Debtors in connection with such production.
|
5. |
Dissolution of the Committee |
The Committee will continue in existence until the
Effective Date to exercise those powers and perform those duties specified in section 1103 of the Bankruptcy Code and will perform such other duties as it may have been assigned by the Court prior to the Effective Date. On the Effective Date, the
Committee will be dissolved and its members will have no further duties, responsibilities and obligations in connection with the Chapter 11 Cases or the Plan and its implementation, and the retention or employment of the Committees attorneys,
financial advisors and other agents will terminate, except with respect to (i) all Professional Fee Claims and (ii) any appeals of the Confirmation Order. All expenses of Committee members and the reasonable fees and expenses of the
Committees Professionals through the Effective Date will be paid in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Professional Fee Order and/or the Plan, as applicable. Professionals employed by the Committee will be entitled to reasonable
compensation and reimbursement of actual, necessary expenses for post-Effective Date activities, including the preparation, filing and prosecution of final fee applications.
|
6. |
The Plan Administrator |
|
a. |
Appointment of the Plan Administrator |
From and after the Effective Date, a Person or
Entity to be designated by the Debtors, and subject to the consent of the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders, the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders, and the Committee, which consent will not be unreasonably withheld, will serve
as the Plan Administrator pursuant to the Plan Administrator Agreement and the Plan, until the resignation or discharge and the appointment of a successor Plan Administrator in accordance with the Plan Administrator Agreement and the Plan. The
Debtors will file a notice providing the information set forth in sections 1129(a)(4) and (5) of the Bankruptcy Code on a date that is not less than ten (10) days prior to the hearing to consider confirmation of the Plan designating the
Person who it has selected as Plan Administrator. The appointment of the Plan Administrator will be approved in the Confirmation Order, and such appointment will be as of the Effective Date. The Plan Administrator will have and perform all of the
duties, responsibilities, rights and obligations set forth in the Plan and Plan Administrator Agreement.
41
|
b. |
The Plan Administrator Agreement |
Prior to or on the Effective Date, the Debtors will
execute a Plan Administrator Agreement in substantially the same form as set forth in Exhibit A to the Plan, which will be reasonably acceptable to the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders, the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders,
and the Committee. Any nonmaterial modifications to the Plan Administrator Agreement made by the Debtors, and reasonably acceptable to the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders, the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders, and the
Committee, prior to the Effective Date are deemed ratified by the Plan. The Plan Administrator Agreement will contain provisions permitting the amendment or modification of the Plan Administrator Agreement necessary to implement the provisions of
the Plan.
|
c. |
Rights, Powers and Duties of the Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator |
The
Liquidating Debtors will retain and have all the rights, powers and duties necessary to carry out its responsibilities under the Plan. Such rights, powers and duties, which will be exercisable by the Plan Administrator on behalf of the Liquidating
Debtors and the Estates pursuant to the Plan and the Plan Administrator Agreement, will include, among others, (i) investigating and, if appropriate, pursuing Causes of Action, (ii) administering and pursuing the Liquidating Debtors
assets, (iii) resolving all Disputed Claims and any Claim objections pending as of the Effective Date and (iv) making Distributions to Holders of Allowed Claims as provided for in the Plan.
|
d. |
Compensation of the Plan Administrator |
The Plan Administrator will be compensated from
the Wind-down Reserve pursuant to the terms of the Plan Administrator Agreement. Any professionals retained by the Plan Administrator will be entitled to reasonable compensation for services rendered and reimbursement of expenses incurred from the
Wind-down Reserve. The payment of the fees and expenses of the Plan Administrator and its retained professionals will be made in the ordinary course of business and will not be subject to the approval of the Court; provided, however,
that any disputes related to such fees and expenses will be brought before the Court.
The Liquidating Debtors will indemnify and hold harmless (i) the
Plan Administrator (in its capacity as such and as officer and director of the Liquidating Debtors), (ii) such individuals that may serve as officers and directors of the Liquidating Debtors, if any, and (iii) the Plan Administrator
Professionals (collectively, the Indemnified Parties), from and against and with respect to any and all liabilities, losses, damages, claims, costs and expenses, including but not limited to attorneys fees arising out of or
due to their actions or omissions, or consequences of such actions or omissions, other than acts or omissions resulting from such Indemnified Partys willful misconduct or gross negligence, with respect to the Liquidating Debtors or the
implementation or administration of the Plan or Plan Administrator Agreement. To the extent an Indemnified Party asserts a claim for indemnification as provided above, the legal fees and related costs incurred by counsel to the Plan Administrator in
monitoring and participating in the
42
defense of such claims giving rise to the asserted right of indemnification will be advanced to such Indemnified Party (and such Indemnified Party undertakes to repay such amounts if it
ultimately will be determined that such Indemnified Party is not entitled to be indemnified therefore) out of the Wind-down Reserve or any insurance purchased using the Wind-down Reserve. The indemnification provisions of the Plan Administrator
Agreement will remain available to and be binding upon any former Plan Administrator or the estate of any decedent of the Plan Administrator and will survive the termination of the Plan Administrator Agreement.
The Plan Administrator will be authorized to obtain and pay for out of the
Wind-down Reserve all reasonably necessary insurance coverage for itself, its agents, representatives, employees or independent contractors, and the Liquidating Debtors, including, but not limited to, coverage with respect to (i) any property
that is or may in the future become the property of the Liquidating Debtors or their Estates and (ii) the liabilities, duties and obligations of the Plan Administrator and its agents, representatives, employees or independent contractors under
the Plan Administrator Agreement (in the form of an errors and omissions policy or otherwise), the latter of which insurance coverage may remain in effect for a reasonable period of time as determined by the Plan Administrator after the termination
of the Plan Administrator Agreement.
Except as expressly provided elsewhere in the Plan, on the
Effective Date, the property of each Debtors Estate, if any, will revest in the applicable Liquidating Debtor.
|
7. |
Distributions to Holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims and General Unsecured Claims |
On the Distribution Date, the Plan Administrator will make, or
will make adequate reserves in the Disputed Claims Reserve for, the Distributions required to be made under the Plan to Holders of Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims and Allowed General Unsecured Claims. The Disbursing Agent will not make any
Distributions to the Holders of Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims or Allowed General Unsecured Claims unless the Plan Administrator retains and reserves in the Disputed Claims Reserve such amounts as are required under Section 6.9(c) of the Plan.
The Disbursing Agent will make interim Distributions of Cash in
accordance with the Plan (i) to Holders of Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims and Allowed General Unsecured Claims at least once each three-month period, unless the aggregate amount of such Distributions, except for the last anticipated
Distributions, is $100,000.00 or less, and (ii) from the Disputed Claims Reserve as Disputed General Unsecured Claims become Allowed Claims.
43
The Liquidating Debtors will be dissolved and their affairs wound
up and the Plan Administrator will make the final Distributions on the date when, (A) in the reasonable judgment of the Plan Administrator, substantially all of the assets of the Liquidating Debtors have been liquidated and there are no
substantial potential sources of additional Cash for Distribution, and (B) there remain no substantial Disputed Claims. The date on which the Plan Administrator determines that all obligations under the Plan and Plan Administrator Agreement
have been satisfied is referred to as the Plan Termination Date. On the Plan Termination Date, the Plan Administrator will, to the extent not already done, request that the Court enter an order closing the Chapter 11 Cases.
Upon dissolution of the Liquidating Debtors in accordance with Section 5.2(a) of the Plan, if the Plan Administrator reasonably
determines that any remaining assets of the Liquidating Debtors are valued at $10,000.00 or less, or exceed the amounts required to be paid under the Plan, the Plan Administrator will transfer such remaining funds to a charitable institution
selected by the Plan Administrator, which charitable institution will be qualified as a not-for-profit corporation under applicable federal and state laws. If the Plan Administrator determines that any remaining assets of the Liquidating Debtors are
valued at more than $10,000.00, the Plan Administrator may seek to transfer such remaining assets to a charitable institution in accordance with Section 5.7(c) of the Plan upon a motion to the Court.
|
8. |
Limited Release of Liens |
On the Effective Date, all mortgages, deeds of trust, liens
or other security interests against property of the Estates will be released, subject to the requirements of Section 3.2(b) of the Plan.
|
a. |
Professional Fee Reserve |
On or before the Effective Date, the Debtors will create and
fund the Professional Fee Reserve in Cash in the Amount of the Professional Fee Estimate. Subject to Section 5.9(e) of the Plan, the Cash so transferred will not be used for any purpose other than to pay Allowed Professional Fee Claims,
Supporting Noteholders Professional Fee Claims, the Allowed Deerfield Substantial Contribution Claim, the Allowed Committee Member Substantial Contribution Claims, and the 2016 Notes Trustee Fee Claims, and no payments on account of such claims will
be made from any source other than the Professional Fee Reserve. The Plan Administrator (i) will segregate and will not commingle the Cash held in the Professional Fee Reserve, (ii) subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan, will pay
each Professional Fee Claim of a Professional employed by the Debtors or the Committee, on or as soon as reasonably practicable after the date such Claim becomes an Allowed Claim, upon entry of a Final Order allowing such Claim, (iii) will pay
the Supporting Noteholders Professional Fee Claims upon satisfaction of the conditions to payment provided under the PSA Order, and (iv) will pay any other Claims permitted to be paid from the Professional Fee Reserve pursuant to the terms of the
Plan. After all Professional Fee Claims are Allowed or Disallowed and the Allowed amounts of such Claims are paid by the Plan Administrator, any remaining Cash in the Professional Fee Reserve will be transferred to the Administrative and Priority
Claims Reserve until such time as all Administrative Claims (except Professional Fee Claims), Priority Tax Claims and Priority Non-Tax Claims are Allowed or Disallowed and the Allowed amounts of
44
such Claims are paid by the Plan Administrator, then such remaining Cash, if any, will be available for Pro Rata distribution to Holders of Allowed Class 3 Claims and Allowed Class 4 Claims. Only
Professionals employed in the Chapter 11 Cases by the Debtors or the Committee, the Supporting Noteholders Professionals, the Allowed Deerfield Substantial Contribution Claim, the Allowed Committee Member Substantial Contribution Claims, and the
2016 Notes Trustee Fee Claims will be entitled to payment from the Professional Fee Reserve. For the avoidance of doubt, (i) the Supporting Noteholders Professionals will not be required to file final fee applications and will only be required to
meet the conditions necessary to payment as set forth in the PSA Order and (ii) the 2016 Notes Trustee will not be required to file a final fee application and will be paid pursuant to Section 5.14 of the Plan.
The Professionals employed by the Debtors and the Committee, as applicable, the Supporting Noteholders and the 2016 Notes Trustee, will be
entitled to reasonable compensation and reimbursement of actual, necessary expenses for post-Effective Date activities, including the preparation, filing and prosecution of final fee applications (if applicable), upon the submission of redacted
invoices to the Plan Administrator for payment from the Professional Fee Reserve. Any Supporting Noteholders Professional that serves as a member of the Oversight Committee will be entitled to such post-Effective Date fees and expenses incurred for
serving in such capacity and, separately, in its capacity as a Supporting Noteholders Professional; provided, however, that in no event will any such Supporting Noteholders Professional be entitled to receive fees and expenses in more
than one such capacity on account of any given efforts. Any time or expenses incurred in the preparation, filing and prosecution of final fee applications will be disclosed by each Professional in its final fee application and will be subject to
approval of the Court.
|
b. |
Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve |
On or before the Effective Date, the
Debtors will create and fund the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve in Cash in the Amount of the Administrative and Priority Claims Estimate. The Cash so transferred will not be used for any purpose other than to pay Allowed Administrative
Claims (except Professional Fee Claims, which will be paid from the Professional Fee Reserve), Priority Tax Claims and Priority Non-Tax Claims, and, subject to Section 5.9(e), no payments on account of the foregoing claims will be made from any
source other than the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve. The Plan Administrator (i) will segregate and will not commingle the Cash held in the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve and (ii) will pay each Administrative Claim
(except Professional Fee Claims, which will be paid from the Professional Fee Reserve), Priority Tax Claim and Priority Non-Tax Claim, on or as soon as reasonably practicable after the date such Claim becomes an Allowed Claim. After all
Administrative Claims (including Professional Fee Claims), Priority Tax Claims and Priority Non-Tax Claims are Allowed or Disallowed and the Allowed amounts of such Claims are paid by the Plan Administrator, any remaining Cash in the Administrative
and Priority Claims Reserve will be available for Pro Rata distribution to Holders of Allowed Class 3 Claims and Allowed Class 4 Claims.
45
|
c. |
Disputed Claims Reserve |
On or before the Effective Date, the Debtors will create and
fund the Disputed Claims Reserve in Cash in the amount of the Disputed Claims Estimate. Subject to Section 5.9(e) of the Plan, no payments made on account of Disputed General Unsecured Claims that become Allowed Claims after the Effective Date
will be made from any source other than the Disputed Claims Reserve.
On or before the Effective Date, the Debtors will create and fund
the Wind-down Reserve in Cash in the amount of the Wind-down Budget. Subject to Section 5.9(e) of the Plan, no payments to the Plan Administrator and Plan Administrator Professionals will be made from any source other than the Wind-down
Reserve. Any recovery from Causes of Action will be deposited by the Plan Administrator into the Wind-down Reserve.
|
e. |
Other Reserves and Modifications to Reserves |
Subject to and in accordance with the
provisions of the Plan Administrator Agreement and the Wind-down Budget, the Plan Administrator may establish and administer any other necessary reserves that may be required under the Plan or Plan Administrator Agreement, subject to the consent of
the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders, the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders and the Committee prior to the Effective Date, or the Oversight Committee on and after the Effective Date, which consent will not be unreasonably
withheld. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in the Plan, the Plan Administrator may, in consultation with the Oversight Committee, make transfers of money between the reserves established under the Plan to satisfy Claims and other
obligations in accordance with the Plan and the Wind-down Budget.
|
10. |
Exemption from Certain Transfer Taxes |
Pursuant to section 1146(a) of the Bankruptcy
Code, any transfers of property pursuant to the Plan will not be subject to any document recording tax, stamp tax, conveyance fee, intangibles or similar tax, mortgage tax, real estate transfer tax, mortgage recording tax or other similar tax or
governmental assessment, and the Confirmation Order will direct the appropriate state or local governmental officials or agents to forego the collection of any such tax or governmental assessment and to accept for filing and recordation instruments
or other documents without the payment of any such tax or governmental assessment. In Florida Dept. of Revenue v. Piccadilly Cafeterias, 554 U.S. 33 (2008), the Supreme Court held that such exemption only applies to sales and transfers made
after confirmation of a chapter 11 plan. Therefore, this exemption is not being sought in connection with the Sale Order.
|
11. |
Exemption from Securities Laws |
As provided in the Solicitation Procedures Order, the
offer and sale of the Valeant Shares pursuant to the Plan is exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act and similar state and local statutes pursuant and subject to section 1145 of the Bankruptcy Code. The Debtors are authorized
to offer the Valeant Shares pursuant to the safe harbor contained in
46
section 1125(e) of the Bankruptcy Code. The Valeant Shares may be resold by the holders thereof without restriction except to the extent that any such holder is deemed to be (i) an
underwriter as defined in section 1145(b)(1) of the Bankruptcy Code, (ii) an issuer or an affiliate of an issuer, or (iii) a dealer.
|
12. |
Preservation of Causes of Action |
In accordance with section 1123(b) of the Bankruptcy
Code, the Debtors and their Estates will retain all of the Causes of Action, a nonexclusive list of which is set forth on Exhibit C, annexed to the Plan. The Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors, may enforce all rights to
commence and pursue, as appropriate, the Causes of Action, and the Plan Administrators rights to commence, prosecute or settle such Causes of Action will be preserved notwithstanding the occurrence of the Effective Date or the dissolution of
the Debtors. The Plan Administrator expressly reserves all rights to prosecute any and all Causes of Action against any Entity, except as otherwise expressly provided in the Plan. Unless any Causes of Action against an Entity are expressly waived,
relinquished, exculpated, released, compromised or settled in the Plan or a Court order, the Plan Administrator expressly reserves all Causes of Action for later adjudication, and, therefore, no preclusion doctrine, including the doctrines of res
judicata, collateral estoppel, issue preclusion, claim preclusion, estoppels (judicial, equitable or otherwise) or laches, will apply to such Causes of Action upon, after or as a consequence of the Confirmation or Consummation. For the avoidance of
doubt, the Plan Administrator will waive and will not commence, pursue or prosecute claims, if any, pursuant to section 547 of the Bankruptcy Code against any non-Insiders of the Debtors.
The Plan Administrator will be authorized to (i) enforce, (ii) prosecute, and (iii) settle or compromise (subject to the
consent of the Oversight Committee for settlements in the amount of $100,000.00 and above) the Causes of Action. The Plan Administrator may pursue such Causes of Action, with the consent of the Oversight Committee, which consent will not be
unreasonably withheld, in accordance with the obligations of the Plan and the best interests of all of the beneficiaries of the Plan. The method of distribution of the Estates assets pursuant to the Plan will not, and will not be deemed to,
prejudice the Causes of Action, which will survive entry of the Confirmation Order for the beneficiaries of the Plan. At any time after the Confirmation Date and before the Effective Date, notwithstanding anything in the Plan to the contrary, the
Debtors may settle any or all of the Causes of Action with the approval of the Court pursuant to Fed. R. Bankr. P. 9019.
The Debtors have
not conducted an investigation into the Causes of Action. Accordingly, in considering the Plan, each party in interest should understand that any and all Causes of Action that may exist against such Person or Entity may be pursued by the Plan
Administrator, regardless of whether, or the manner in which, such Causes of Action are listed on Exhibit C to the Plan or described in the Plan. The failure of the Debtors to list a claim, right, cause of action, suit or proceeding on Exhibit C to
the Plan will not constitute a waiver or release by the Debtors or their Estates of such claim, right of action, suit or proceeding.
The
substantive consolidation of the Debtors and their Estates pursuant to the Confirmation Order and Section 5.1 of the Plan will not, and will not be deemed to, prejudice any of the Causes of Action, which will survive entry of the Confirmation
Order for the benefit
47
of the Debtors and their Estates, and, upon the Effective Date, for the benefit of the Liquidating Debtors.
|
13. |
Effectuating Documents; Further Transactions |
The Plan Administrator, subject to the
terms and conditions of the Plan and the Plan Administrator Agreement, will be authorized to execute, deliver, file or record such contracts, instruments, releases, indentures and other agreements or documents, and take such actions as may be
necessary or appropriate to effectuate and further evidence the terms and conditions of the Plan and the conveyance and transfer of assets and liabilities provided for by the Asset Purchase Agreement.
|
14. |
2016 Notes Trustee Fee Claims |
The Debtors or the Liquidating Debtors, on the Effective
Date to the extent invoiced, or as soon as reasonably practicable following receipt of redacted invoices post-Effective Date (which invoices will also be provided to the Supporting Noteholders and the Committee), will pay the 2016 Notes Trustee Fee
Claims incurred through the Effective Date; provided, however, if the Debtors, the Liquidating Debtors, the Committee or the Supporting Noteholders, as applicable, and the 2016 Notes Trustee cannot agree with respect to the
reasonableness of the fees and expenses to be paid, the Debtors or the Liquidating Debtors, as applicable, will (i) pay the undisputed portion of any invoices submitted with respect to 2016 Notes Trustee Fee Claims, (ii) place the disputed
amounts of any such invoices in escrow, and (iii) notify the 2016 Notes Trustee of any dispute within ten (10) days after the presentation of such invoices. After the parties have attempted in good faith to resolve any such dispute for at
least fifteen (15) days after the notification of the dispute, the 2016 Notes Trustee may submit such dispute for resolution to the Court; provided, however, that the Courts review will be limited to a determination under
the reasonableness standard in accordance with the 2016 Notes Indenture. Nothing in the Plan (including, without limitation, any release, discharge or injunction provided under the Plan) will impair, waive, discharge or negatively affect any
charging lien for any fees, costs and expenses not paid pursuant to the Plan and otherwise claimed by the 2016 Notes Trustee in accordance with the 2016 Notes Indenture.
As of the Effective Date, a post-confirmation committee (the
Oversight Committee) will be formed. The members of the Oversight Committee will be identified in the Plan Supplement. After the Effective Date, the Plan Administrator will consult with the Oversight Committee regarding
(i) Causes of Action and Disputed Claims for which the Plan Administrator proposes a settlement in the amount of $100,000.00 and above) and (ii) the disposition of property of the Debtors and the Liquidating Debtors for $100,000.00 and
above in accordance with the terms of the Plan and the Plan Administrator Agreement.
The compensation of the members of the Oversight
Committee will be provided in the Plan Supplement.
48
C. |
Provisions Governing Distributions |
|
1. |
Distributions for Claims Allowed as of the Effective Date |
Except as otherwise provided
in the Plan or as ordered by the Court, all Distributions to be made on account of Claims that are Allowed Claims as of the Effective Date will be made on the Distribution Date by the Disbursing Agent in accordance with Section 5.7(a) of the
Plan; provided that the Pro Rata Distribution of the Valeant Shares to the Holders of Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims will be made immediately upon the occurrence of the Effective Date and the Liquidating Debtors will make reasonable
efforts to make a Pro Rata Distribution of Available Cash to Holders of Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims and Holders of Allowed General Unsecured Claims on the Effective Date. Distributions on account of Claims that first become Allowed Claims after
the Effective Date will be made pursuant to the terms and conditions of the Plan. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan to the contrary, no Distribution will be made on account of any Allowed Claim or portion thereof that (i) has been
satisfied after the Petition Date; (ii) is listed in the Schedules as contingent, unliquidated, disputed or in a zero amount, and for which a Proof of Claim has not been timely filed; or (iii) is evidenced by a Proof of Claim that has been
amended by a subsequently filed Proof of Claim.
The Disbursing Agent will make all Distributions required under the
Plan, subject to the terms and provisions of the Plan. If the Disbursing Agent is an independent third party designated to serve in such capacity, such Disbursing Agent will receive, without further Court approval, reasonable compensation from the
Wind-down Reserve for distribution services rendered pursuant to the Plan and reimbursement of reasonable out-of-pocket expenses. No Disbursing Agent will be required to give any bond or surety or other security for the performance of its duties.
The Disbursing Agent will be authorized and directed to rely upon the Debtors Books and Records and the Plan Administrators representatives and professionals in determining Allowed Claims not entitled to Distributions under the Plan in
accordance with the terms and conditions of the Plan. Class 3 Distributions of the Valeant Shares on account of the Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims will be made immediately upon the occurrence of the Effective Date to such Holders.
|
3. |
Delivery of Distributions and Undeliverable or Unclaimed Distributions |
|
a. |
Delivery of Distributions in General |
Distributions to Holders of Allowed Claims will
be made by the Disbursing Agent (a) at the addresses set forth on the Proofs of Claim filed by such Holders (or at the last known addresses of such Holders if no Proof of Claim is filed or if the Debtors have been notified of a change of
address), (b) at the addresses set forth in any written notices of address changes delivered to the Disbursing Agent after the date of any related Proof of Claim, after sufficient evidence of such addresses as may be requested by the Disbursing
Agent is provided, (c) at the addresses reflected in the Schedules if no Proof of Claim has been filed and the Disbursing Agent has not received a written notice of a change of address, (d) at the addresses set forth in the other records
of the Debtors or the Disbursing Agent at the time of the Distribution or (e) in
49
the case of the Holder of a Claim that is governed by an agreement and is administered by an agent or servicer, at the addresses contained in the official records of such agent or servicer.
In making Distributions under the Plan, the Disbursing Agent may rely upon the accuracy of the Claims register maintained by the Claims Agent
in the Chapter 11 Cases, as modified by any Final Order of the Court disallowing Claims in whole or in part.
|
b. |
Undeliverable and Unclaimed Distributions |
If the Distribution to any Holder of an
Allowed Claim is returned to the Disbursing Agent as undeliverable or is otherwise unclaimed, no further Distributions will be made to such Holder unless and until the Disbursing Agent is notified in writing of such Holders then-current
address and such Holder provides sufficient evidence of such address as may be requested by the Disbursing Agent, at which time all missed Distributions will be made to such Holder without interest, subject to the time limitations set forth below.
Amounts in respect of undeliverable Distributions made by the Disbursing Agent will be returned to the Disbursing Agent until such Distributions are claimed. The Disbursing Agent will segregate and, with respect to Cash, deposit in a segregated
account designated as an unclaimed Distribution reserve undeliverable and unclaimed Distributions for the benefit of all such similarly-situated Persons until such time as a Distribution becomes deliverable or is claimed, subject to the time
limitations set forth below.
Any Holder of an Allowed Claim that does not assert a claim pursuant to the Plan for an undeliverable or
unclaimed Distribution within ninety (90) days after the date such Distribution was returned undeliverable will be deemed to have forfeited its Claim for such undeliverable or unclaimed Distribution and will be forever barred and enjoined from
asserting any such claim for an undeliverable or unclaimed Distribution against the Debtors and their Estates, the Liquidating Debtors, the Plan Administrator, and their respective agents, attorneys, representatives, employees or independent
contractors, and/or any of its or their property. In the case of undeliverable or unclaimed Distributions on account of Administrative Claims, Priority Tax Claims or Priority Non-Tax Claims, any Cash otherwise reserved for undeliverable or unclaimed
Distributions will revert to the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve. In the case of undeliverable or unclaimed Distributions on account of Allowed General Unsecured Claims, any Cash otherwise reserved for undeliverable or unclaimed
Distributions will revert to the Disputed Claims Reserve, and all title to and all beneficial interests in the Available Cash represented by any such undeliverable Distributions will revert to and/or remain in the Liquidating Debtors and will be
distributed in accordance with the Plan. The reversion of such Cash to the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve or the Disputed Claims Reserve, as applicable, will be free of any restrictions thereon and notwithstanding any federal or state
escheat laws to the contrary and will be treated in accordance with the terms of the Plan. Nothing contained in the Plan or the Plan Administrator Agreement will require the Debtors, the Liquidating Debtors, the Plan Administrator, or any Disbursing
Agent to attempt to locate any Holder of an Allowed Claim.
This Article IVC.3.b of the Disclosure Statement and Section 6.3(b) of
the Plan are not applicable to the 2016 Notes Trustee or the holders of the 2016 Notes.
50
Except as otherwise provided in the Plan or in the Confirmation Order, the
Debtors or the Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors, as applicable, will have the right to prepay, without penalty, all or any portion of an Allowed Administrative Claim, Allowed Priority Tax Claim, Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim
or Allowed Secured Claim at any time.
Cash payments made pursuant to the Plan will be in U.S. dollars
and will be made at the option and in the sole discretion of the Disbursing Agent by (i) checks drawn on or (ii) wire transfers from a domestic bank selected by the Disbursing Agent. In the case of foreign creditors, Cash payments may be
made, at the option of the Disbursing Agent, in such funds and by such means as are necessary or customary in a particular jurisdiction.
Unless otherwise specifically provided for in the Plan or the
Confirmation Order, or required by applicable bankruptcy law, postpetition interest will not accrue or be paid on any Claims, and no Claimholder will be entitled to interest accruing on or after the Petition Date on any Claim. Interest will not
accrue or be paid upon any Disputed Claim in respect of the period from the Petition Date to the date a final Distribution is made thereon if and after such Disputed Claim becomes an Allowed Claim.
|
7. |
Withholding and Reporting Requirements |
In connection with the Plan and all
Distributions thereunder, the Disbursing Agent or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors, is authorized to take any and all actions that may be necessary or appropriate to comply with all withholding, payment and
reporting requirements imposed by any federal, state, local or foreign taxing authority, and all Allowed Claims and Distributions under the Plan will be subject to any such withholding and reporting requirements. The Disbursing Agent or the Plan
Administrator, as applicable, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors, will be authorized to take any and all actions that may be necessary or appropriate to comply with such withholding, payment and reporting requirements. All Holders of Claims will
be required to provide any information necessary to allow the Plan Administrator to comply with all withholding, payment and reporting requirements with respect to such Taxes. The Disbursing Agent or the Plan Administrator will withhold the full
amount required by law on any Distribution on account of any Holder of an Allowed Claim that fails to timely provide to the Disbursing Agent or the Plan Administrator the required information.
Subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan Administrator Agreement, the
Debtors and/or the Plan Administrator may, but will not be required to, set off against any Claim and the payments or other Distributions to be made under the Plan on account of the Claim, claims of any nature whatsoever that the Debtors may have
against the Holder thereof, provided that any such right of setoff that is exercised will be allocated, first, to the principal amount of the related Claim, and thereafter to any interest portion thereof, but neither the failure to do so nor the
51
allowance of any Claim under the Plan will constitute a waiver or release by the Debtors, the Liquidating Debtors or the Plan Administrator of any such claim that the Debtors may have against
such Holder.
|
9. |
Procedure for Treating and Resolving Disputed, Contingent and/or Unliquidated Claims |
|
a. |
Objection Deadline; Prosecution of Objections |
Except as set forth in the Plan with
respect to Professional Fee Claims, all objections to Claims must be filed and served on the Holders of such Claims by the Claims Objection Deadline, as the same may be extended by the Court. If an objection has not been filed to a Proof of Claim or
the Schedules have not been amended with respect to a Claim that (i) was Scheduled by the Debtors but (ii) was not Scheduled as contingent, unliquidated and/or disputed, by the Claims Objection Deadline, as the same may be extended by
order of the Court, the Claim to which the Proof of Claim or Scheduled Claim relates will be treated as an Allowed Claim if such Claim has not been Allowed earlier. Notice of any motion for an order extending the Claims Objection Deadline will be
required to be given only to those persons or entities that have requested notice in the Chapter 11 Cases in accordance with Bankruptcy Rule 2002.
Notwithstanding any requirements that may be imposed pursuant to Bankruptcy Rule 9019, on and after the Effective Date, the Plan Administrator
will have the authority to: (1) file, withdraw or litigate to judgment objections to and requests for estimation of Claims; (2) settle or compromise any Disputed Claim without any further notice to or action, order or approval by the
Court, subject to the consent of the Oversight Committee for proposed settlements in the amount of $100,000.00 and above, which consent will not be unreasonably withheld; and (3) administer and adjust the Claims register to reflect any such
settlements or compromises without any further notice to or action, order or approval by the Court; provided, however, that the objection to and settlement of Professional Fee Claims will not be subject to Section 6.9(a) of the
Plan, but rather will be governed by Section 9.1(a) of the Plan. In the event that any objection filed by the Debtors or the Committee remains pending as of the Effective Date, the Plan Administrator will be deemed substituted for the Debtors
or the Committee, as applicable, as the objecting party.
The Plan Administrator will be entitled to assert all of the Debtors
rights, claims, defenses, offsets, rights of recoupment, setoffs, rights of disallowance, subrogation, recharacterization and/or equitable subordination and counter-claims with respect to Claims.
|
b. |
No Distributions Pending Allowance |
Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan or
the Plan Administrator Agreement, no payments or Distributions will be made with respect to all or any portion of a Disputed Claim unless and until all objections to such Disputed Claim have been settled or withdrawn or have been determined by Final
Order, and the Disputed Claim, or some portion thereof, has become an Allowed Claim. To the extent that a Claim is not a Disputed Claim but is held by a Holder that is or may be liable to the Debtors or the Liquidating Debtors on account of a Cause
of Action, no payments or Distributions will be made with respect to all or any portion of such
52
Claim unless and until such Claim and liability have been settled or withdrawn or have been determined by Final Order of the Court or such other court having jurisdiction over the matter.
|
c. |
Disputed Claims Reserve |
On the Distribution Date and on each subsequent Periodic
Distribution Date, the Plan Administrator will withhold on a Pro Rata basis from property that would otherwise be distributed to Holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims and Holders of General Unsecured Claims entitled to Distributions under the Plan on
such date, in a separate Disputed Claims Reserve, such amounts or property as may be necessary to equal one hundred percent (100%) of Distributions to which Holders of such Disputed General Unsecured Claims would be entitled under the Plan if
such Disputed General Unsecured Claims were allowed in their Disputed Claim Amounts. The Plan Administrator may request, if necessary, estimation for any Disputed General Unsecured Claim that is contingent or unliquidated, or for which the Plan
Administrator determines to reserve less than the Face Amount. The Plan Administrator will withhold the applicable Disputed Claim Amounts with respect to such Claims based upon the estimated amount of each such Claim as estimated by the Court. If
practicable, the Plan Administrator will invest any Cash that is withheld as the Disputed Claims Reserve in an appropriate manner to ensure the safety of the investment, in accordance with the Plan Administrator Agreement. Nothing in the Plan, the
Disclosure Statement or the Plan Administrator Agreement will be deemed to entitle the Holder of a Disputed General Unsecured Claim to postpetition interest on such Claim.
|
d. |
Distributions After Allowance or Disallowance |
Payments and Distributions to Holders of
Disputed Claims that ultimately become Allowed Claims will be made in accordance with provisions of the Plan that govern Distributions to Holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims and Allowed General Unsecured Claims and Holders of Allowed Administrative
Claims, Allowed Priority Tax Claims and Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claims. The Plan Administrator will no longer reserve for and will distribute to the Holders of Allowed Class 3 Claims and Allowed Class 4 Claims, on the next Periodic Distribution
Date and pursuant to the Plan, their Pro Rata shares of the funds held in the Disputed Claims Reserve on account of any Disputed General Unsecured Claim that becomes a Disallowed Claim.
|
e. |
De Minimis Distributions |
The Plan Administrator will not be required to make any
distributions to Holders of Allowed Claims (other than Priority Tax Claims or Administrative Claims) aggregating less than fifty dollars ($50.00). Cash that otherwise would be payable under the Plan to Holders of Allowed General Unsecured Claims but
for Section 6.9(e) of the Plan will be available for Distributions to Holders of Allowed Class 3 Claims and Allowed Class 4 Claims. Subject to Section 5.9(e) of the Plan, Cash that otherwise would be payable under the Plan to Holders of
Administrative Claims, Priority Tax Claims and Priority Non-Tax Claims but for Section 6.9(e) of the Plan will remain in the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve until such time as all such Claims are Allowed or Disallowed and the Allowed
amounts of such Claims are paid.
53
Any other provision of the Plan notwithstanding, the Disbursing
Agent will not be required to make Distributions or payments of fractions of dollars. Whenever any payment of a fraction of a dollar under the Plan would otherwise be called for, the actual payment will reflect a rounding of such fraction to the
nearest whole dollar (up or down), with half dollars being rounded down.
|
g. |
Allocation of Plan Distributions Between Principal and Interest |
To the extent that any
Allowed Claim entitled to a Distribution under the Plan is composed of indebtedness and accrued but unpaid interest thereon, such Distribution will, for all income tax purposes, be allocated to the principal amount of the Claim first and then, to
the extent the consideration exceeds the principal amount of the Claim, to the portion of such Claim representing accrued but unpaid interest.
|
h. |
Distribution Record Date |
The Disbursing Agent will have no obligation to recognize the
transfer of or sale of any participation in any Allowed Claim that occurs after the close of business on the Distribution Record Date. Instead, the Disbursing Agent will be entitled to recognize and deal for all purposes under the Plan with only
those record Holders stated on the official Claims register or the Debtors Books and Records, as applicable, as of the close of business on the Distribution Record Date.
D. |
Treatment of Executory Contracts and Unexpired Leases |
|
1. |
Rejected Contracts and Leases |
Except as otherwise provided in the Plan, the Sale
Order, or in any contract, instrument, release or other agreement or document entered into in connection with the Plan, each of the Executory Contracts and Unexpired Leases to which any Debtor is a party will be deemed automatically rejected by the
applicable Debtor as of the Effective Date, unless such contract or lease (i) previously has been assumed or rejected by the Debtors, (ii) expired or terminated pursuant to its own terms, (iii) is the subject of a motion to assume or
reject pending before the Court as of the Confirmation Date or (iv) is identified on Exhibit B hereto as a contract to be assumed; provided, however, that nothing contained in the Plan will constitute an admission by any
Debtor that any such contract or lease is an Executory Contract or Unexpired Lease or that any Debtor or its successors and assigns has any liability thereunder; and, provided further, that the Debtors reserve their right, at any time
before the Confirmation Date, to assume any Executory Contract or Unexpired Lease that was not already rejected prior to the Confirmation Date. The Confirmation Order will constitute an order of the Court approving the rejections described in
Section 7.1 of the Plan, pursuant to section 365 of the Bankruptcy Code, as of the Effective Date.
54
|
2. |
Rejection Damages Bar Date |
If the rejection of an Executory Contract or Unexpired
Lease pursuant to Section 7.1 of the Plan gives rise to a Claim by the other party or parties to such contract or lease, such Claim will be forever barred and will not be enforceable against the applicable Debtor or its Estate, the Liquidating
Debtors or their respective successors or properties unless a Proof of Claim is filed with the Court and served on counsel for the Plan Administrator within thirty (30) days after service of notice of entry of the Confirmation Order.
|
3. |
Assumed Contracts and Leases |
Except as otherwise provided in the Confirmation Order,
the Plan, the Plan Administrator Agreement or any other document entered into after the Petition Date or in connection with the Plan, the Confirmation Order will constitute an order under Bankruptcy Code section 365 assuming, as of the Effective
Date, those contracts listed on Exhibit B to the Plan; provided, however, that the Debtors may amend such Exhibit at any time prior to the Confirmation Date; provided further, however, that listing an
insurance agreement on such Exhibit will not constitute an admission by a Debtor that such agreement is an executory contract or that any Debtor has any liability thereunder.
Any monetary amounts by which each executory contract and unexpired lease to be assumed pursuant to the Plan is in default, if any, will be
satisfied, under section 365(b)(1) of the Bankruptcy Code, by Cure, with such Cure being provided by, at the option of the Liquidating Debtors or the Plan Administrator, either (x) Dendreon or (y) the assignee to whom such contract or
lease is being assigned. If there is a dispute regarding (a) the nature or amount of any Cure, (b) the ability of Dendreon or any assignee to provide adequate assurance of future performance (within the meaning of section 365
of the Bankruptcy Code) under the contract or lease to be assumed, or (c) any other matter pertaining to assumption, Cure will occur following the entry of a Final Order resolving the dispute and approving the assumption or assumption and
assignment, as the case may be; provided that if there is a dispute as to the amount of Cure that cannot be resolved consensually among the parties, the Liquidating Debtors or the Plan Administrator will have the right to reject the
contract or lease for a period of five (5) days after entry of a Final Order establishing a Cure amount in excess of that provided by the Debtors. The Confirmation Order, if applicable, will contain provisions providing for notices of proposed
assumptions and proposed cure amounts to be sent to applicable third parties and for procedures for objecting thereto (which will provide not less than twenty (20) days notice of such procedures and any deadlines pursuant thereto) and
resolution of disputes by the Court.
|
4. |
Indemnification Obligations |
Any obligations of the Debtors pursuant to their corporate
charters and bylaws or agreements, including amendments, entered into any time prior to the Effective Date, to indemnify, reimburse or limit the liability of any Person pursuant to the Debtors certificates of incorporation, bylaws, policy of
providing employee indemnification, applicable state law or specific agreement in respect of any claims, demands, suits, causes of action or proceedings against such Persons based upon any act or omission related to such Persons service with,
for or on behalf of the Debtors prior to the Effective Date with respect to all present and future actions,
55
suits and proceedings relating to the Debtors will survive confirmation of the Plan and except as set forth in the Plan, remain unaffected thereby, and will not be discharged, irrespective of
whether such defense, indemnification, reimbursement or limitation of liability accrued or is owed in connection with an occurrence before or after the Petition Date; provided, however, that all obligations under Section 7.4 of
the Plan will be limited solely to available insurance coverage and neither the Liquidating Debtors, the Plan Administrator nor any of their assets will be liable for any such obligations. Any Claim based on the Debtors obligations set forth
in Section 7.4 of the Plan will not be a Disputed Claim or subject to any objection in either case by reason of section 502(e)(1)(B) of the Bankruptcy Code. This provision for indemnification obligations will not apply to or cover any Claims,
suits or actions against a Person that result in a final order determining that such Covered Person is liable for fraud, willful misconduct, gross negligence, bad faith, self-dealing or breach of the duty of loyalty.
E. |
Conditions Precedent to Confirmation and Consummation of the Plan |
|
1. |
Conditions to Confirmation |
The following are conditions precedent to confirmation of
the Plan, each of which must be satisfied or waived in accordance with Section 8.3 of the Plan:
a. the Confirmation Order will be in form and substance reasonably acceptable
to the Debtors, the Committee, the Unaffiliated Noteholders and the Deerfield Noteholders and will, among other things:
(i) provide that the Debtors are authorized and directed to take all actions
necessary or appropriate to enter into, implement and consummate the agreements or documents created under or in connection with the Plan; and
(ii) provide that, notwithstanding Bankruptcy Rule 3020(e), the Confirmation
Order will be immediately effective, subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan; and
b. the amounts of the Administrative and Priority Claims Estimate, the
Disputed Claims Estimate, the Wind-down Reserve, the Professional Fee Estimate, and the Wind-down Budget will be reasonably acceptable to the Committee, the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders and the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting
Noteholders;
c. the Plan Administrator Agreement will be in form and
substance reasonably acceptable to the Committee, the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders, and the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders; and
d. the Confirmation Order will have been entered by the Court.
|
2. |
Conditions to Effective Date |
The following are conditions precedent to the occurrence
of the Effective Date, each of which must be satisfied or waived in accordance with Section 8.3 of the Plan:
56
a. the Confirmation Order will
not then be stayed pending appeal, vacated or reversed and will not have been amended without the agreement of the Debtors, the Committee, the Unaffiliated Noteholders and the Deerfield Noteholders;
b. the Professional Fee Reserve, the Administrative and Priority Claims
Reserve and the Disputed Claims Reserve will have been funded in Cash in full and the Wind-down Reserve will have been funded with the amount agreed pursuant to Section 5.9(d) of the Plan;
c. the Plan Administrator will have been appointed and assumed its rights and
responsibilities under the Plan and the Plan Administrator Agreement, as applicable;
d. the Debtors will have retained and pre-paid appropriate professionals for
the preparation of the Debtors tax returns for 2014 and 2015;
e.
all actions, documents and agreements necessary to implement the provisions of the Plan to be effectuated on or prior to the Effective Date will be reasonably satisfactory to the Debtors, the Committee, the Unaffiliated Noteholders and the Deerfield
Noteholders, and such actions, documents and agreements will have been effected or executed and delivered. The Plan Administrator Agreement will be completed and in final form and, as applicable, executed by the parties thereto and all conditions
precedent contained in any of the foregoing will have been satisfied or waived; and
|
f. |
the Debtors will have received the Valeant Shares. |
Each of the conditions to the Effective Date set forth in
Section 8.2 of the Plan may be waived in whole or in part by the Debtors without any other notice to parties in interest or the Court, provided that the Debtors have received the consent of the Committee, the Deerfield Requisite
Supporting Noteholders and the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders, which consent will not unreasonably be withheld, provided further that it will be deemed reasonable to withhold consent if the Debtors are not in receipt of
the Valeant Shares. The failure of any party to exercise any of its foregoing rights will not be deemed a waiver of any of its other rights, and each such right will be deemed an ongoing right that may be asserted thereby at any time.
|
4. |
Consequences of Non-Occurrence of Effective Date |
If the Effective Date does not occur
within 180 days of the Confirmation Date, or by such date, after notice and a hearing, as approved by the Court, (a) the Plan will be null and void in all respects; (b) any settlement of claims will be null and void without further order
of the Court; and (c) the time within which the Debtors may assume and assign or reject all Executory Contracts will be extended for a period of thirty (30) days after such motion is granted.
57
F. |
Allowance and Payment of Certain Administrative Claims |
|
1. |
Professional Fee Claims |
|
a. |
Final Fee Applications |
All final requests for payment of Professional Fee Claims (the
Final Fee Applications) must be filed no later than forty-five (45) days after the Effective Date. Objections, if any, to Final Fee Applications of such Professionals must be filed and served on the Liquidating Debtors, the
Plan Administrator, counsel to the Deerfield Noteholders, counsel to the Unaffiliated Noteholders, the requesting Professional and the Office of the United States Trustee no later than twenty (20) days from the date on which each such Final Fee
Application is served and filed. After notice and a hearing in accordance with the procedures established by the Bankruptcy Code and prior orders of the Court, the Allowed amounts of such Professional Fee Claims will be determined by the Court.
|
b. |
Employment of Professionals after the Effective Date |
From and after the Effective
Date, any requirement that professionals comply with sections 327 through 331 of the Bankruptcy Code or any order previously entered by the Court in seeking retention or compensation for services rendered or expenses incurred after such date will
terminate.
|
2. |
Substantial Contribution Compensation and Expenses Bar Date |
Any Person who wishes to
make a Substantial Contribution Claim based on facts or circumstances arising after the Petition Date must file an application with the clerk of the Court, on or before the Administrative Claims Bar Date, and serve such application on the
Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator and as otherwise required by the Court and the Bankruptcy Code on or before the Administrative Claims Bar Date, or be forever barred from seeking such compensation or expense reimbursement. Objections,
if any, to the Substantial Contribution Claim must be filed no later than the Claims Objection Deadline, unless otherwise extended by Order of the Court. For the avoidance of doubt, this Article IVF.2 and Section 9.2 of the Plan will not apply
to the Committee Member Substantial Contribution Claim and the Deerfield Substantial Contribution Claim.
|
3. |
Other Administrative Claims |
All other requests for payment of an Administrative Claim
arising after the Petition Date, other than Professional Fee Claims and Claims arising under section 503(b)(9) of the Bankruptcy Code, must be filed with the Court and served on the Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator no later than the
Administrative Claims Bar Date. Unless the Plan Administrator or any other party in interest objects to an Administrative Claim by the Claims Objection Deadline, such Administrative Claim will be deemed Allowed in the amount requested. In the event
that the Plan Administrator or any other party in interest objects to an Administrative Claim, the Court will determine the Allowed amount of such Administrative Claim.
58
G. |
Effects of Confirmation |
|
1. |
Satisfaction of Claims |
Distributions made under the Plan on account of Claims or
Interests will satisfy the obligations of the Debtors and the Liquidating Debtors, as adjusted by the Plan, in respect of such Claims or Interests. The entry of the Confirmation Order will constitute the Courts approval of such treatment and
satisfaction of all such Claims and Interests, as well as a finding by the Court that such treatment and satisfaction is in the best interests of the Debtors, their Estates and Holders of Claims and Interests and is fair, equitable and reasonable.
The Plan will be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the Debtors,
all present and former Holders of Claims and Interests, whether or not such Holders will receive or retain any property or interest in property under the Plan, and their respective successors and assigns, including, but not limited to, the
Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator and all other parties in interest in the Chapter 11 Cases.
|
3. |
Effects of Confirmation |
No Claimholder or Interest Holder may, on account of a Claim
or Interest, seek or receive any payment or other Distribution from, or seek recourse against, any Debtor or its respective successors, assigns and/or property, except as expressly provided in the Plan.
|
a. |
Releases by the Debtors |
Pursuant to section 1123(b) of the Bankruptcy Code, to the
fullest extent permissible under applicable law, and except as otherwise specifically provided in the Plan, upon the Effective Date, each of the Debtors will release unconditionally, and hereby is deemed to forever release unconditionally
(i) the Committee and, solely in their respective capacities as members or representatives of the Committee, (and not as individual lenders or creditors to or on behalf of the Debtors), each member of the Committee; (ii) the Released
Parties; (iii) each of the respective agents, advisors, accountants, investment bankers, consultants, attorneys and other representatives of any of the foregoing or of the Debtors, solely in their respective capacities as such; and
(iv) all individuals serving, or who have served, since the Petition Date, as a director or officer of the Debtors, from any and all claims, obligations, suits, judgments, damages, rights, causes of action and liabilities whatsoever (other than
the right to enforce the performance of their respective obligations, if any, to the Debtors or the Liquidating Debtors under the Plan, the Plan Administrator Agreement and the contracts, instruments, releases and other agreements delivered under
the Plan and the Plan Administrator Agreement), whether liquidated or unliquidated, fixed or contingent, matured or unmatured, known or unknown, foreseen or unforeseen, then existing or thereafter arising, in law, equity or otherwise that are based
in whole or in part on any act or omission, transaction, event or other occurrence taking place on or prior to the Effective Date in any way relating to the Debtors, the Chapter 11 Cases, the Plan or the
59
Disclosure Statement, other than Claims or liabilities arising out of or relating to any act or omission that constitutes a failure to perform the duty to act in good faith and where such failure
to perform constitutes willful misconduct, gross negligence, or fraud.
|
b. |
Release by Holders of Claims |
Except as otherwise specifically provided in the Plan
and to the fullest extent permissible under applicable law, on the Effective Date, the Released Parties and each Holder of a Claim (excluding any of the Debtors), including each Claimholder deemed to accept the Plan pursuant to section 1126(f) of
the Bankruptcy Code, will release unconditionally, and hereby is deemed to forever release unconditionally (i) the Released Parties, (ii) the Committee, (iii) each of their respective agents, advisors, accountants, investment bankers,
consultants, attorneys and other representatives, solely in their respective capacities as such, and only with respect to their activities and conduct during or in connection with the Chapter 11 Cases, (iv) all individuals serving, or who have
served, since the Petition Date, as a manager, director, managing member, officer, partner, agent, employee, attorney or other advisor of the Debtors and (v) any successors or assigns of the foregoing, from any and all claims, obligations,
suits, judgments, damages, rights, causes of action and liabilities whatsoever (other than the right to enforce the performance of their respective obligations, if any, to the Debtors under the Plan, the Plan Administrator Agreement and the
contracts, instruments, releases and other agreements delivered under the Plan and the Plan Administrator Agreement), whether liquidated or unliquidated, fixed or contingent, matured or unmatured, known or unknown, foreseen or unforeseen, then
existing or thereafter arising, in law, equity or otherwise, whether or not by or in the right of any of the Debtors, that are based in whole or in part on any act or omission, transaction, event or other occurrence taking place on or prior to the
Effective Date in any way relating to the Debtors, the Chapter 11 Cases, the Plan or the Disclosure Statement other than Claims or liabilities arising out of or relating to any act or omission that constitutes a failure to perform the duty to act in
good faith and where such failure to perform constitutes willful misconduct, gross negligence, or fraud; provided, that this subsection will not release any Person from any Claim or cause of action existing as of the Effective Date,
based on (x) the Internal Revenue Code or any other domestic state, city or municipal tax code, (y) the environmental laws of the United States or any domestic state, city or municipality or (z) any criminal laws of the United States
or any domestic state, city or municipality. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in Section 10.4(b) of the Plan, a Holder of a Claim (other than a Released Party) will be deemed not to provide the releases in Section 10.4(b) if such
Holder (i) votes to reject the Plan and (ii) opts out of the releases provided in Section 10.4(b) of the Plan in a timely submitted, valid Ballot. For the avoidance of doubt, each Released Party that is the Holder of a Claim
will be deemed to have given the releases in Section 10.4(b) of the Plan.
|
5. |
Exculpation and Limitation of Liability |
Except as otherwise specifically provided
in the Plan, to the maximum extent permitted by the Bankruptcy Code and applicable law, none of (i) the Debtors, (ii) the Liquidating Debtors, (iii) the Plan Administrator, (iv) the Committee, (v) the Supporting Noteholders,
nor (vi) any of their respective members, officers, directors, shareholders,
60
employees, advisors, attorneys or agents acting in such capacity on or after the Petition Date, will have or incur any liability to, or be subject to any right of action by, any Holder of a Claim
or an Interest, or (with respect to such Claims or Interests) any of their respective agents, affiliates, or any of their successors or assigns, for any act or omission in connection with, relating to, or arising out of, the Debtors Chapter 11
Cases, the pursuit of confirmation of the Plan, the consummation of the Plan or the administration of the Plan or the property to be distributed under the Plan, except for their willful misconduct or gross negligence, and in all respects will be
entitled to rely reasonably upon the advice of counsel with respect to their duties and responsibilities under the Plan.
Except as otherwise expressly provided in the Plan, the Plan Supplement
or related documents, or for obligations issued pursuant to the Plan, all Persons who have held, hold or may hold Claims against or Interests in the Debtors are permanently enjoined, from and after the Effective Date, from taking any of the
following actions against any of the Estate(s), the Plan Administrator, any of the property of the foregoing, the property of the Liquidating Debtors, or any successors or assigns of the foregoing on account of any such Claims or Interests:
(A) commencing or continuing, in any manner or in any place, any action or other proceeding; (B) enforcing, attaching, collecting or recovering in any manner any judgment, award, decree or order; (C) creating, perfecting or enforcing
any lien or encumbrance; (D) asserting a setoff or right of subrogation of any kind against any debt, liability or obligation due to the Debtors; and (E) commencing or continuing, in any manner or in any place, any action that does not
comply with or is inconsistent with the provisions of the Plan. By accepting Distributions pursuant to the Plan, each Holder of an Allowed Claim receiving any Distribution pursuant to the Plan will be deemed to have specifically consented to the
injunctions set forth in Section 10.6 of the Plan.
The releases pursuant to Article X of the Plan shall also act as a
permanent injunction against any party that has provided such releases from commencing or continuing any action, employment of process, or act to collect, offset, or recover any Claim released under this Plan to the fullest extent authorized by
applicable law.
|
7. |
Satisfaction of Subordination Rights |
All Claims against the Debtors and all rights and
claims between or among Claimholders relating in any manner whatsoever to Distributions on account of Claims against the Debtors based upon any subordination rights, whether asserted or unasserted, legal or equitable, will be deemed satisfied by the
Distributions under the Plan to Claimholders having such subordination rights, and such subordination rights will be deemed waived, released, discharged and terminated as of the Effective Date. Distributions to the various Classes of Claims under
the Plan will not be subject to levy, garnishment, attachment or like legal process by any Claimholder by reason of any subordination rights or otherwise, so that each Claimholder will have and receive the benefit of the Distributions in the manner
set forth in the Plan.
61
H. |
Retention of Jurisdiction |
|
1. |
Retention of Jurisdiction by the Court |
Under sections 105(a) and 1142 of the
Bankruptcy Code, and notwithstanding entry of the Confirmation Order, substantial consummation of the Plan and occurrence of the Effective Date, the Court will retain exclusive jurisdiction over all matters arising out of, and related to, the
Chapter 11 Cases, the Plan, and the Plan Administrator Agreement to the fullest extent permitted by law, including, among other things, jurisdiction to:
1. To the extent not otherwise determined by the Plan, determine
(i) the allowance, classification or priority of Claims upon objection by any party in interest entitled to file an objection, or (ii) the validity, extent, priority and nonavoidability of consensual and nonconsensual Liens and other
encumbrances against assets of the Estates, Causes of Action, or property of the Estates or the Liquidating Debtors;
2. Issue injunctions or take such other actions or make such other
orders as may be necessary or appropriate to restrain interference with the Plan or its execution or implementation by any Entity or Person, construe and to take any other action to enforce and execute the Plan, the Confirmation Order or any other
order of the Court, issue such orders as may be necessary for the implementation, execution, performance and consummation of the Plan and all matters referred to in the Plan, and determine all matters that may be pending before the Court in the
Chapter 11 Cases on or before the Effective Date with respect to any Entity or Person;
3. Protect the assets or property of the Estates and/or the
Liquidating Debtors, including Causes of Action, from claims against, or interference with, such assets or property, including actions to quiet or otherwise clear title to such property or to resolve any dispute concerning Liens or other
encumbrances on any assets of the Estates;
4. Determine any
and all applications for allowance of Professional Fee Claims;
5. Determine any Priority Tax Claims, Priority Non-Tax Claims or
Administrative Claims, entitled to priority under section 507(a) of the Bankruptcy Code;
6. Resolve any dispute arising under or related to the
implementation, execution, consummation or interpretation of the Plan and the making of Distributions under the Plan;
7. Determine any and all motions related to the rejection,
assumption or assignment of Executory Contracts or Unexpired Leases or determine any issues arising from the deemed rejection of Executory Contracts and Unexpired Leases set forth in Article VII of the Plan;
62
8. Except as
otherwise provided in the Plan, determine all applications, motions, adversary proceedings, contested matters, actions and any other litigated matters instituted in and prior to the closing of the Chapter 11 Cases, including any remands;
9. Enter a Final Order closing each of the Chapter 11 Cases;
10. Modify the Plan under section 1127 of the Bankruptcy Code, remedy any
defect, cure any omission or reconcile any inconsistency in the Plan or the Confirmation Order so as to carry out their intent and purposes;
11. Issue such orders in aid of consummation of the Plan and the Confirmation
Order notwithstanding any otherwise applicable non-bankruptcy law, with respect to any Entity or Person, to the full extent authorized by the Bankruptcy Code;
12. Determine any Tax liability pursuant to section 505 of the Bankruptcy
Code;
13. Enter and implement such orders as may be appropriate in the
event the Confirmation Order is for any reason stayed, revoked, modified or vacated;
14. Resolve any disputes concerning whether an Entity or Person had sufficient
notice of the Chapter 11 Cases, the applicable Bar Date, the hearing to consider approval of the Disclosure Statement or the Confirmation Hearing or for any other purpose;
15. Resolve any dispute or matter arising under or in connection with any
order of the Court entered in the Chapter 11 Cases;
16. Authorize, as may
be necessary or appropriate, sales of assets as necessary or desirable and resolve objections, if any, to such sales;
17. Resolve any disputes concerning any release, injunction, exculpation or
other waiver or protection provided in the Plan;
18. Approve, if
necessary, any Distributions, or objections thereto, under the Plan;
19.
Approve, as may be necessary or appropriate, any Claims settlement entered into or offset exercised by the Plan Administrator;
20. Resolve any dispute or matter arising under or in connection with the
Liquidating Debtors or the Plan Administrator;
21. Order the production
of documents, disclosures or information, or to appear for deposition demanded pursuant to Bankruptcy Rule 2004; and
63
22. Determine such other matters,
and for such other purposes, as may be provided in the Confirmation Order or as may be authorized under provisions of the Bankruptcy Code.
|
2. |
Retention of Non-Exclusive Jurisdiction by the Court |
Notwithstanding anything else in
the Plan, the Court will retain non-exclusive jurisdiction over all Causes of Action prosecuted by the Plan Administrator on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors.
|
3. |
Failure of Court to Exercise Jurisdiction |
If the Court abstains from exercising, or
declines to exercise, jurisdiction or is otherwise without jurisdiction over any matter arising in, arising under, or related to the Chapter 11 Cases, including the matters set forth in Section 11.1 of the Plan, the provisions of Article XI of
the Plan will have no effect upon and will not control, prohibit or limit the exercise of jurisdiction by any other court having jurisdiction with respect to such matter.
I. |
Miscellaneous Provisions |
|
1. |
Modifications and Amendments |
The Debtors may alter, amend or modify the Plan or any
Exhibits thereto under section 1127(a) of the Bankruptcy Code at any time prior to the Confirmation Date provided that the Debtors have received the prior consent of the Committee, the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders, and the Unaffiliated
Requisite Supporting Noteholders, which consent will not unreasonably be withheld. After the Confirmation Date and prior to substantial consummation of the Plan as defined in section 1101(2) of the Bankruptcy Code, the Debtors may, under section
1127(b) of the Bankruptcy Code, institute proceedings in the Court to remedy any defect or omission or reconcile any inconsistencies in the Plan, the Disclosure Statement or the Confirmation Order, and such matters as may be necessary to carry out
the purpose and effect of the Plan so long as such proceedings do not adversely affect the treatment of Holders of Claims under the Plan; provided, however, that prior notice of such proceedings will be served in accordance with the
Bankruptcy Rules or order of the Court.
|
2. |
Severability of Plan Provisions |
If, prior to Confirmation, any term or provision of
the Plan is held by the Court to be invalid, void or unenforceable, then the Court, at the request of the Debtors, will have the power to alter and interpret such term or provision to make it valid or enforceable to the maximum extent practicable,
consistent with the original purpose of the term or provision held to be invalid, void or unenforceable, and such term or provision will then be applicable as altered or interpreted. Notwithstanding any such holding, alteration or interpretation,
the remainder of the terms and provisions of the Plan will remain in full force and effect and will in no way be affected, impaired or invalidated by such holding, alteration or interpretation. The Confirmation Order will constitute a judicial
determination and will provide that each term and provision of the Plan, as it may have been altered or interpreted in accordance with the foregoing, is valid and enforceable pursuant to its terms.
64
|
3. |
Successors and Assigns |
The rights, benefits and obligations of any Person named or
referred to in the Plan will be binding on, and will inure to the benefit of, any heir, executor, administrator, successor or assign of that Person.
|
4. |
Payment of Statutory Fees |
All fees payable through the Effective Date pursuant to 28
U.S.C. § 1930 will be paid on the Effective Date. The Debtors, prior to the Effective Date, and the Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors, from and after the Effective Date, will pay U.S. Trustee Fees in accordance with 28
U.S.C. § 1930 until the Chapter 11 Cases are closed or converted and/or the entry of final decrees. In addition, the Plan Administrator will file post-confirmation quarterly reports or any pre-confirmation monthly operating reports not filed as
of the Confirmation Hearing in conformance with the U.S. Trustee Guidelines. The U.S. Trustee will not be required to file a request for payment of its quarterly fees.
|
5. |
Revocation, Withdrawal or Non-Consummation |
The Debtors reserve the right to revoke or
withdraw the Plan as to any or all of the Debtors prior to the Confirmation Date and to file subsequent plans. If the Debtors revoke or withdraw the Plan as to any or all of the Debtors, or if Confirmation or consummation of the Plan as to any or
all of the Debtors does not occur, then, with respect to such Debtors, (a) the Plan will be null and void in all respects, (b) any settlement or compromise embodied in the Plan (including the fixing or limiting to an amount certain any
Claim or Class of Claims), assumption or rejection of executory contracts or leases effected by the Plan, and any document or agreement executed pursuant to the Plan, will be deemed null and void, and (c) nothing contained in the Plan, and no
acts taken in preparation for consummation of the Plan, will (i) constitute or be deemed to constitute a waiver or release of any Claims by or against, or any Interests in, such Debtors or any other Person, (ii) prejudice in any manner the
rights of such Debtors or any other Person or (iii) constitute an admission of any sort by such Debtors or any other Person.
The Debtors or the Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating
Debtors, may cancel, terminate, or surrender any insurance policies in accordance with the terms thereof and the applicable insurer is authorized to accept such cancellation, termination, or surrender of any such policy. Any insurer is authorized to
pay, and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors, may collect any proceeds of such cancellation, termination or surrender.
Any notice, request or demand required or permitted to be made or
provided to or upon a Debtor, a Liquidating Debtor, the Committee, or the Plan Administrator will be (a) in writing, (b) served by (i) certified mail, return receipt requested, (ii) hand delivery, (iii) overnight delivery
service, or (iv) facsimile transmission, (c) deemed to have been duly given or made when actually delivered or, in the case of notice by facsimile transmission, when received and telephonically confirmed and (d) addressed as follows:
65
The Debtors:
Dendreon Corporation
601
Union Street
Suite 4900
Seattle, WA 98101
Attn: Rob
Crotty, Esq.
Title: General Counsel and Secretary
Telephone: (888) 369-8915
with a copy to:
Ken Ziman,
Esq.
Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meager & Flom LLP
Four Times Square
New York,
New York 10036-6522
Telephone: (212) 735-3000
Fax: (212) 735-2000
with
a copy to:
Felicia Gerber Perlman, Esq.
Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meager & Flom LLP
155 N. Wacker Dr.
Chicago, IL
60606-1720
Telephone: (312) 407-0700
Fax: (312) 407-0411
The
Liquidating Debtors:
Dendreon Corporation
601 Union Street
Suite 4900
Seattle, WA 98101
Attn:
Rob Crotty, Esq.
Title: General Counsel and Secretary
Telephone: (888) 369-8915
Committee:
c/o Michael Torkin, Esq.
Mark Schneiderman, Esq.
Sullivan & Cromwell LLP
125 Broad Street
New York, New
York 10004
Telephone: (212) 558-4000
Facsimile: (212) 558-3588
66
Deerfield Noteholders:
c/o John C. Longmire, Esq.
Willkie Farr & Gallagher LLP
787 Seventh Avenue
New York,
New York 10019
Telephone: (212) 728-8000
Facsimile: (212) 728-8111
Unaffiliated Noteholders:
c/o Steven D. Pohl, Esq.
Brown Rudnick LLP
One
Financial Center
Boston, Massachusetts 02111
Telephone: (617) 856-8200
Facsimile: (617) 856-8201
and
c/o John
Storz, Esq.
Seven Times Square
New York, NY 10036
Telephone:
(212) 209-4800
Facsimile: (212) 209-4801
Plan Administrator:
Name
Address
Telephone:
Facsimile:
Exhibits to the Plan not attached to the Plan will be filed in one
or more Plan Supplements by the Plan Supplement Filing Date. Any Plan Supplement (and amendments thereto) filed by the Debtors will be deemed an integral part of the Plan and will be incorporated by reference as if fully set forth in the Plan.
Substantially contemporaneously with their filing, the Plan Supplements may be viewed at the Debtors case website (https://cases.primeclerk.com/dendreon/) or the Courts website (http://www.deb.uscourts.gov). Copies of case
pleadings, including the Plan Supplements, also may be examined between the hours of 8:00 a.m. and 4:00 p.m., Monday through Friday, excluding federal holidays, at the Office of the Clerk of the Court, 824 N. Market St., 3rd Floor, Wilmington,
Delaware 19801. Finally, copies of case pleadings also may be obtained by written request to the Claims Agent, at dendreoninfo@primeclerk.com. The documents contained in any Plan Supplements will be approved by the Court pursuant to the
Confirmation Order.
67
ARTICLE V
ISSUANCE OF VALEANT SHARES UNDER THE PLAN
A. |
Valuation of Valeant Shares |
Pursuant to the Second Amended Acquisition Agreement, the
Valeant Shares will be valued at the closing price of the Valeant Shares on the New York Stock Exchange as reported by Bloomberg L.P. (or, if not reported therein, in another authoritative source mutually selected by the parties) on the trading day
immediately prior to the Effective Date. The Second Amended Acquisition Agreement also provides that Valeant will use commercially reasonable efforts to cause the Valeant Shares issued as consideration for the purchase of the Acquired Assets to be
approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange and the Toronto Stock Exchange on or prior to the date of issuance of such Valeant Shares. A discussion of certain federal and securities laws can be found at Article XI.
B. |
Delivery of Valeant Shares to the Debtors |
Pursuant to the Second Amended Acquisition
Agreement, the Debtors will provide at least three (3) business days prior written notice to Valeant and the Purchaser of the anticipated Effective Date. On the same date, the Debtors will also file a notice on the docket in these Chapter 11
Cases. The Valeant Shares will be delivered by Valeant through Valeants transfer agent to Dendreon Corporation on the Effective Date of the Plan through the facilities of The Depository Trust Company by crediting the account of Dendreon
Corporations prime broker with The Depository Trust Company. Distributions of the Valeant Shares on account of Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims will be made immediately to such Holders upon the occurrence of the Effective Date.
C. |
Information Concerning Valeant |
As more fully detailed in its public filings with the
SEC, Valeant is a multinational, specialty pharmaceutical and medical device company that develops, manufactures, and markets a broad range of products and medical devices which are marketed directly or indirectly in over 100 countries. Valeant is a
public company with a market capitalization exceeding $55 billion that is traded on the New York Stock Exchange and the Toronto Stock Exchange under the ticker symbol VRX. This Disclosure Statement hereby incorporates by reference the publicly filed
financial statements of Valeant. For additional information regarding Valeant, please see Valeants most recent Form 10-K attached to this Disclosure Statement as Exhibit B. As of April 13, 2015, shares of Valeant were trading at
$209.46 with a daily volume of 1,516,985.
68
ARTICLE VI
VOTING REQUIREMENTS;
ACCEPTANCE AND CONFIRMATION OF THE PLAN
The Bankruptcy Code requires that, in order to confirm the Plan, the Court
must make a series of findings concerning the Plan and the Debtors, including that (i) the Plan has classified Claims in a permissible manner; (ii) the Plan complies with applicable provisions of the Bankruptcy Code; (iii) the Plan
has been proposed in good faith and not by any means forbidden by law; (iv) the disclosure required by section 1125 of the Bankruptcy Code has been made; (v) the Plan has been accepted by the requisite votes of Holders of Claims (except to
the extent that cramdown is available under section 1129(b) of the Bankruptcy Code); (vi) the Plan is feasible and confirmation is not likely to be followed by the liquidation or the need for further financial reorganization of the Debtors
unless such liquidation or reorganization is proposed in the Plan; (vii) the Plan is in the best interests of all Holders of Claims in an Impaired Class by providing to such Holders on account of their Claims property of a value, as
of the Effective Date, that is not less than the amount that such Holders would receive or retain in a chapter 7 liquidation, unless each Holder of a Claim in such Class has accepted the Plan; and (viii) all fees and expenses payable under 28
U.S.C. § 1930, as determined by the Court at the hearing on confirmation, have been paid or the Plan provides for the payment of such fees on the Effective Date.
B. |
Parties in Interest Entitled to Vote |
Pursuant to the Bankruptcy Code, only Classes of
Claims that are impaired (as defined in section 1124 of the Bankruptcy Code) under the Plan are entitled to vote to accept or reject the Plan. A Class is impaired if the legal, equitable or contractual rights to which the Claims of that
Class entitled the Holders of such Claims are modified, other than by curing defaults and reinstating the Claims. Classes that are not impaired are not entitled to vote on the Plan and are conclusively presumed to have accepted the Plan. In
addition, Classes that receive no distributions under the Plan are not entitled to vote on the Plan and are deemed to have rejected the Plan.
C. |
Classes Impaired and Entitled to Vote under the Plan |
The following Classes are
Impaired under the Plan and entitled to vote on the Plan:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Class |
|
Claim |
|
Status |
|
Voting Right |
3 |
|
2016 Noteholder Claims |
|
Impaired |
|
Entitled to Vote |
4 |
|
General Unsecured Claims |
|
Impaired |
|
Entitled to Vote |
Acceptances of the Plan are being solicited only from Holders of Claims in Classes 3 and 4 that will or may
receive consideration under the Plan. Holders of Claims and Interests in
69
Classes 5, 6, and 7 are deemed to reject the Plan. Holders of Claims in Classes 1, 2, and 8 are deemed to accept the Plan and are not entitled to vote.
D. |
Voting Procedures and Requirements |
The Solicitation Procedures Order sets April 7, 2015, as the record date
for voting on the Plan (the Record Date). Accordingly, only Holders of record as of the Record Date that are otherwise entitled to vote under the Plan will receive a Ballot and may vote on the Plan.
In voting for or against the Plan, please use only the Ballot sent to you with this Disclosure Statement. If you are a Holder of a Claim in
Classes 3 or 4 and did not receive a Ballot, if your Ballot is damaged or lost or if you have any questions concerning voting procedures, please contact the Voting Agent at (844) 794-3479 or at dendreoninfo@PrimeClerk.com.
If you are entitled to vote to accept or reject the Plan, you should
read carefully, complete, sign and return your Ballot, with original signature, in the enclosed envelope.
TO BE COUNTED, YOUR
BALLOT WITH YOUR ORIGINAL SIGNATURE INDICATING YOUR ACCEPTANCE OR REJECTION OF THE PLAN MUST BE RECEIVED NO LATER THAN 4:00 P.M. (EASTERN TIME) ON MAY 19, 2015 (THE VOTING DEADLINE).
Pursuant to section 105(a) of the Bankruptcy Code, Bankruptcy Rules 2002(a)(7)
and 3003(c)(2) and the Bar Date Order, any creditors whose claims are not the subject of a timely-filed proof of claim, or a proof of claim deemed timely filed with the Bankruptcy Court pursuant to either the Bankruptcy Code or other order of the
Court, or otherwise deemed timely filed under applicable law and (a) are scheduled in Debtors Schedules as disputed, contingent or unliquidated; or (b) are not scheduled (the Non-Voting Claims), will be denied
treatment as creditors with respect to such claims for purposes of voting on the Plan and receiving distributions under the Plan.
For
purposes of voting, the amount of a Claim used to calculate acceptance or rejection of the Plan under section 1126 of the Bankruptcy Code will be determined in accordance with the following hierarchy:
|
a. |
if an order has been entered by the Court determining the amount of such Claim, whether pursuant to Bankruptcy Rule 3018 or otherwise, then in the amount prescribed by the order; |
|
b. |
if no such order has been entered, then in the liquidated amount contained in a timely-filed proof of claim that is not the subject of a timely-filed objection; and |
70
|
c. |
if no such proof of claim has been timely filed, then in the liquidated, noncontingent and undisputed amount contained in the Debtors Schedules. |
For purposes of voting, the following conditions will apply to determine the amount and/or classification of a Claim:
|
a. |
if a Claim is partially liquidated and partially unliquidated, such Claim will be allowed for voting purposes only in the liquidated amount; |
|
b. |
if a scheduled or filed Claim has been paid, such Claim will be disallowed for voting purposes; |
|
c. |
the holder of a timely-filed proof of claim that is filed in a wholly unliquidated, contingent, disputed and/or unknown amount, and is not the subject of a timely-filed objection, is entitled to vote in the amount of
$1.00; and |
|
d. |
Claims filed for $0.00 are not entitled to vote. |
Pursuant to the Solicitation Procedures
Order, the deadline for filing and serving motions pursuant to Bankruptcy Rule 3018(a) seeking temporary allowance of claims for the purpose of accepting or rejecting the Plan will be May 12, 2015 at 4:00 p.m. (Eastern Time).
As a condition to confirmation, the Bankruptcy Code requires that
each class of impaired claims vote to accept the Plan, except under certain circumstances. See Confirmation Without Necessary Acceptances; Cramdown below. A plan is accepted by an impaired class of claims if holders of at least
two-thirds in dollar amount and more than one-half in number of claims of those that vote in such class vote to accept the plan. Only those holders of claims who actually vote count in these tabulations. Holders of claims who fail to vote are not
counted as either accepting or rejecting a plan.
In addition to this voting requirement, section 1129 of the Bankruptcy Code requires
that a plan be accepted by each holder of a claim or interest in an impaired class or that the plan otherwise be found by a court to be in the best interests of each holder of a claim or interest in such class. See Best Interests
Test below. Moreover, each impaired class must accept the plan for the plan to be confirmed without application of the fair and equitable and unfair discrimination tests set forth in section 1129(b) of the Bankruptcy
Code discussed below. See Confirmation Without Necessary Acceptances; Cramdown below.
F. |
Confirmation Without Necessary Acceptances; Cramdown |
In the event that any impaired
class of claims or interests does not accept a plan, a debtor nevertheless may move for confirmation of the plan. A plan may be confirmed, even if it is not accepted by all impaired classes, if the plan has been accepted by at least one impaired
class of claims, and the plan meets the cramdown requirements set forth in section 1129(b) of the Bankruptcy Code. Section 1129(b) of the Bankruptcy Code requires that a court find that a plan
71
(i) does not discriminate unfairly and (ii) is fair and equitable, with respect to each non-accepting impaired class of claims or interests.
Here, because Classes 5, 6, and 7 are deemed to reject the Plan, and Classes 3 and 4 are entitled to vote on the Plan, the Debtors will seek
confirmation of the Plan from the Court by satisfying the cramdown requirements set forth in section 1129(b) of the Bankruptcy Code. The Debtors believe that such requirements are satisfied as no Claim or Interest Holder junior to those
in Classes 5-7 will receive any property under the Plan.
|
1. |
No Unfair Discrimination |
A plan does not discriminate unfairly if
(a) the legal rights of a nonaccepting class are treated in a manner that is consistent with the treatment of other classes whose legal rights are similar to those of the nonaccepting class, and (b) no class receives payments in excess of
that which it is legally entitled to receive for its claims or interests. The Debtors believe that under the Plan all impaired Classes of Claims and Interests are treated in a manner that is consistent with the treatment of other Classes of Claims
and Interests that are similarly situated, if any, and no class of Claims or Interests will receive payments or property with an aggregate value greater than the aggregate value of the Allowed Claims or Allowed Interests in such Class. Accordingly,
the Debtors believe the Plan does not discriminate unfairly as to any Impaired Class of Claims or Interests.
|
2. |
Fair and Equitable Test |
With respect to a dissenting class of claims or interests, the
fair and equitable standard requires that a plan provide that either the claims or interests in each class received everything to which they are legally entitled or that classes junior in priority to the class receive nothing. The strict
requirement of the allocation of full value to dissenting classes before any junior class can receive distribution is known as the absolute priority rule.
The Bankruptcy Code establishes different fair and equitable tests for holders of secured claims, unsecured claims and interests,
which may be summarized as follows:
a. Secured Claims. Either (i) each holder of a claim in
an impaired class of secured claims retains its liens securing its secured claim and it receives on account of its secured claim deferred cash payments having a present value equal to the amount of its allowed secured claim, (ii) each holder of
a claim in an impaired class of secured claims realizes the indubitable equivalent of its allowed secured claim or (iii) the property securing the claim is sold free and clear of liens, with such liens to attach to the proceeds and the
treatment of such liens on proceeds as provided in clause (i) or (ii) of this subparagraph.
b. Unsecured Claims. Either (i) each holder of a claim in an impaired class of unsecured claims
receives or retains under the plan property of a value equal to the amount of its allowed claim or (ii) the holders of claims and interests that are junior to the claims of the dissenting class will not receive any property under the chapter 11
plan, subject to the applicability of the judicial doctrine of contributing new value.
c.
Equity Interests. Either (i) each holder of an equity interest in an impaired class of interests will receive or retain under the chapter 11 plan property of a value equal to the greater of (a) the fixed liquidation preference or
redemption price, if any, of such stock or (b) the value of the stock or (ii) the holders of interests that are junior to the stock will not receive any property under the chapter 11 plan, subject to the applicability of the judicial
doctrine of contributing new value.
72
As discussed above, the Debtors believe that the distributions provided under the Plan satisfy
the absolute priority rule.
ARTICLE VII
FEASIBILITY AND BEST INTERESTS OF CREDITORS
As noted above, even if the Plan is accepted by the holders of each
class of claims and interests, the Bankruptcy Code requires a bankruptcy court to determine that such Plan is in the best interests of all holders of claims or interests that are impaired by that Plan and that have not accepted the Plan. The
best interests test, as set forth in section 1129(a)(7) of the Bankruptcy Code, requires a bankruptcy court to find either that all members of an impaired class of claims or interests have accepted the plan or that the plan will provide
a member who has not accepted the plan with a recovery of property of a value, as of the effective date of the plan, that is not less than the amount that such holder would recover if the debtor were liquidated under chapter 7 of the Bankruptcy
Code.
To calculate the probable distribution to holders of each impaired class of claims and interests if the Debtors were liquidated
under chapter 7, a bankruptcy court must first determine the aggregate dollar amount that would be generated from a debtors assets if its chapter 11 cases were converted to chapter 7 cases under the Bankruptcy Code. Because the Plan is a
liquidating plan, the liquidation value in the hypothetical chapter 7 liquidation analysis for purposes of the best interests test is substantially similar to the estimates of the results of the chapter 11 liquidation
contemplated by the Plan. However, the Debtors believe that in a chapter 7 liquidation, there would be additional costs and expenses that the Estates would incur as a result of liquidating the Estates in a chapter 7 case.
Costs of liquidation under chapter 7 of the Bankruptcy Code would include the compensation of a trustee, as well as of counsel and other
professionals retained by the trustee, all unpaid expenses incurred by the debtor in its Chapter 11 Cases (such as compensation of attorneys, financial advisors and accountants) that are allowed in the chapter 7 cases, litigation costs, and claims
arising from the operations of the debtor during the pendency of the Chapter 11 Cases.
If these cases were to be converted to chapter 7 cases, the
Debtors Estates would incur the costs of payment of a statutorily allowed commission to the chapter 7 trustee, as well as the costs of counsel and other professionals retained by the trustee. The Debtors believe such
73
amount would exceed the amount of expenses that would be incurred in implementing the Plan and winding up the affairs of the Debtors. Conversion also would likely delay the liquidation
process and ultimately distribution to unsecured creditors. The Debtors Estates would also be obligated to pay all unpaid expenses incurred by the Debtors during these Chapter 11 Cases (such as compensation for professionals) which are
allowed in the chapter 7 cases. Accordingly, the Debtors believe that holders of Allowed Claims would receive less than anticipated under the Plan if the Chapter 11 Cases were converted to chapter 7 cases. A hypothetical liquidation analysis is
included as
Exhibit C.
Section 1129(a)(11) of the Bankruptcy Code requires that confirmation
of the Plan is not likely to be followed by the liquidation, or the need for further financial reorganization, of the Debtors or any successors to the Debtors under the Plan, unless such liquidation or reorganization is proposed in the Plan.
Inasmuch as the Debtors have been liquidated and the Plan provides for the distribution of all of the proceeds of that liquidation to holders of claims that are allowed as of the Effective Date, the Plan is effectively exempted from the feasibility
requirements in accordance with the express terms of section 1129(a)(11) of the Bankruptcy Code.
ARTICLE VIII
EFFECT OF CONFIRMATION
A. |
Binding Effect of Confirmation |
Confirmation will bind the Debtors and all Holders of
Claims and Interests to the provisions of the Plan, whether or not the Claim or Interest of any such Holder is Impaired under the Plan and whether or not any such Holder of a Claim or Interest has accepted the Plan. Confirmation will have the effect
of converting all claims into rights to receive the treatment specified in Article IVA hereof and cancelling all Interests in Dendreon Corporation.
Confirmation of the Plan will constitute a finding that: (i) the Plan
has been proposed in good faith and in compliance with applicable provisions of the Bankruptcy Code; and (ii) all solicitations of acceptances or rejections of the Plan have been in good faith and in compliance with applicable provisions of the
Bankruptcy Code.
ARTICLE IX
RELEASES
Pursuant to
Section 10.4 of the Plan, the Debtors will provide releases (the Debtor Third Party Releases), as of the Effective Date, of, among other things, certain claims, rights, and causes of action that the Debtors may have against
the following: (a) the Committee and, solely in their respective capacities as members or representatives of the Committee, (and not as individual lenders or creditors to or on behalf of the Debtors), each member of the Committee;
74
(b) the Released Parties;10 (c) each of the respective agents, advisors, accountants, investment bankers, consultants, attorneys and
other representatives of any of the foregoing or of the Debtors, solely in their respective capacities as such; and (d) all individuals serving, or who have served, since the Petition Date, as a director or officer of the Debtors (the
Debtor Third Party Releasees).
Section 10.4 of the Plan also provides for certain releases by the Released
Parties and Holders of Claims (excluding any of the Debtors), including each Claimholder deemed to accept the Plan pursuant to section 1126(f) of the Bankruptcy Code (the Non Debtor Third Party Releases, and together with the
Debtor Third Party Releases, the Third Party Releases) of (a) the Released Parties, (b) the Committee, (c) each of their respective agents, advisors, accountants, investment bankers, consultants, attorneys and other
representatives, solely in their respective capacities as such, and only with respect to their activities and conduct during or in connection with the Chapter 11 Cases, (d) all individuals serving, or who have served, since the Petition Date,
as a manager, director, managing member, officer, partner, agent, employee, attorney or other advisor of the Debtors and (e) any successors or assigns of the foregoing (the Non Debtor Third Party Releasees, and together with
the Debtor Third Party Releasees, the Releasees).
The Third Party Releases satisfy the test applied to third party
releases in In re Master Mortgage Investment Fund, Inc., 168 B.R. 930, 934-35 (Bankr. W.D. Mo. 1994) and applied to debtor releases in In re Zenith Electronics Corp., 241 B.R. 92 (Bankr. D. Del. 1999). The Master Mortgage
factors include: (a) whether an identity of interest between the debtors and the releasees exists, such that a suit against the releasees is, in essence, a suit against the debtors or would deplete assets of the estates; (b) whether the
releasees have made a substantial contribution to the reorganization; (c) the essential nature of the releases to the likelihood of success of the reorganization; (d) whether a substantial majority of the impacted creditors support the
plan; and (e) whether the plan pays substantially all of the claims of the impacted creditors. 168 B.R. at 935. The Master Mortgage factors are not a rigid test; rather, the court should engage in a fact specific review, weighing
the equities of [the individual] case. Id. Further, the factors are not an exclusive list of considerations, nor are they a list of conjunctive requirements. Id.
The Debtors submit that the Third Party Releases set forth in the Plan satisfy the Master Mortgage factors. First, certain of the
Releasees share an identity of interest with the Debtors because the Debtors have an obligation to indemnify them for claims arising out of their services or contracts with the Debtors. Thus, a suit against these Releasees would, in essence, be a
claim against the Debtors. In addition, the Debtors and many of the Released Parties share the common goal of confirming the Plan, as the Plan represents the culmination of the broad
10 |
Released Party as defined in the Plan means each of the following (a) the Deerfield Noteholders, (b) the Unaffiliated Noteholders, (c) the 2016 Notes Trustee, and (d) with respect to each
of the foregoing persons in clauses (a) through (c), such Persons current and former subsidiaries, Affiliates, members, directors, officers, principals, agents, financial advisors, restructuring advisors, accountants, investment bankers,
consultants, attorneys, employees, partners, equity holders, representatives, and other professionals, in each case, only in their capacity as such. |
75
negotiations among the Debtors, the Supporting Noteholders and the Committee that were documented in the settlement in connection with the Amended and Restated Plan Support Agreements.
Second, all of the Releasees have made substantial contributions to the Chapter 11 Cases and to the Plan process. The Supporting
Noteholders releases were negotiated as part of the Plan Support Agreements. The keystone of the Plan Support Agreements was a competitive process pursuant to which the Debtors would sell all or substantially all of their assets. The Plan
Support Agreements allowed the Debtors to set a floor price for a potential sale, which resulted in the successful sale of substantially all of the Debtors assets to a subsidiary of Valeant. The premise of the Plan is to distribute the
proceeds of that sale. The Plan Support Agreements further assisted the Debtors by providing concrete evidence to the market of the support of the Supporting Noteholders, which in turn provided stability to the Debtors business while they
navigated the chapter 11 process and pursued a sale of their assets. The Plan Support Agreements enabled the Debtors to make a strong statement to all stakeholders, including doctors, patients, distributors, vendors and employees that the business
was secure and viable and to assure such parties that PROVENGE would continue to be available. This stability also provided certainty to potential purchasers as to the viability of the Debtors business, allowing the Debtors to maximize value
for all stakeholders through the sale process. The Supporting Noteholders have continued to contribute to the Chapter 11 Cases through their oversight of the Debtors liquidation efforts and by negotiating and supporting the Plan.
The Committee has also contributed substantially to the Chapter 11 Cases in that it ultimately supported the Debtors entry into the Plan
Support Agreements, was instrumental in negotiating the Plan and will assist in securing votes in favor of the Plan through its Letter of Support in connection with the Plan. In addition, as noted with respect to the Committee Members
Substantial Contribution claim, the Committee assisted greatly with the sale, specifically by (i) evaluating materials related to the sale of substantially all of the Debtors assets, including bids submitted to the Debtors,
(ii) negotiating with the Debtors and the Supporting Noteholders the terms of the potential plans for disposition of those assets, and (iii) facilitating compromise among the various parties.
The directors and officers of the Debtors similarly contributed to the Chapter 11 Cases, among other ways, through maintaining the stability
of the Debtors business operations during the liquidation, managing a work force in an uncertain work environment, assisting in negotiating the terms of the Plan Support Agreements, participating in the sale process throughout these Chapter 11
Cases, and assisting in an orderly and efficient wind-down of the Debtors estates.
In addition, the releases were an integral part
of the Supporting Noteholders agreement to enter into the Plan Support Agreements and, therefore, to support the Plan. Likewise, the releases are an integral part of the Committees decision to support the Plan and the Debtors entry into
the Plan Support Agreements.
Moreover, while it remains to be determined, the Debtors are optimistic that those classes entitled to vote,
will vote in favor of the Plan. The Supporting Noteholders hold approximately 85% of the Class 3, 2016 Noteholder Claims. Additionally, the Committee has provided a letter
76
of support recommending that holders of Class 4 General Unsecured Claims vote in favor of the Plan.
Further, the Plan provides a substantial distribution to the creditors in exchange for the Releases. The Debtors estimate that the recovery
under the Plan for holders of claims in Classes 3 and 4 will be approximately 72% to 75%. The Liquidation Analysis establishes that the distribution to creditors under the Plan would be lower in a liquidation, and absent the support of the
Releasees, liquidation of the Debtors may have been necessary. Finally, the Debtors do not believe there is any basis for the assertion of any claims against any of the Releasees. Based on the foregoing the Debtors believe the Third Party Releases
are appropriate and the Debtors will be prepared to meet their burden to establish the basis for each of the Third Party Releases as part of the confirmation of the Plan.
ARTICLE X
CERTAIN RISK
FACTORS TO BE CONSIDERED
THE PLAN AND ITS IMPLEMENTATION ARE SUBJECT TO CERTAIN RISKS, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE RISK
FACTORS SET FORTH BELOW. HOLDERS OF CLAIMS WHO ARE ENTITLED TO VOTE ON THE PLAN SHOULD READ AND CAREFULLY CONSIDER THE RISK FACTORS, AS WELL AS THE OTHER INFORMATION SET FORTH IN THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT AND THE PLAN, BEFORE DECIDING WHETHER TO
VOTE TO ACCEPT OR REJECT THE PLAN.
These risk factors should not, however, be regarded as constituting the only risks involved in
connection with the Plan and its implementation. No representations concerning or related to the Debtors, the Chapter 11 Cases or the Plan are authorized by the Court or the Bankruptcy Code, other than as set forth in this Disclosure Statement. Any
representations or inducements made to secure your acceptance or rejection of the Plan that are not contained in, or included with, this Disclosure Statement should not be relied upon by you in arriving at your decision.
A. |
Plan May Not Be Accepted |
There can be no assurance that the requisite acceptances to
confirm the Plan will be obtained. Thus, while the Debtors believe the Plan is confirmable under the standards set forth in section 1129 of the Bankruptcy Code, there is no guarantee that the Plan will be accepted by the requisite Classes entitled
to vote on the Plan.
B. |
Certain Bankruptcy Law Considerations |
Even if the Holders of Claims who are entitled
to vote accept the Plan, the Court, which may exercise substantial discretion as a court of equity, may choose not to confirm the Plan. Section 1129 of the Bankruptcy Code requires, among other things, that the value of distributions to
dissenting Holders of Claims or Interests may not be less than the value such Holders would receive if the Debtors were liquidated under chapter 7 of the Bankruptcy Code. Although the Debtors believe the Plan meets such requirement, there can be no
assurance the Court will reach the same conclusion.
77
C. |
Distributions to Holders of Allowed Claims Under The Plan |
Projected distributions are
based upon good faith estimates of the total amount of Claims ultimately Allowed and the funds available for distribution. Both the actual amount of Allowed Claims in a particular Class and the funds available for distribution to such Class may
differ from the Debtors estimates. If the total amount of Allowed Claims in a Class is higher than the Debtors estimates, or the funds available for distribution to such Class are lower than the Debtors estimates, the percentage
recovery to Holders of Allowed Claims in such Class will be less than projected.
D. |
Classification and Treatment of Claims and Equity Interests |
Section 1122 of the
Bankruptcy Code requires that the Plan classify Claims against, and Interests in, the Debtors. The Bankruptcy Code also provides that the Plan may place a Claim or Interest in a particular Class only if such Claim or Interest is substantially
similar to the other Claims or Interests of such Class. The Debtors believe that all Claims and Interests have been appropriately classified in the Plan.
To the extent that the Bankruptcy Court finds that a different classification is required for the Plan to be confirmed, the Debtors would seek
(i) to modify the Plan to provide for whatever classification might be required for confirmation and (ii) to use the acceptances received from any creditor pursuant to this solicitation for the purpose of obtaining the approval of the
Class or Classes of which such creditor ultimately is deemed to be a member. Any such reclassification of creditors, although subject to the notice and hearing requirements of the Bankruptcy Code, could adversely affect the Class in which such
creditor was initially a member, or any other Class under the Plan, by changing the composition of such Class and the vote required for approval of the Plan. There can be no assurance that the Bankruptcy Court, after finding that a classification
was inappropriate and requiring a reclassification, would approve the Plan based upon such reclassification. Except to the extent that modification of classification in the Plan requires resolicitation, the Debtors will, in accordance with the
Bankruptcy Code and the Bankruptcy Rules, seek a determination by the Bankruptcy Court that acceptance of the Plan of any Holder of Claims pursuant to this solicitation will constitute a consent to the Plans treatment of such Holder regardless
of the Class as to which such Holder is ultimately deemed to be a member. The Debtors believe that under the Bankruptcy Rules, they would be required to resolicit votes for or against the Plan only when a modification adversely affects the treatment
of the claim of any creditor or equity holder.
The Bankruptcy Code also requires that the Plan provide the same treatment for each Claim
or Interest of a particular Class unless the Holder of a particular Claim or Interest agrees to a less favorable treatment of its Claim or Interest. The Debtors believe that the Plan complies with the requirement of equal treatment. To the extent
that the Bankruptcy Court finds that the Plan does not satisfy such requirement, the Bankruptcy Court could deny confirmation of the Plan.
Issues or disputes relating to classification and/or treatment could result in a delay in the confirmation and consummation of the Plan and
could increase the risk that the Plan will not be consummated.
78
E. |
Conditions Precedent to Consummation of the Plan |
The Plan provides for certain
conditions that must be satisfied (or waived) prior to confirmation of the Plan and for certain other conditions that must be satisfied (or waived) prior to the Effective Date. As of the date of this Disclosure Statement, there can be no assurance
that any or all of the conditions in the Plan will be satisfied (or waived). Accordingly, there can be no assurance that the Plan will be confirmed by the Court. Further, if the Plan is confirmed, there can be no assurance that the Plan will be
consummated.
F. |
Certain Tax Considerations |
There are a number of material income tax considerations,
risks and uncertainties associated with consummation of the Plan. Holders of Claims and other interested parties should read carefully the discussion of certain U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Plan set forth below.
ARTICLE XI
CERTAIN
FEDERAL AND SECURITIES LAW MATTERS
The Debtors believe that, subject to certain exceptions described below, various provisions of the
Securities Act, the Bankruptcy Code, and state securities laws exempt from federal and state securities registration requirements (a) the offer and sale of securities pursuant to the Plan and (b) subsequent transfers of such securities.
A. |
Offer and Sale of Valeant Shares: Bankruptcy Code Exemption |
Pursuant to the Plan, in
full satisfaction, settlement, release and discharge of their allowed claims, each holder of a 2016 Noteholder Claim will receive, among other consideration, its pro rata distribution of Valeant Shares. Section 1145(a)(1) of the Bankruptcy Code
exempts the offer and sale of securities under a plan from registration under Section 5 of the Securities Act and state laws if three principal requirements are satisfied: (1) the securities must be offered or sold under a plan
by the debtor or its successor under a plan or by an affiliate participating in a joint plan of reorganization with the debtor; (2) the recipients of the securities must hold a claim against, an interest in, or a claim for administrative
expenses in the case concerning the debtor or such affiliate; and (3) the securities must be offered or sold in exchange for the recipients claim against or interest in the debtor, or such affiliate, or principally in such
exchange and partly for cash or property. In reliance upon this exemption, the Debtors believe that the offer and sale of the Valeant Shares under the Plan (including the distribution of Valeant Shares to each holder of a 2016 Noteholder
Claim) will be exempt from registration under the Securities Act and state securities laws, and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder.
As part of the relief in connection with the approval of this Disclosure Statement, the Debtors sought an order from the Court authorizing the
Debtors to offer and sell the Valeant Shares exempt from registration under the Securities Act and state securities laws pursuant to section 1145(a)(1) of the Bankruptcy Code and pursuant to the safe harbor contained in Bankruptcy Code section
1125(e). The Court entered the Solicitation Procedures Order authorizing this relief on April 14, 2015. The Solicitation Procedures Order also provides that
79
Valeant is a successor to the Company under the Plan for purposes of section 1145 of the Bankruptcy Code.
B. |
Subsequent Transfers of Valeant Shares Received under the Plan |
Section 1145(c) of
the Bankruptcy Code provides that the offer or sale of securities in a transaction of the kind referred to in Section 1145(a)(1) is deemed to be a public offering, except with respect to an underwriter under Section 1145(b) of
the Bankruptcy Code, which includes any affiliate of the issuer. As such, the securities received in such offering are not restricted securities under Rule 144 of the Securities Act. Moreover, the exemption set forth in
Section 4(a)(1) of the Securities Act would apply to resales of such securities without registration as long as such person is not (i) an underwriter, (ii) an issuer, or (iii) a dealer. Further,
Section 1145(b)(3) specifically provides that if a recipient of securities issued under a plan pursuant to Bankruptcy Code Section 1145(a) is not an underwriter under section 1145(b)(1) Bankruptcy Code, then such a person is
not deemed to be an underwriter under section 2(a)(11) of the Securities Act. Therefore, unless such person is an affiliate of the issuer or a dealer, the exemption under Section 4(a)(1) of the Securities Act will
apply in these circumstances.
As part of the relief in connection with the approval of this Disclosure Statement, the Debtors sought an
order from the Court finding that the Valeant Shares may be resold by the holders thereof without restriction except to the extent that any such holder is deemed to be (i) an underwriter as defined in Section 1145(b)(1) of the
Bankruptcy Code, (ii) an issuer or an affiliate of an issuer, or (iii) a dealer. As noted previously, the Court entered the Solicitation Procedures Order authorizing this relief on April 14, 2015.
Section 1145(b) of the Bankruptcy Code defines the term underwriter for purposes of the Securities Act as one who, except
with respect to ordinary trading transactions of an entity that is not an issuer, (1) purchases a claim against, interest in, or claim for an administrative expense in the case concerning the debtor, if such purchase is
with a view to distributing any security received in exchange for such a claim or interest; (2) offers to sell securities offered or sold under a plan for the holders of such securities; (3) offers to buy securities offered or sold under
the plan from the holders of such securities, if the offer to buy is: (a) with a view to distribution of such securities and (b) under an agreement made in connection with the plan, with the consummation of the plan, or with the offer or
sale of securities under the plan; or (4) is an issuer with respect to the securities, as the term issuer is defined in Section 2(a)(11) of the Securities Act.
The term issuer is defined in Section 2(a)(4) of the Securities Act; however, the reference contained in Sections
1145(b)(1)(D) and 1145(b)(3) of the Bankruptcy Code to Section 2(a)(11) of the Securities Act purports to include as statutory underwriters all persons who, directly or indirectly, through one or more intermediaries, control, are controlled by,
or are under common control with, an issuer of securities. Control (as such term is defined in Rule 405 of Regulation C under the Securities Act) means the possession, direct or indirect, of the power to direct or cause the direction of
the policies of a person, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract, or otherwise. Accordingly, an officer or director of a reorganized debtor (or its successor) under a plan may be deemed to be a control person,
particularly if such management position is coupled with the ownership of a significant percentage of the debtors
80
(or successors) voting securities. Ownership of a significant amount of voting securities of a reorganized debtor or its successor could also result in a person being considered to be a
control person.
Section 2(a)(12) of the Securities Act defines a dealer as any person who engages either for
all or part of his time, directly or indirectly, as agent, broker, or principal, in the business of offering, buying, selling, or otherwise dealing or trading in securities issued by another person.
To the extent that persons deemed to be underwriters, affiliates of the issuer or dealers receive Valeant
Shares pursuant to the Plan, resales by such persons would not be exempted by Section 1145 of the Bankruptcy Code from registration under the Securities Act or other applicable law. Such persons would not be permitted to resell such Valeant
Shares, unless such securities were registered under the Securities Act or an exemption from such registration requirements were available. Entities deemed to be statutory underwriters for purposes of Section 1145 of the Bankruptcy Code may,
however, be able, at a future time and under certain conditions, to sell securities without registration pursuant to the resale provisions of Rule 144 under the Securities Act or another available exemption under the Securities Act.
Whether or not any particular person would be deemed to be an underwriters, affiliates of the issuer or
dealers with respect to the Valeant Shares to be issued pursuant to the Plan, or an affiliate of the Debtor(s), would depend upon various facts and circumstances applicable to that person.
Accordingly, the Debtors express no view as to whether any such person would be such an underwriters, affiliates of
the issuer or dealers. PERSONS WHO RECEIVE VALEANT SHARES UNDER THE PLAN ARE URGED TO CONSULT THEIR OWN LEGAL ADVISOR WITH RESPECT TO THE RESTRICTIONS APPLICABLE UNDER THE SECURITIES LAWS AND THE CIRCUMSTANCES UNDER WHICH SECURITIES MAY
BE SOLD IN RELIANCE ON SUCH LAWS.
THE FOREGOING SUMMARY DISCUSSION IS GENERAL IN NATURE AND HAS BEEN INCLUDED IN THIS DISCLOSURE
STATEMENT SOLELY FOR INFORMATIONAL PURPOSES. THE DEBTORS MAKE NO REPRESENTATIONS CONCERNING, AND DO NOT PROVIDE, ANY OPINIONS OR ADVICE WITH RESPECT TO THE VALEANT SHARES OR THE BANKRUPTCY MATTERS DESCRIBED IN THIS DISCLOSURE STATEMENT. IN LIGHT OF
THE UNCERTAINTY CONCERNING THE AVAILABILITY OF EXEMPTIONS FROM THE RELEVANT PROVISIONS OF FEDERAL AND STATE SECURITIES LAWS, THE DEBTORS ENCOURAGE EACH 2016 NOTEHOLDER AND PARTY IN INTEREST TO CONSIDER CAREFULLY AND CONSULT WITH ITS OWN LEGAL
ADVISORS WITH RESPECT TO ALL SUCH MATTERS. BECAUSE OF THE COMPLEX, SUBJECTIVE NATURE OF THE QUESTION OF WHETHER A PARTICULAR 2016 NOTEHOLDER MAY BE AN UNDERWRITER, AFFILIATE OF AN ISSUER OR DEALER, THE DEBTORS MAKE NO REPRESENTATION CONCERNING THE
ABILITY OF A PERSON TO DISPOSE OF THE VALEANT SHARES.
81
ARTICLE XII
CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES OF THE PLAN
The following discussion is a summary of certain U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Plan to the Debtors and to holders of 2016
Noteholder Claims and General Unsecured Claims. This discussion is based on the Tax Code, Treasury Regulations promulgated and proposed thereunder, judicial decisions and published administrative rules and pronouncements of the Internal Revenue
Service (IRS), all as in effect on the date hereof.
Due to the complexity of certain aspects of the Plan, the lack of
applicable legal precedent, the possibility of changes in the law, the differences in the nature of the Claims, each holders status and method of accounting and the potential for disputes as to legal and factual matters with the IRS, the tax
consequences described herein are uncertain. No legal opinions have been requested from counsel with respect to any of the tax aspects of the Plan and no rulings have been or will be requested from the IRS with respect to the any of the issues
discussed below. Further, legislative, judicial or administrative changes may occur, perhaps with retroactive effect, which could affect the accuracy of the statements and conclusions set forth below as well as the tax consequences to the Debtors
and the holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims and General Unsecured Claims.
The following summary does not address the U.S. federal income
tax consequences to creditors whose Claims are unimpaired or otherwise entitled to payment in full in Cash under the Plan (e.g., Priority Non-Tax Claims and Secured Claims), holders of Interests or Subordinated Claims, or purchasers of Claims
following the Effective Date. This discussion assumes that the holder has not taken a bad debt deduction with respect to a Claim (or any portion thereof) in the current or any prior year and such Claim did not become completely or partially
worthless in a prior taxable year. This discussion does not purport to address all aspects of U.S. federal income taxation that may be relevant to the Debtors or the holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims or General Unsecured Claims in light of their
personal circumstances, nor does the discussion deal with tax issues with respect to taxpayers subject to special treatment under the U.S. federal income tax laws (including, for example, broker dealers, insurance companies, financial institutions,
real estate investment trusts, tax-exempt organizations, small business investment companies, regulated investment companies, persons whose functional currency is not the U.S. dollar, persons subject to the alternative minimum tax or the unearned
income Medicare contribution tax, persons owning 5% or more of Valeant after the Effective Date, and persons holding Claims as part of a straddle, hedge, constructive sale or conversion
transaction with other investments). No aspect of foreign, state, local or estate and gift taxation is addressed.
The Debtors
believe, and the following discussion generally assumes, that the Plan implements the liquidation of the Debtors for U.S. federal income tax purposes and that all distributions to holders of Claims will be taxed accordingly (including as
distributions pursuant to the Plan for U.S. federal income tax purposes).
EACH HOLDER OF A 2016 NOTEHOLDER CLAIM OR GENERAL UNSECURED
CLAIM IS URGED TO CONSULT SUCH HOLDERS TAX ADVISORS CONCERNING
82
THE U.S. FEDERAL, STATE, LOCAL, FOREIGN AND OTHER TAX CONSEQUENCES OF THE PLAN.
A. |
Tax Consequences to Certain Creditors |
The following generally discusses the U.S.
federal income tax consequences of the Plan to holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims and General Unsecured Claims. Additional potential U.S. federal income tax consequences potentially applicable to such holders are discussed below under Tax
Treatment of Liquidating Trusts.
|
1. |
Holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims |
It is intended that the receipt of Valeant Shares
and Available Cash in exchange for 2016 Noteholder Claims be treated as part of a reorganization for U.S. federal income tax purposes. The classification of an exchange as part of a reorganization for U.S. federal income tax purposes
generally serves to defer the recognition of any gain or loss realized by the holder. Assuming qualification as a reorganization:
|
|
|
a holder should recognize any gain to the extent of any cash and the fair market value of any property (other than Valeant Shares, but including, if a liquidating trust is established, the fair market value of its share
of the assets of the liquidating trust, as described below) received. Such holder will also have interest income to the extent of any consideration allocable to accrued but unpaid interest. See Distributions With Respect to Accrued But Unpaid
Interest, below. |
|
|
|
A holders aggregate tax basis in the Valeant Shares received should equal the holders aggregate adjusted tax basis in the 2016 Noteholder Claims exchanged therefor, increased by any gain or interest income
recognized by the holder with respect to the exchange, and decreased by any deductions claimed in respect of any previously accrued but unpaid interest and any consideration received other than Valeant Shares (i.e., any Cash and the fair market
value of any other property received, whether on or after the Effective Date). |
|
|
|
A holders holding period in the Valeant Shares received should include the holders holding period in the Claims exchanged therefor, except to the extent of any exchange consideration received in respect of a
Claim for accrued but unpaid interest (which will commence a new holding period for the Valeant Shares attributed thereto). |
If the exchange does not qualify for reorganization treatment, the holder should generally have tax consequences as described below with
respect to General Unsecured Claims (taking into account the fair market value of the Valeant Shares received).
|
2. |
Holders of General Unsecured Claims |
Pursuant to the Plan, the holders of General
Unsecured Claims will receive, in respect of their Claims, solely their share of Available Cash. Generally, a holder of a General Unsecured Claim should in most, but not all circumstances, recognize gain or loss equal to the difference
83
between the amount of cash (and, if a liquidating trust is established, the fair market value of their share of the assets of the liquidating trust, as described below) received by such holder
pursuant to the Plan in exchange for its Claim and such holders adjusted tax basis in the Claim.
|
3. |
Character of Gain or Loss |
To the extent applicable, the character of any recognized
gain or loss (e.g., ordinary income, or short-term or long-term capital gain or loss) will depend upon the status of the holder, the nature of the Claim in the holders hands, the purpose and circumstances of its acquisition, the holders
holding period of the Claim, whether payments are received in respect thereof in more than one taxable year, and the extent to which the holder previously claimed a deduction for the worthlessness of all or a portion of the Claim. Generally, if the
Claim is a capital asset in the holders hands, any gain or loss realized generally will be characterized as capital gain or loss, and will constitute long-term capital gain or loss if the holder has held such Claim for more than one year.
If a holder acquired its Claim after its original issuance at a market discount (generally defined as the amount, if any, by which
the debt obligations adjusted issue price exceeds the holders tax basis in a debt obligation immediately after its acquisition, subject to a de minimis exception), the holder generally will be required to treat any gain recognized
pursuant to the Plan as ordinary income to the extent of the market discount accrued during the holders period of ownership, unless the holder elected to include the market discount in income as it accrued.
The treatment of accrued market discount in a nonrecognition transaction is subject to the issuance of Treasury Regulations that have not yet
been promulgated. In the absence of such regulations, the application of the market discount rules in the present transaction is uncertain. In the case of a reorganization exchange, the Tax Code indicates that, under Treasury regulations to be
issued, any accrued market discount in respect of a Claim in excess of the gain recognized in the exchange should not be currently includible in income. However, such accrued market discount should carry over to any non-recognition property received
in exchange therefor (i.e., to the Valeant Shares received in the exchange), such that any gain recognized by the holder upon a subsequent disposition of such exchange consideration would be treated as ordinary income to the extent of the accrued
market discount allocable thereto not previously included in income. A holder of a market discount bond that is required under the market discount rules of the Tax Code to defer deduction of all or a portion of the interest on indebtedness incurred
or maintained to acquire or carry the bond may be allowed to deduct such interest, in whole or in part, on disposition of such bond for cash. However, continued deferral of the deduction for interest may be required to the extent attributable to the
Valeant Shares received in exchange for the Claim, and would be treated as interest paid or accrued in the year in which the Valeant Shares are disposed. To date, specific Treasury regulations implementing this rule have not been issued.
|
4. |
Distributions with Respect to Accrued but Unpaid Interest |
In general, to the extent
that any consideration received pursuant to the Plan by a holder of a Claim (whether in cash, Valeant Shares or other property) is received in satisfaction of interest accrued but unpaid during its holding period, such amount will be taxable to the
holder as interest income (if not previously included in the holders gross income).
84
Conversely, a holder generally recognizes a deductible loss to the extent that any accrued interest was previously included in its gross income and is not paid in full.
Pursuant to the Plan, all distributions in respect of Allowed Claims will be allocated first to the principal amount of such Claims, as
determined for U.S. federal income tax purposes, and thereafter to any remaining portion of such Claim (including accrued but unpaid interest). However, there is no assurance that such allocation would be respected by the IRS for U.S. federal income
tax purposes. Each holder of a Claim is urged to consult its tax advisor regarding the allocation of consideration to, and the deductibility of a loss with respect to, accrued but unpaid interest for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
|
5. |
Non-United States Persons |
A holder of a Claim that is not a United States
Person within the meaning of the Tax Code (a Non-U.S. Holder) generally will not be subject to United States federal income tax with respect to property (including money) received in exchange for such Claim pursuant to the
Plan, unless (i) such holder is engaged in a trade or business in the United States to which income, gain or loss (unless an applicable income tax treaty provides otherwise) from the exchange is effectively connected for United
States federal income tax purposes, or (ii) if such holder is an individual, such holder is present in the United States for 183 days or more during the taxable year of the exchange and certain other requirements are met (unless an applicable
income tax treaty provides otherwise).
Payments to a Non-U.S. Holder that are attributable to accrued interest generally will not be
subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax, provided that the withholding agent has received or receives, prior to payment, appropriate documentation (generally, an IRS Form W-8BEN IRS Form W-8BEN-E, or a successor form) establishing that the
Non-U.S. Holder is not a U.S. person, unless:
(i) the Non-U.S. Holder actually or constructively owns 10% or more of the total combined
voting power of all classes of Dendreons stock that are entitled to vote,
(ii) the Non-U.S. Holder is a controlled foreign
corporation that is a related person with respect to Dendreon (each, within the meaning of the Tax Code), or
(iii) such
interest is effectively connected with the conduct by the Non-U.S. Holder of a trade or business within the United States (in which case, provided the Non-U.S. Holder provides a properly-executed IRS Form W-8ECI (or successor form) to the
withholding agent, the Non-U.S. Holder (x) generally will not be subject to withholding tax, but (y) will be subject to U.S. federal income tax in the same manner as a U.S. Holder (unless an applicable income tax treaty provides
otherwise), and a Non-U.S. Holder that is a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes may also be subject to a branch profits tax with respect to such Non-U.S. Holders effectively connected earnings and profits that are attributable to
the interest at a rate of 30% (or at a reduced rate or exemption from tax under an applicable income tax treaty).
A Non-U.S. Holder that
does not qualify for exemption from withholding tax with respect to interest that is not effectively connected income generally will be subject to withholding of U.S. federal income tax at a 30% rate (or at a reduced rate or exemption from tax
85
under an applicable income tax treaty) on payments that are attributable to accrued interest. For purposes of providing a properly executed IRS Form W-8BEN or W-8BEN-E, special procedures are
provided under applicable Treasury regulations for payments through qualified foreign intermediaries or certain financial institutions that hold customers securities in the ordinary course of their trade or business. To claim the benefits of a
treaty, a Non-U.S. Holder must provide a properly-executed IRS Form W-8BEN or W8BEN-E (or a successor form) prior to the payment.
Non-U.S. Holders of Valeant Shares should consult their own tax advisors concerning the tax consequences of receiving and holding such stock
in their particular circumstances.
B. |
Tax Consequences to the Debtors |
The Debtors expect to remain in existence following
the Effective Date, but in accordance with the Asset Purchase Agreement, in no event will they remain in existence for U.S. federal income tax purposes beyond December 31, 2015; however, the sole purpose of their remaining in existence is the
liquidation of any remaining assets and the winding-up of their affairs. Accordingly, the Debtors intend to treat the Plan as the implementation of the liquidation of the Debtors in furtherance of the Plan for U.S. federal income tax purposes and in
furtherance of the treatment of the Plan, in conjunction with the Sale Transaction, as a reorganization pursuant to Section 368(a)(1)(G) of the Tax Code.
Pursuant to the terms of the Sale Transaction, the parties will elect to treat Dendreons tax year as ending on the closing date of the
Sale Transaction. As a result of the election, pursuant to the Tax Code and regulations promulgated thereunder, Dendreons tax attributes (e.g., tax asset basis, net operating losses (NOLs) and NOL carryforwards), as reduced
by any cancellation of indebtedness (COD) income realized by Dendreon after the Sale Transaction, will transfer to Purchaser as of the closing date.
Because of the lack of direct authoritative guidance as to the survival and utilization of NOL carryforwards and the timing of recognition of
COD in the context of a bankruptcy liquidation, there is a risk that certain favorable tax attributes of the Debtors (including any NOL carryforwards incurred since the Sale Transaction and any NOLs incurred through the end of the taxable year in
which the Plan becomes effective) may be substantially reduced, eliminated, or subjected to significant limitations as the result of implementation of the Plan. The Debtors believe that, notwithstanding the potential for attribute reduction,
elimination, or limitation, implementation of the Plan (including any distribution to a liquidating trust or other liquidating vehicle) should not cause them to incur a material amount of U.S. federal income tax.
C. |
Tax Treatment of Liquidating Trusts |
A liquidating trust may be established for the
benefit of holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims and General Unsecured Claims in furtherance of the liquidation of the Debtors for U.S. federal income tax purposes. This Section applies unless an election is made under Treasury Regulations
Section 1.468B-9 treat the trust as a disputed ownership fund.
86
|
1. |
Classification of Liquidating Trusts |
If established, such liquidating trust will be
intended to qualify as a liquidating trust for U.S. federal income tax purposes. In general, a liquidating trust is not a separate taxable entity but rather is treated for U.S. federal income tax purposes as a grantor trust
(i.e., a pass-through entity). The IRS, in Revenue Procedure 94-45, 1994-2 C.B. 684, set forth the general criteria for obtaining an IRS ruling as to the grantor trust status of a liquidating trust under a chapter 11 plan. The liquidating trust will
be structured with the intention of complying with such general criteria. Pursuant to the Plan, and in conformity with Revenue Procedure 94-45, all parties (including the liquidating trustee and the holders of beneficial interests in the liquidating
trust) will be required to treat for U.S. federal income tax purposes the liquidating trust as a grantor trust of which the holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims and General Unsecured Claims are the owners and grantors. While the following discussion
assumes that the liquidating trust would be so treated for U.S. federal income tax purposes, no ruling will be requested from the IRS concerning the tax status of the liquidating trust as a grantor trust. Accordingly, there can be no assurance that
the IRS would not take a contrary position to the classification of the liquidating trust as a grantor trust. If the IRS were to challenge successfully such classification, the U.S. federal income tax consequences to the liquidating trust and the
holders of Claims could vary from those discussed herein.
|
2. |
General Tax Reporting by Trusts and Beneficiaries |
For all U.S. federal income tax
purposes, all parties (including the liquidating trustee and the holders of beneficial interests in the liquidating trust) will be required to treat the transfer of assets to the liquidating trust, in accordance with the terms of the Plan, as a
transfer of those assets directly to the holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims and General Unsecured Claims in respect of their Allowed Claims (see Article XIIA for a discussion of the tax treatment of such Claims) followed by the transfer of such
assets by such holders to the liquidating trust. Consistent therewith, all parties will be required to treat the liquidating trust as a grantor trust of which such holders are to be owners and grantors. Thus, such holders (and any subsequent holders
of interests in the liquidating trust) will be treated as the direct owners of an undivided beneficial interest in the assets of the liquidating trust for all U.S. federal income tax purposes. Accordingly, each holder of a beneficial interest in the
liquidating trust will be required to report on its U.S. federal income tax return(s) the holders allocable share of all income, gain, loss, deduction or credit recognized or incurred by the liquidating trust.
The U.S. federal income tax reporting obligation of a holder of a beneficial interest in the liquidating trust is not dependent upon the
liquidating trust distributing any cash or other proceeds. Therefore, a holder of a beneficial interest in the liquidating trust may incur a U.S. federal income tax liability regardless of the fact that the liquidating trust has not made, or will
not make, any concurrent or subsequent distributions to the holder. If a holder incurs a federal tax liability but does not receive distributions commensurate with the taxable income allocated to it in respect of its beneficial interests in the
liquidating trust it holds, the holder may be allowed a subsequent or offsetting loss.
The liquidating trustee will file tax returns with
the IRS for the liquidating trust as a grantor trust pursuant to Treasury Regulations Section 1.671-4(a). The liquidating trustee will
87
also send to each holder of a beneficial interest in the liquidating trust a separate statement setting forth the holders share of items of income, gain, loss, deduction or credit and will
instruct the holder to report such items on its U.S. federal income tax return.
|
3. |
Allocations of Taxable Income and Loss |
The liquidating trusts taxable income
will be allocated to the holders of beneficial interests in the liquidating trust in accordance with each such holders pro rata share of the liquidating trusts interests. The character of items of income, deduction and credit to any
holder and the ability of such holder to benefit from any deductions or losses may depend on the particular situation of such holder.
Any
amount a holder receives as a distribution from the liquidating trust in respect of its beneficial interest in the liquidating trust should not be included, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, in the holders amount realized in respect of its
Allowed Claim but should be separately treated as a distribution received in respect of such holders beneficial interest in the liquidating trust.
In general, a holders aggregate tax basis in its undivided beneficial interest in the assets transferred to the liquidating trust will
equal the fair market value of such undivided beneficial interest in the assets as of the date the assets are transferred to the trust and the holders holding period in such assets will begin the day following its receipt of such interest.
If established, the liquidating trustee will, in good faith, value the liquidating trust assets, and will (to the extent relevant, from
time to time) apprise the holders of beneficial interests in the liquidating trust of such valuation. The valuation is required to be used consistently by all parties (including the Debtors, the trustee and the holders) for all U.S. federal income
tax purposes, including applicable reporting requirements. The Court will resolve any dispute regarding the valuation of the assets.
D. |
Importance of Obtaining Professional Tax Assistance |
THE FOREGOING DISCUSSION IS INTENDED ONLY AS A
SUMMARY OF CERTAIN INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES OF THE PLAN. THE ABOVE DISCUSSION IS FOR INFORMATIONAL PURPOSES ONLY AND IS NOT TAX ADVICE. THE TAX CONSEQUENCES ARE IN MANY CASES UNCERTAIN AND MAY VARY DEPENDING ON A CLAIM HOLDERS PARTICULAR
CIRCUMSTANCES. ACCORDINGLY, CLAIM HOLDERS ARE URGED TO CONSULT THEIR TAX ADVISORS ABOUT THE UNITED STATES FEDERAL, STATE AND LOCAL, AND APPLICABLE FOREIGN INCOME AND OTHER TAX CONSEQUENCES OF THE PLAN.
ARTICLE XIII
RECOMMENDATION AND CONCLUSION
This Disclosure Statement was approved by the Court after notice and a hearing. The Court has determined that this Disclosure Statement
contains information adequate to permit
88
holders of Claims to make an informed judgment about the Plan. Such approval, however, does not mean that the Court recommends either acceptance or rejection of the Plan.
The Debtors believe that confirmation and consummation of the Plan is in the best interests of the Debtors, their Estates and their creditors.
The Plan provides for an equitable distribution to creditors. The Debtors believe that any alternative to confirmation of the Plan, such as liquidation under chapter 7 of the Bankruptcy Code, could result in significant delay, litigation and
additional costs, as well as a reduction in the distributions to Holders of Claims in certain Classes. Consequently, the Debtors urge all eligible Holders of Impaired Claims to vote to ACCEPT the Plan, and to complete and return their Ballots so
that they will be RECEIVED by the Voting Agent on or before the Voting Deadline.
|
|
|
Dated: |
|
Wilmington, Delaware |
|
|
April 16, 2015 |
|
DENDREON CORPORATION, et al., |
Debtors and Debtors-in-Possession |
/s/ Robert L. Crotty |
Name: Robert L. Crotty |
Title: President, General Counsel and Secretary |
|
SKADDEN, ARPS, SLATE, MEAGHER & FLOM LLP
/s/ Sarah E. Pierce |
Anthony W. Clark (I.D. No. 2051) |
Sarah E. Pierce (I.D. No. 4648) |
One Rodney Square |
P.O. Box 636 |
Wilmington, Delaware 19899-0636 |
Telephone: (302) 651-3000 |
Fax: (302) 651-3001 |
|
- and - |
|
Kenneth S. Ziman |
Raquelle L. Kaye |
Four Times Square |
New York, New York 10036-6522 |
Telephone: (212) 735-3000 |
Fax: (212) 735-2000 |
|
- and - |
|
Felicia Gerber Perlman |
155 N. Wacker Drive |
Chicago, Illinois 60606-1720 |
Telephone: (312) 407-0700 |
Fax: (312) 407-0411 |
89
ANNEX 1
The views expressed in this Annex 1 are those of GlaxoSmithKline LLC ONLY. The Debtors do
NOT agree with the views expressed in this Annex 1. See Article II.D.1 of the Disclosure Statement.
In re Dendreon
Corporation, et al. Case No. 14-12515 (LSS)
GlaxoSmithKline LLCs Rider for Disclosure Statement1
|
GlaxoSmithKline LLC (GSK), which asserts that it is the largest unsecured creditors of the Debtors |
|
beside the holders of the 2016 Noteholder Claim, further asserts that the 2016 Noteholder Claim should be |
|
reduced in order to take into account an original issue discount (OID) associated with the conversion |
|
component of the 2016 Notes Indenture. A reduction of the 2016 Noteholder Claim would increase the |
|
recovery for Class 4 (General Unsecured Creditors). |
|
Specifically, by purchasing the 2016 Notes from the Debtors, the holders of the 2016 Noteholder Claim |
|
effectively purchased two instruments. First, they purchased a note that bore a below market interest rate |
|
and was worth less than the $620 million in face amount (the OID Note Component). The difference |
|
between the value of the OID Note Component and the face amount of the 2016 Notes is OID. Second, |
|
they purchased a derivative component that allowed an exchange of the OID Note Component into |
|
Dendreon common stock on the terms set forth in the Indenture (the Equity Derivative Component). The |
|
value of the OID Note Component and the Equity Derivative Component equaled approximately $620 |
|
million on the date that the 2016 Notes were issued. |
|
The Bankruptcy Code provides that a claim should be disallowed to the extent that it is unmatured |
|
interest. 11 U.S.C. § 502(b)(2). Courts generally have agreed that if a derivative, such as the Equity Derivative |
|
Component, does in fact constitute OID that can be separately valued, then the claim for such OID |
|
constitutes unmatured interest that should be disallowed pursuant to Bankruptcy Code section 502(b). See |
|
LTV Corp. v. Valley Fidelity Bank & Trust Co. (In re |
1 Capitalized terms not defined herein shall have the meanings ascribed to them in the First Amended Plan of Liquidation Pursuant to Chapter 11 of the Bankruptcy Code Proposed by the Debtors [Docket
No. 575] (the Plan).
1
The views expressed in this Annex 1 are those of GlaxoSmithKline LLC ONLY. The Debtors do
NOT agree with the views expressed in this Annex 1. See Article II.D.1 of the Disclosure Statement.
|
Chateaugay Corp.), 961 F.2d 378, 380 (2d Cir. 1992) (stating that unamortized OID is unmatured interest |
|
pursuant to Bankruptcy Code section 502(b); however, holding that a debt-for-debt face value exchange |
|
offered as part of a pre-bankruptcy consensual workout did not generate OID that was disallowable as |
|
unmatured interest pursuant to section 502(b) because such an exchange does not change the character of the |
|
debt, but reaffirms and modifies it.); see also In re Residential Capital, LLC, 501 B.R. 549, 586-87 (Bankr. |
|
S.D.N.Y. 2013) (agreeing with the Chateaugay court that unamortized OID is unmatured interest, and that |
|
despite the differences between face value and fair value debt-exchanges, the same rule on disallowance of |
|
[OID] should apply in both circumstances.); In re Allegheny Intl, Inc., 100 B.R. 247, 250 (Bankr. W.D. Pa. |
|
1989) (holding that original issue discount is unmatured interest, as that term is used in section 502(b)(2) |
|
and disallowing that portion of the claim in a debt-for-equity circumstance); In re Solutia Inc., |
|
379 B.R. 473, 486 (Bankr. S.D.N.Y. 2007) (holding that the value of noteholders claim is in the amount |
|
actually advanced on the notes, as well as the OID that matured prior to the petition date). |
|
The Bankruptcy Court should reduce the 2016 Noteholder Claim to account for the OID as it is |
|
unmatured interest under the Bankruptcy Code. See generally Brad B. Erens & Timothy W. Hoffman, Are |
|
Claims of Convertible Debt Holders at Risk in Bankruptcy?, Pratts J. of Bankr. L., 575, 578 (2010) (available |
|
at http://www.jonesday.com/files/Publication/1d49cb41-e5da-463a-a638-53a8f6dee0e3/Presentation/ |
|
PublicationAttachment/0015921a-aaac-4e82-8e26-556196ddc43d/ |
|
Are_The_Claims_of_Convertible%5B1%5D.pdf ); Peltz v. Welsh, Carson, Anderson & Stowe VII, L.P. |
|
(In re Bridge Info. Sys., Inc.), 311 B.R. 781 (Bankr. E.D. Mo. 2004) (holding the value of the options |
|
contained in the convertible debt instrument is separate consideration apart from the debtors unsecured |
|
obligation to repay the principal amount of the |
2
The views expressed in this Annex 1 are those of GlaxoSmithKline LLC ONLY. The Debtors do
NOT agree with the views expressed in this Annex 1. See Article II.D.1 of the Disclosure Statement.
|
loan.); Brown v. Sayyah (In re ICH Corp.), 230 B.R. 88 (N.D. Tex. 1999) (holding that a debenture should be |
|
independently valued, taking into consideration more than just the purchase price stated in an agreement for a |
|
stock purchase); Custom Chrome, Inc. v. Commr of Internal Revenue, 217 F.3d 1117 (9th Cir. 2000) (holding |
|
that warrants had independent value that resulted in OID and that value should be determined at the time of |
|
issuance, not at the time of exercising). |
|
Rather than discount the 2016 Noteholder Claim to reflect the OID, the Plan deems the claim allowed in |
|
full in the amount of $625,694,097.22. See Plan Article I § 1.2. The Debtors contention that no OID exists |
|
with respect to the 2016 Noteholder Claim suggests that the holders of the 2016 Noteholder Claim would |
|
have loaned the Debtors the same funds for 2.875% interest without a conversion component. This is not |
|
correct. The 2016 Noteholder Claim should be reduced to account for the OID associated with the |
|
conversion right provided to such holders under the 2016 Notes Indenture. |
3
EXHIBIT A
EXHIBIT B
EXHIBIT C
Dendreon Corporation, et al
Liquidation Analysis
Consolidated
($ in Thousands)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Consolidated Liquidation and Wind-Down * |
|
Notes |
|
|
|
Chapter 7 |
|
|
|
|
Chapter 11 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Assets |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash On Hand as of March 27, 2015 |
|
1 |
|
|
|
$ 458,672 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ 458,672 |
|
|
|
|
Litigation Proceeds and Other Receipts |
|
2 |
|
|
|
3,922 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,922 |
|
|
|
|
Business Unit Sales - Equity |
|
3 |
|
|
|
49,500 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
49,500 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total Assets/Proceeds |
|
|
|
|
|
512,094 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
512,094 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Wind-Down Expenses |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Wind-Down Reserve |
|
4 |
|
|
|
8,943 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7,154 |
|
|
|
|
Trustee Fees |
|
5 |
|
|
|
15,363 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- |
|
|
|
|
Professional Fee Reserve |
|
6 |
|
|
|
26,762 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
26,762 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total Wind-Down Expenses |
|
|
|
|
|
51,068
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
33,917
|
|
|
|
|
Net Proceeds Available for Payment of Claims |
|
|
|
|
|
461,026 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
478,178 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Post-Petition Claims |
|
7 |
|
|
|
3,162 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,162 |
|
|
|
|
Cure and Critical Vendor Costs |
|
8 |
|
|
|
895 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
895 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total Administrative Priority Claims |
|
|
|
|
|
4,057 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,057 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Excess in Proceeds over Administrative Claims |
|
|
|
|
|
456,970 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
474,121 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
General Unsecured Claims |
|
|
|
|
|
Low |
|
High |
|
|
|
|
Low |
|
High |
|
Allowed General Unsecured Claims |
|
9 |
|
|
|
625,695 |
|
|
625,695 |
|
|
|
|
625,695 |
|
|
625,695 |
|
Disputed Claims Reserve |
|
10 |
|
|
|
32,292 |
|
|
4,261 |
|
|
|
|
32,292 |
|
|
4,261 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total General Unsecured Claims Reserves |
|
|
|
|
|
$ 657,987 |
|
$ |
629,956 |
|
|
|
|
$ 657,987 |
|
$ |
629,956 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Recovery to General Unsecured Claims |
|
|
|
|
|
69% |
|
|
73% |
|
|
|
|
72% |
|
|
75% |
|
* There are a number of estimates and assumptions underlying the analysis below
that are inherently subject to significant uncertainties and contingencies beyond the control of the Debtors and their professionals. Additionally, assumptions are made with respect to certain liquidation decisions which could be subject to
change. Accordingly, there can be no assurance that the values reflected in the analysis would be realized and actual results could vary materially from those shown here.
Values are as of March 27, 2015. The Debtors plan to include a Wind-down Budget as part of the Plan Supplement to be filed with the Court at a later date. You
should review both this Liquidation Analysis and the Wind-down Budget as values may differ based on the timing of each analysis.
Notes
1 Cash On Hand: Reflects cash and cash equivalents held in all bank accounts.
2 Litigation Proceeds and Other Receipts: Anticipated recovery of various
litigation matters as well as recoveries from healthcare refunds and other miscellaneous receipts. Litigation is inherently speculative and uncertain in nature and no creditor should rely upon the potential recovery from litigation actions as a
basis for recovery on account of their claims.
3 Business Unit Sales: Equity held by Valeant from the sale of
substantially all of the Debtors assets to Drone Acquisition Sub Inc., a subsidiary of Valeant Pharmaceuticals International, Inc.
4 Wind-Down Reserve: The Company anticipates that the liquidation process would take six to twelve months. Wind-down
operating costs would include compensation expenses, insurance, taxes, and the costs of orderly winding down healthcare and other employee-related plans. Under a Chapter 7 liquidation, a change in professionals would result in lost efficiencies,
which is reflected in a 25% increase in the wind-down budget. The Wind-Down Reserve is calculated based on estimates and is being provided for illustrative purposes only. Actual expenses may differ materially from the stated value.
5 Trustee Fees: Assumed to be 3% of the gross proceeds from the liquidation of the assets.
6 Professional Fee Reserve: The Professional Fee Reserve is intended to cover (a) all Professional Fee Claims of
Professionals employed by the Debtors or the Committee, including but not limited to an amount sufficient to pay (i) all unpaid Professional Fee Holdback Amounts and other expenses billed by Professionals of the Debtors or the Committee prior
to the Effective Date; (ii) all outstanding fee applications of Professionals of the Debtors or the Committee not ruled upon by the Court as of the Effective Date; and (iii) the estimated aggregate amount of all reasonable fees and
expenses due to Professionals of the Debtors or the Committee for periods that have not been billed as of the Effective Date; (b) the Supporting Noteholders Professionals Fee Estimate; (c) the Allowed Deerfield Substantial Contribution
Claim; and (d) the Allowed Committee Member Substantial Contribution Claims. The Professional Fee Reserve is based on estimates and is being provided for illustrative purposes only. Actual expenses may differ materially from the stated value.
For the Chapter 7 liquidation, the Professional Fee Reserve also contains an estimate of certain fees that would be incurred by professionals during the liquidation.
7 Post-Petition Claims: Includes estimates of post-petition expenses that will be paid prior to confirmation, consisting of,
among other expenses, vacation accruals, sales incentive payments, and other employee-related payments earned post-petition. This estimate assumes that plan confirmation will occur in June 2015.
8 Cure and Critical Vendor Costs: Includes estimates of payments that will be paid prior to confirmation or as part of the
emergence to Critical Vendors and contract counterparties for Assumed Contracts. This estimate assumes that plan confirmation and emergence will occur in June 2015.
9 Allowed General Unsecured Claims: The actual amount of Allowed General Unsecured Claims may differ materially from the
stated amount.
10 Disputed Claims Reserve: The actual amount to be allocated to the Disputed Claims Reserve may differ materially
from the stated amounts.
Exhibit 99.2
Solicitation Version
IN
THE UNITED STATES BANKRUPTCY COURT
FOR THE DISTRICT OF DELAWARE
|
|
|
|
|
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - |
|
x |
|
|
In re:
DENDREON CORPORATION, et al.,
Debtors.1 |
|
:
: :
: :
: :
: |
|
Chapter 11
Case No. 14-12515 (LSS)
Jointly Administered |
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - |
|
x |
|
|
FIRST AMENDED PLAN OF LIQUIDATION PURSUANT TO CHAPTER 11
OF THE BANKRUPTCY CODE PROPOSED BY THE DEBTORS
Nothing contained herein shall constitute an offer, an acceptance or a legally binding obligation of the Debtors or any other party in interest. This Plan is
subject to approval of the Bankruptcy Court and other customary conditions. This Plan is not an offer with respect to any securities. You should not rely on the information contained in, or the terms of, this Plan for any purpose (including in
connection with the purchase or sale of the Debtors securities) prior to the confirmation of this Plan by the Bankruptcy Court.
SKADDEN, ARPS, SLATE, MEAGHER & FLOM LLP
|
|
|
|
|
Anthony W. Clark (I.D. No. 2051) Sarah E.
Pierce (I.D. No. 4648) One Rodney Square P.O. Box
636 Wilmington, DE 19899 Telephone: (302) 651-3000
Fax: (302) 651-3001 |
|
Kenneth S. Ziman Raquelle L. Kaye
Four Times Square New York, NY 10036
Telephone: (212) 735-3000 Fax: (212) 735-2000 |
|
Felicia Gerber Perlman Candice Korkis
155 N. Wacker Dr. Chicago, IL 60606
Telephone: (312) 407-0700 Fax: (312) 407-0411 |
|
Counsel for Debtors and Debtors in Possession |
Dated: April 16, 2015
1 |
The Debtors and the last four digits of their respective taxpayer identification numbers are as follows: Dendreon Corporation (3193), Dendreon Holdings, LLC (8047), Dendreon Distribution, LLC (8598) and Dendreon
Manufacturing, LLC (7123). The address of the Debtors corporate headquarters is 601 Union Street, Suite 4900, Seattle, Washington 98101. |
TABLE OF CONTENTS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Page |
|
|
INTRODUCTION |
|
|
Article I |
|
|
DEFINITIONS AND RULES OF INTERPRETATION |
|
|
|
|
1.1 |
|
Rules of Construction |
|
|
1 |
|
1.2 |
|
Definitions |
|
|
1 |
|
1.3 |
|
Rules of Interpretation |
|
|
15 |
|
1.4 |
|
Computation of Time |
|
|
15 |
|
1.5 |
|
Governing Law |
|
|
15 |
|
|
Article II |
|
|
CLASSIFICATION OF CLAIMS AND INTERESTS |
|
|
|
|
2.1 |
|
Introduction |
|
|
16 |
|
2.2 |
|
Unclassified Claims (not entitled to vote on the Plan) |
|
|
16 |
|
2.3 |
|
Unimpaired Classes of Claims (deemed to have accepted the Plan and not entitled to vote on the Plan) |
|
|
16 |
|
2.4 |
|
Impaired Classes of Claims (entitled to vote on the Plan) |
|
|
16 |
|
2.5 |
|
Impaired Classes of Claims (not entitled to vote on the Plan) |
|
|
16 |
|
2.6 |
|
Impaired Classes of Interests (not entitled to vote on the Plan) |
|
|
17 |
|
2.7 |
|
Unimpaired Classes of Interests (not entitled to vote on the Plan) |
|
|
17 |
|
|
Article III |
|
|
TREATMENT OF CLAIMS AND INTERESTS |
|
|
|
|
3.1 |
|
Unclassified Claims |
|
|
17 |
|
3.2 |
|
Unimpaired Claims |
|
|
17 |
|
3.3 |
|
Impaired Claims Entitled to Vote on the Plan |
|
|
18 |
|
3.4 |
|
Impaired Claims Not Entitled to Vote on the Plan |
|
|
19 |
|
3.5 |
|
Impaired Interests |
|
|
19 |
|
3.6 |
|
Unimpaired Interests |
|
|
19 |
|
3.7 |
|
Special Provision Regarding Unimpaired Claims |
|
|
19 |
|
3.8 |
|
Allowed Claims |
|
|
20 |
|
3.9 |
|
Special Provisions Regarding Insured Claims |
|
|
20 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Article IV |
|
|
ACCEPTANCE OR REJECTION OF THE PLAN |
|
|
|
|
4.1 |
|
Acceptance by an Impaired Class |
|
|
21 |
|
4.2 |
|
Presumed Acceptances by Unimpaired Classes |
|
|
21 |
|
4.3 |
|
Classes Deemed to Reject Plan |
|
|
21 |
|
4.4 |
|
Impaired Classes of Claims Entitled to Vote |
|
|
21 |
|
4.5 |
|
Elimination of Vacant Classes |
|
|
21 |
|
4.6 |
|
Voting Classes; Deemed Acceptance by Non-Voting Classes |
|
|
21 |
|
4.7 |
|
Confirmation Pursuant to Section 1129(b) of the Bankruptcy Code |
|
|
22 |
|
|
Article V |
|
|
MEANS FOR IMPLEMENTATION OF THE PLAN |
|
|
|
|
5.1 |
|
Substantive Consolidation |
|
|
22 |
|
5.2 |
|
Corporate Action |
|
|
23 |
|
5.3 |
|
Compliance with the Asset Purchase Agreement |
|
|
26 |
|
5.4 |
|
Privilege Matters |
|
|
26 |
|
5.5 |
|
Dissolution of the Committee |
|
|
27 |
|
5.6 |
|
The Plan Administrator |
|
|
27 |
|
5.7 |
|
Distributions to Holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims and General Unsecured Claims |
|
|
29 |
|
5.8 |
|
Limited Release of Liens |
|
|
30 |
|
5.9 |
|
Accounts and Reserves |
|
|
30 |
|
5.10 |
|
Exemption from Certain Transfer Taxes |
|
|
32 |
|
5.11 |
|
Exemption from Securities Laws |
|
|
32 |
|
5.12 |
|
Preservation of Causes of Action |
|
|
33 |
|
5.13 |
|
Effectuating Documents; Further Transactions |
|
|
34 |
|
5.14 |
|
2016 Notes Trustee Fee Claims |
|
|
34 |
|
5.15 |
|
Oversight Committee |
|
|
34 |
|
|
Article VI |
|
|
PROVISIONS GOVERNING DISTRIBUTIONS |
|
|
|
|
6.1 |
|
Distributions for Claims Allowed as of the Effective Date |
|
|
35 |
|
6.2 |
|
Disbursing Agent |
|
|
35 |
|
6.3 |
|
Delivery of Distributions and Undeliverable or Unclaimed Distributions |
|
|
35 |
|
6.4 |
|
Prepayment |
|
|
37 |
|
6.5 |
|
Means of Cash Payment |
|
|
37 |
|
6.6 |
|
Interest on Claims |
|
|
37 |
|
6.7 |
|
Withholding and Reporting Requirements |
|
|
37 |
|
6.8 |
|
Setoffs |
|
|
37 |
|
6.9 |
|
Procedure for Treating and Resolving Disputed, Contingent and/or Unliquidated Claims |
|
|
38 |
|
ii
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Article VII |
|
|
TREATMENT OF EXECUTORY CONTRACTS AND UNEXPIRED LEASES |
|
|
|
|
7.1 |
|
Rejected Contracts and Leases |
|
|
40 |
|
7.2 |
|
Rejection Damages Bar Date |
|
|
41 |
|
7.3 |
|
Assumed Contracts and Leases |
|
|
41 |
|
7.4 |
|
Indemnification Obligations |
|
|
41 |
|
|
Article VIII |
|
|
CONDITIONS PRECEDENT TO CONFIRMATION |
|
AND CONSUMMATION OF THE PLAN |
|
|
|
|
8.1 |
|
Conditions to Confirmation |
|
|
42 |
|
8.2 |
|
Conditions to Effective Date |
|
|
43 |
|
8.3 |
|
Waiver of Conditions |
|
|
43 |
|
8.4 |
|
Consequences of Non-Occurrence of Effective Date |
|
|
43 |
|
|
Article IX |
|
|
ALLOWANCE AND PAYMENT OF CERTAIN ADMINISTRATIVE CLAIMS |
|
|
|
|
9.1 |
|
Professional Fee Claims |
|
|
44 |
|
9.2 |
|
Substantial Contribution Compensation and Expenses Bar Date |
|
|
44 |
|
9.3 |
|
Other Administrative Claims |
|
|
44 |
|
|
Article X |
|
|
EFFECTS OF CONFIRMATION |
|
|
|
|
10.1 |
|
Satisfaction of Claims |
|
|
45 |
|
10.2 |
|
Binding Effect |
|
|
45 |
|
10.3 |
|
Effects of Confirmation |
|
|
45 |
|
10.4 |
|
Releases |
|
|
45 |
|
10.5 |
|
Exculpation and Limitation of Liability |
|
|
47 |
|
10.6 |
|
Injunction |
|
|
47 |
|
10.7 |
|
Satisfaction of Subordination Rights |
|
|
47 |
|
|
Article XI |
|
|
RETENTION OF JURISDICTION |
|
|
|
|
11.1 |
|
Retention of Jurisdiction by the Court |
|
|
48 |
|
11.2 |
|
Retention of Non-Exclusive Jurisdiction by the Court |
|
|
50 |
|
11.3 |
|
Failure of Court to Exercise Jurisdiction |
|
|
50 |
|
iii
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Article XII |
|
|
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS |
|
|
|
|
12.1 |
|
Modifications and Amendments |
|
|
50 |
|
12.2 |
|
Severability of Plan Provisions |
|
|
50 |
|
12.3 |
|
Successors and Assigns |
|
|
51 |
|
12.4 |
|
Payment of Statutory Fees |
|
|
51 |
|
12.5 |
|
Revocation, Withdrawal or Non-Consummation |
|
|
51 |
|
12.6 |
|
Insurance Policies |
|
|
51 |
|
12.7 |
|
Service of Documents |
|
|
51 |
|
12.8 |
|
Plan Supplement(s) |
|
|
53 |
|
TABLE OF EXHIBITS
|
|
|
Exhibit |
|
Title |
A |
|
Plan Administrator Agreement |
B |
|
Contracts To Be Assumed Under Plan |
C |
|
Non-Exclusive List of Retained Claims and Causes of Action |
Note: To the extent that the foregoing Exhibits are not attached to this Plan, such Exhibits will be filed with the
Court in Plan Supplement(s) filed on or before the date(s) set for the filing of such documents and forms of documents.
iv
INTRODUCTION2
The debtors and debtors-in-possession in the above-captioned Chapter 11 Cases propose the following plan of liquidation. The Plan contemplates
the liquidation of the Debtors and the resolution of outstanding Claims against and Interests in the Debtors pursuant to section 1121(a) of the Bankruptcy Code. The Debtors are the proponents of the Plan within the meaning of section 1129 of the
Bankruptcy Code.
For a discussion of the Debtors history, businesses, properties, operations, the Chapter 11 Cases, risk factors, a
summary of this Plan and certain other related matters, reference is hereby made to the Disclosure Statement that is being distributed herewith. In the event of any inconsistencies between the Plan and the Disclosure Statement, the terms and
provisions of the Plan shall control.
All Holders of Claims that are eligible to vote on the Plan are encouraged to read the Plan and the
Disclosure Statement in their entirety before voting to accept or reject the Plan. Subject to certain restrictions and requirements set forth in section 1127 of the Bankruptcy Code, Bankruptcy Rule 3019 and Section 12.1 of this Plan, the
Debtors reserve the right to alter, amend, modify (one or more times), revoke or withdraw the Plan prior to its substantial consummation.
ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS
AND RULES OF INTERPRETATION
|
1.1 |
Rules of Construction |
For purposes of this Plan, except as expressly provided herein
or unless the context otherwise requires, all capitalized terms not otherwise defined shall have the meanings ascribed to them in Article I of this Plan. Any term used in this Plan that is not defined herein, but is defined in the Bankruptcy
Code or the Bankruptcy Rules, shall have the meaning ascribed to that term in the Bankruptcy Code or the Bankruptcy Rules, as applicable. Whenever the context requires, such terms shall include the plural as well as the singular number, the
masculine gender shall include the feminine, and the feminine gender shall include the masculine.
2016 Noteholder Claim means, individually, a Claim of a
holder of the 2016 Notes arising under or as a result of such notes and, collectively, the Claims of all such holders arising under or as a result of such notes, which Claims shall be deemed Allowed in the aggregate amount of $625,694,097.22 (which
amount includes any accrued and unpaid interest as of the Petition Date) as of the Effective Date.
2 |
Capitalized terms used in this Introduction shall have the meanings ascribed to such terms in Article I hereof. |
2016 Notes means the 2.875% Convertible Senior Notes due 2016, issued pursuant
to that certain First Supplemental Indenture, dated January 20, 2011, to the base Indenture, dated March 16, 2007, by and between Dendreon Corporation, as issuer, and Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., as indenture trustee.
2016 Notes Indenture that certain First Supplemental Indenture, dated January 20, 2011, to the base Indenture, dated
March 16, 2007, by and between Dendreon Corporation, as issuer, and Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., as indenture trustee, pursuant to which the 2016 Notes were issued.
2016 Notes Trustee means Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A. in its capacity as indenture trustee for the 2016
Notes under the 2016 Notes Indenture.
2016 Notes Trustee Fee Claims means the Claims for reasonable, actual fees and
expenses, including reasonable, actual attorneys fees and expenses, incurred by the 2016 Notes Trustee through the Effective Date and payable under the 2016 Notes Indenture.
Administrative Claim means a Claim for payment of an administrative expense of a kind specified in sections 503(b) or
1114(e)(2) of the Bankruptcy Code and entitled to priority in payment under sections 507(a)(2) or 507(b) of the Bankruptcy Code, including: (a) the actual and necessary costs and expenses incurred after the Petition Date of preserving the
Estates and operating the businesses of the Debtors (such as wages, salaries or commissions for services and payments for goods and other services and leased premises) and Claims by Governmental Units for Taxes accruing after the Petition Date;
(b) Professional Fee Claims; (c) all fees and charges assessed against the Estates under 28 U.S.C. § 1930; (d) obligations designated as Administrative Claims pursuant to an order of the Court; and (e) Claims under section
503(b)(9) of the Bankruptcy Code.
Administrative Claims Bar Date means for Administrative Claims arising on the
Petition Date and through the Effective Date, other than Professional Fee Claims, claims arising under section 503(b)(9) of the Bankruptcy Code and Claims by Governmental Units for Taxes accruing after the Petition Date, the date that falls on the
first Business Day that is at least thirty (30) days after the Effective Date, in each case by which Holders of such Administrative Claims shall File with the Claims Agent and serve on the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable,
requests for payment, in writing, together with supporting documents, substantially complying with the Bar Date Order, the Bankruptcy Code, the Bankruptcy Rules and the Local Rules.
Administrative and Priority Claims Estimate means, as of the Effective Date, the estimated amount, exclusive of
Professional Fee Claims, of all unpaid Claims that will be Allowed Administrative Claims, Allowed Priority Tax Claims and Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claims.
Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve means the reserve of Cash initially funded by the Debtors and maintained by the
Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors (or the Liquidating Trust, if established), for the benefit of Holders of Allowed Administrative Claims (exclusive of Holders of Professional Fee Claims, the reserve for which Holders shall be
2
the Professional Fee Reserve), Allowed Priority Tax Claims and Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claims in an amount equal to the Administrative and Priority Claims Estimate.
Affiliate means affiliate as defined in section 101(2) of the Bankruptcy Code.
Affiliate Debtors means Dendreon Holdings, LLC, Dendreon Distribution, LLC and Dendreon Manufacturing, LLC, the debtors and
debtors-in-possession in Chapter 11 Cases No. 14-12516 (LSS), No. 14-12517 (LSS) and No. 14-12518 (LSS), respectively, which cases are pending in the Court.
Allowed means, when used in reference to a Claim within a particular Class, an Allowed Claim in the specified Class or of a
specified type.
Allowed Claim means a Claim or any portion thereof (a) that has been allowed by a Final Order of
the Court, (b) that either (x) has been Scheduled as a liquidated, non-contingent and undisputed Claim in an amount greater than zero in the Schedules, or (y) is the subject of a timely filed Proof of Claim and, as to both
(x) and (y), either (i) no objection to its allowance has been filed on or before the Claims Objection Deadline (as may be extended) or the expiration of such other applicable period fixed by the Court or (ii) any objection to its
allowance has been settled, waived through payment or withdrawn, or has been denied by a Final Order, or (c) that is expressly allowed in a liquidated amount (x) in the Plan or (y) after the Effective Date, by the Plan Administrator
in writing; provided, however, that with respect to an Administrative Claim, Allowed Claim means an Administrative Claim as to which a timely written request for payment has been made in accordance with applicable bar dates
for such requests set by the Court (if such written request is required) in each case as to which (a) the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, or any other party in interest (x) has not filed an objection on or before the
Claims Objection Deadline (as may be extended) or the expiration of such other applicable period fixed by the Court or (y) has interposed a timely objection and such objection has been settled, waived through payment or withdrawn, or has been
denied by Final Order, or (b) after the Effective Date, the Plan Administrator has expressly allowed in a liquidated amount in writing with the consent of the Oversight Committee (to the extent required under the Plan). For purposes of
computing Distributions under this Plan, a Claim that has been deemed Allowed shall not include interest, fees, costs or charges on such Claim from and after the Petition Date, except as provided in section 506(b) of the Bankruptcy Code,
applicable law, or as otherwise expressly set forth in this Plan.
Asset Purchase Agreement means that certain Second
Amended and Restated Acquisition Agreement by and between the Debtors, the Purchaser and Valeant Pharmaceuticals International, Inc., dated as of February 19, 2015, as may be amended from time to time.
Available Cash means all of the Cash held by the Debtors Estates on the Effective Date plus all Cash realized by the
Liquidating Debtors after the Effective Date, including any recovery from Causes of Action, less the amounts used to fund the Professional Fee Reserve, the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve, the Disputed Claims Reserve and the Wind-down
Reserve.
3
Avoidance Actions means any and all claims and Causes of Action of the Debtors
arising under chapter 5 of the Bankruptcy Code, including, without limitation, sections 544, 545, 547, 548, 549 and 550 thereof or their state law analogs.
Ballot means each of the ballot or master ballot forms distributed with the Disclosure Statement to Holders of Impaired
Claims entitled to vote under Section 4.4 hereof in connection with the solicitation of acceptances of the Plan.
Bankruptcy Code means title 11 of the United States Code, 11 U.S.C. §§ 101 et seq., as such title has been, or
may be, amended from time to time, to the extent that any such amendment is applicable to these Chapter 11 Cases.
Bankruptcy
Rules means the Federal Rules of Bankruptcy Procedure, the Official Bankruptcy Forms and the Local Rules, as each has been, or may be, amended from time to time, to the extent that any such amendment is applicable to these Chapter 11
Cases.
Bar Date means, with respect to any particular Claim, the specific date set by the Court as the last day for
Filing Proofs of Claim against the Debtors or requests in these Chapter 11 Cases for that specific Claim.
Bar Date
Order means the Order Pursuant to Sections 105, 501, 502, 503 and 1111(a) of the Bankruptcy Code, Bankruptcy Rules 2002 and 3003(c)(3), and Local Rules 1009-2 and 2002-1(e) (I) Establishing Bar Dates for Filing Claims Against the
Debtors and (II) Approving Form and Manner of Notice Thereof [Docket No. 352].
Books and Records means any and
all books and records of the Debtors, including computer generated or computer maintained books and records and computer data, as well as electronically generated or maintained books and records or data, along with books and records of any Debtor
maintained by or in the possession of third parties, wherever located.
Business Day means any day, other than a
Saturday, Sunday or a legal holiday (as that term is defined in Bankruptcy Rule 9006(a)).
Cash means legal tender of
the United States of America or equivalents thereof.
Causes of Action means any and all claims, actions, proceedings,
causes of action, Avoidance Actions (excluding Avoidance Actions pursuant to section 547 of the Bankruptcy Code against non-Insiders of the Debtors), suits, accounts, controversies, agreements, promises, rights to legal remedies, rights to equitable
remedies, rights to payment and claims, whether known or unknown, reduced to judgment or not reduced to judgment, liquidated or unliquidated, contingent or non-contingent, matured or unmatured, disputed or undisputed, secured or unsecured,
assertable directly or derivatively, in law, equity or otherwise, based in whole or in part upon any act or omission or other event occurring prior to the Petition Date or during the course of the Bankruptcy Cases, through and including the
Effective Date, that any Debtor and/or Estate may hold against any Person.
Chapter 11 Cases means the chapter 11 cases
commenced by the Debtors and jointly administered under case number 14-12515 (LSS) in the Court.
4
Claim means a claim against any Debtor, whether or not asserted, as such term
is defined in section 101(5) of the Bankruptcy Code.
Claimholder means the holder of a Claim.
Claims Agent means Prime Clerk LLC, or any successor thereto.
Claims Objection Deadline means the last day for filing objections to Claims (other than Disallowed Claims for which no
objection is required), which day shall be one hundred and twenty (120) days after the Effective Date, or such later date as may be ordered by the Court.
Class means each category or group of Holders of Claims or Interests that has been designated as a class in Article
III of this Plan.
Collateral means any property or interest in property of a Debtors Estate subject to a
Lien to secure the payment or performance of a Claim, which Lien is not subject to avoidance under the Bankruptcy Code or otherwise invalid under the Bankruptcy Code or applicable state law.
Committee means the Official Committee of Unsecured Creditors appointed in the Chapter 11 Cases.
Committee Member Substantial Contribution Claim means, individually, any Substantial Contribution Claim by a member or
members of the Committee for services provided by counsel to such member or members (for which redacted invoices shall be provided to the Debtors and the Supporting Noteholders), and, collectively, all such Claims, which shall be deemed Allowed as
of the Effective Date in the amount of such Claims, the aggregate amount of which shall not exceed $100,000.
Confirmation means the entry of the Confirmation Order, subject to all conditions specified in Section 8.1
having been satisfied or waived pursuant to Section 8.3.
Confirmation Date means the date of entry of the
Confirmation Order on the docket of the Chapter 11 Cases within the meaning of Bankruptcy Rules 5003 and 9021.
Confirmation
Hearing means the hearing(s) before the Court to consider confirmation of the Plan and related matters pursuant to section 1128 of the Bankruptcy Code, as such hearing(s) may be adjourned or continued from time to time.
Confirmation Order means the order entered by the Court confirming the Plan pursuant to section 1129 of the Bankruptcy
Code.
Consummation means the occurrence of the Effective Date.
Contingent means, with reference to a Claim, a Claim that has not accrued or is not otherwise payable and the accrual of
which, or the obligation to make payment on which, is dependent upon a future event that may or may not occur.
5
Court means the United States Bankruptcy Court for the District of Delaware or
such other court as may have jurisdiction over the Chapter 11 Cases.
Cure means the distribution within a reasonable
period of time following the Effective Date of Cash, or such other property as may be agreed upon by the parties or ordered by the Court, with respect to the assumption or assumption and assignment of an executory contract or unexpired lease,
pursuant to section 365(b) of the Bankruptcy Code, in an amount equal to all unpaid monetary obligations, without interest, or such other amount as may be agreed upon by the parties under such executory contract or unexpired lease, to the extent
such obligations are enforceable under the Bankruptcy Code and applicable bankruptcy law.
Debtors means, together,
Dendreon Corporation, Dendreon Holdings, LLC, Dendreon Distribution, LLC and Dendreon Manufacturing, LLC.
Deerfield
Noteholders means Deerfield Management Company, L.P. and certain funds managed by it that are holders of 2016 Notes.
Deerfield Noteholders PSA means that certain Amended and Restated Plan Support Agreement dated December 17, 2014, as
amended from time to time, by and among the Debtors and each holder of the 2016 Notes that is a signatory thereto.
Deerfield
Requisite Supporting Noteholders has the meaning ascribed to Requisite Supporting Noteholders in the Deerfield Noteholders PSA.
Deerfield Substantial Contribution Claim means the Substantial Contribution Claim of the Deerfield Noteholders for the
services performed by Katten Muchin Rosenman LLP (for which redacted invoices shall be provided to the Debtors, the Unaffiliated Noteholders and the Committee), which shall be deemed Allowed in the amount of $152,953.00 as of the Effective Date.
Dendreon means Dendreon Corporation.
Disallowed means (with reference to a Claim) any Claim, or any portion thereof, that (a) has been disallowed by a
Final Order, (b) is Scheduled at zero or as contingent, disputed or unliquidated and as to which no Proof of Claim has been filed by the Bar Date or deemed timely filed with the Court pursuant to either the Bankruptcy Code or any Final Order or
under applicable law, (c) is not Scheduled, and as to which (i) no Proof of Claim has been filed by the Bar Date or deemed timely filed with the Court pursuant to either the Bankruptcy Code or any Final Order or under applicable law, and
(ii) no request for payment of an Administrative Claim has been filed by the Bar Date or deemed timely filed with the Court pursuant to either the Bankruptcy Code or any Final Order or under applicable law, or (d) after the Effective Date,
has been disallowed in a written agreement by and between the Plan Administrator and the Holder of such Claim.
Disbursing
Agent means (a) prior to the Effective Date, the Debtors, and (b) on and after the Effective Date, the Plan Administrator; provided, however, that the Debtors or the Plan Administrator may, in their discretion,
retain a third party to act as Disbursing Agent.
6
Disclosure Statement means the written disclosure statement (including all
exhibits and schedules thereto) that relates to the Plan, as the same may be amended, supplemented, revised or modified from time to time, as approved by the Court pursuant to the Disclosure Statement Approval Order.
Disclosure Statement Approval Order means the Final Order approving, among other things, the adequacy of the Disclosure
Statement pursuant to section 1125 of the Bankruptcy Code.
Disputed means, when used in reference to a Claim, a Claim,
or any portion thereof, that is neither an Allowed Claim nor a Disallowed Claim.
Disputed Claim Amount means
(a) if a liquidated amount is set forth in the Proof of Claim relating to a Disputed Claim, (i) the liquidated amount set forth in the Proof of Claim relating to a Disputed Claim; (ii) an amount agreed to by the Debtors or the Plan
Administrator, as applicable, and the Holder of such Disputed Claim; or (iii) if a request for estimation is filed by any party, the amount at which such Claim is estimated by the Court; (b) if no liquidated amount is set forth in the
Proof of Claim relating to a Disputed Claim, (i) an amount agreed to by the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, and the Holder of such Disputed Claim; (ii) the amount estimated by the Court with respect to such Disputed
Claim; or (c) if the Claim is a Disallowed Claim, zero.
Disputed Claims Estimate means, as of any date of
determination, the aggregate amount that would be distributed to all holders of Disputed General Unsecured Claims if each such claim became an Allowed General Unsecured Claim in the Face Amount of such Claim on such date.
Disputed Claims Reserve means the reserve of Cash in the amount of the Disputed Claims Estimate initially funded by the
Debtors and maintained by the Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors (or the Liquidating Trust, if established), for the payment of Disputed General Unsecured Claims that become Allowed Claims after the Effective Date.
Distribution means the distributions to be made by the Disbursing Agent in accordance with the Plan of, as the case may be:
(a) Cash or (b) any other consideration or residual value distributed to Holders of Allowed Claims under the terms and provisions of the Plan.
Distribution Date means the Effective Date, or the date occurring as soon as practicable after the Effective Date, on which
the initial Distributions are made to Holders of Allowed Claims.
Distribution Record Date means the record date for
the purpose of determining Holders of Allowed Claims entitled to receive Distributions under the Plan on account of Allowed Claims, which date shall be the Confirmation Date or such other date designated in the Confirmation Order or any subsequent
Court order; provided, however, that such Distribution Record Date shall not apply to public securities.
7
Effective Date means the first Business Day on which all conditions to the
consummation of the Plan set forth in Section 8.2 hereof have been satisfied or waived in accordance with Section 8.3.
Entity has the meaning ascribed to such term in section 101(15) of the Bankruptcy Code.
Estate(s) means, individually, the estate of any Debtor in these Chapter 11 Cases and, together, the estates of the Debtors
created under section 541 of the Bankruptcy Code upon the commencement of the Chapter 11 Cases on the Petition Date.
Executory
Contract means a contract to which the Debtor is a party that is subject to assumption or rejection under 365 of the Bankruptcy Code.
Exhibit means an exhibit either attached to this Plan or attached as an appendix to the Disclosure Statement.
Face Amount means (i) when used in reference to a Disputed or Disallowed Claim, the Disputed Claim Amount, and
(ii) when used in reference to an Allowed Claim, the Allowed amount of such Claim.
File, Filed
or Filing means, respectively, file, filed or filing with the Court or its authorized designee in these Chapter 11 Cases.
Final Fee Applications has the meaning ascribed to such term in Section 9.1(a).
Final Order means an order of the Court (x) as to which the time to appeal, petition for certiorari, or move for
reargument, rehearing or new trial has expired and as to which no appeal, petition for certiorari, or other proceedings for reargument, rehearing or new trial shall then be pending; (y) as to which any right to appeal, petition for certiorari,
reargue, rehear or retry shall have been waived in writing; or (z) in the event that an appeal, writ of certiorari, reargument, rehearing or new trial has been sought, as to which (i) such order of the Court shall have been affirmed by the
highest court to which such order is appealed, (ii) certiorari has been denied as to such order, or (iii) reargument or rehearing or new trial from such order shall have been denied, and the time to take any further appeal, petition for
certiorari or move for reargument, rehearing or new trial shall have expired without such actions having been taken; provided, however, that the fact that a petition for reargument or rehearing could be filed, after the applicable
deadline for commencing an appeal, shall not prevent an order from being a Final Order if no such petition has been filed.
General Unsecured Claim means a Claim against any or all of the Debtors that is not an Administrative Claim, Priority Tax
Claim, Secured Claim, Priority Non-Tax Claim, Intercompany Claim, Subordinated Claim or 2016 Noteholder Claim.
Governmental
Unit has the meaning ascribed to such term in section 101(27) of the Bankruptcy Code.
Holder means a holder
of a Claim or Interest, as applicable.
8
Impaired means, when used in reference to a Claim or Interest, a Claim or
Interest that is impaired within the meaning of section 1124 of the Bankruptcy Code.
Impaired Class means a Class of
Claims or Interests that is Impaired.
Indemnified Parties has the meaning ascribed to such term in
Section 5.6(e).
Insider has the meaning ascribed to such term in section 101(31) of the Bankruptcy Code.
Insured Claim means any Claim, other than a Subordinated Claim, or portion of a Claim that is insured under the
Debtors insurance policies, but only to the extent of such coverage.
Intercompany Claims means any Claim, if
any, held by a Debtor against another Debtor, including, without limitation: (i) any account reflecting intercompany book entries by a Debtor with respect to another Debtor, (ii) any Claim not reflected in such book entries that is held by
a Debtor against another Debtor, and (iii) any derivative Claim asserted by or on behalf of one Debtor against another Debtor.
Intercompany Interest means an Interest in a Debtor held by another Debtor.
Interest means the legal interests, equitable interests, contractual interests, equity interests or ownership interests, or
other rights of any Person in the Debtors, including all capital stock, stock certificates, common stock, preferred stock, partnership interests, limited liability company or membership interests, rights, treasury stock, options, warrants,
contingent warrants, convertible or exchangeable securities, investment securities, subscriptions or other agreements and contractual rights to acquire or obtain such an interest or share in the Debtors, partnership interests in the Debtors
stock appreciation rights, conversion rights, repurchase rights, redemption rights, dividend rights, preemptive rights, subscription rights and liquidation preferences, puts, calls, awards or commitments of any character whatsoever relating to any
such equity, common stock, preferred stock, ownership interests or other shares of capital stock of the Debtors or obligating the Debtors to issue, transfer or sell any shares of capital stock whether or not certificated, transferable, voting or
denominated stock or a similar security.
Lien has the meaning ascribed to such term in section 101(37) of the
Bankruptcy Code.
Liquidating Debtors means the Debtors, or any successor thereto, by merger, consolidation or
otherwise, on or after the Effective Date.
Liquidating Trust has the meaning ascribed to such term in
Section 5.2(a).
Local Rules means the Local Rules of Bankruptcy Practice and Procedure of the United
States Bankruptcy Court for the District of Delaware.
Objection(s) means any objection, application, motion, complaint
or any other legal proceeding seeking, in whole or in part, to disallow, determine, liquidate, classify, reclassify or
9
establish the priority, expunge, subordinate or estimate any Claim (including the resolution of any request for payment of any Administrative Claim).
Official Bankruptcy Forms means the Official Bankruptcy Forms, prescribed by the Judicial Conference of the United States,
the observance and use of which is required pursuant to Bankruptcy Rule 9009, as such forms may be amended, revised or supplemented from time to time.
Outside Date has the meaning ascribed to such term in Section 5.2(a).
Ordinary Course Professionals means those professionals authorized to be paid by the Debtors pursuant to the Order Pursuant
to 11 U.S.C. §§ 105(a), 327, 330 and 331 Authorizing Debtors to Employ and Pay Professionals Utilized in the Ordinary Course of Business [Docket No. 159].
Oversight Committee has the meaning ascribed to such term in Section 5.15.
Periodic Distribution Date means each date selected by the Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors, for
making a Distribution to Holders of Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims and Allowed General Unsecured Claims in accordance with the Plan Administrator Agreement, which dates shall be no less frequent than quarterly unless the aggregate amount of any such
Distributions to be made on any such date, except the last distribution date, is $100,000.00 or less.
Person has the
meaning ascribed to such term in section 101(41) of the Bankruptcy Code.
Petition Date means November 10, 2014,
the date on which the Debtors filed their petitions for relief commencing the Chapter 11 Cases.
Plan means this
chapter 11 plan of liquidation proposed by the Debtors including all exhibits and schedules attached hereto or otherwise incorporated herein, as such Plan may be altered, amended, modified or supplemented from time to time, including in accordance
with its terms and the Bankruptcy Code and the Bankruptcy Rules.
Plan Administrator means the Person or Entity
designated by the Debtors, subject to the consent of the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders, the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders and the Committee, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld, prior to the Confirmation
Date and approved by the Court pursuant to the Confirmation Order to administer the Plan in accordance with the terms of the Plan and the Plan Administrator Agreement and to take such other actions as may be authorized under the Plan Administrator
Agreement, and any successor thereto.
Plan Administrator Agreement means the agreement between and among the Debtors
and the Plan Administrator, specifying the rights, duties and responsibilities of and to be performed by the Plan Administrator under the Plan, in substantially the form set forth in Exhibit A.
10
Plan Administrator Professionals means the agents, financial advisors,
attorneys, consultants, independent contractors, representatives and other professionals of the Plan Administrator and the Liquidating Debtors (in their capacities as such).
Plan Supplement means the compilation(s) of documents and forms of documents, including any exhibits to the Plan not
included herewith, that the Debtors shall file with the Court on or before the Plan Supplement Filing Date.
Plan Supplement
Filing Date means the date on which the Plan Supplement shall be filed with the Court, which date shall be at least five (5) days prior to the Voting Deadline or such other date as may be approved by the Court without further notice
to parties in interest.
Plan Termination Date has the meaning ascribed to such term in Section 5.7(c).
Priority Non-Tax Claim means any Claim accorded priority in right of payment under section 507(a) of the Bankruptcy
Code, other than a Priority Tax Claim or an Administrative Claim.
Priority Tax Claim means any Claim accorded priority
in right of payment under section 507(a)(8) of the Bankruptcy Code.
Professional means, other than Ordinary Course
Professionals, (i) any professional employed by the Debtors or the Committee in the Chapter 11 Cases pursuant to sections 327, 328, 363 or 1103 of the Bankruptcy Code and (ii) any professionals seeking compensation or reimbursement of
expenses in connection with the Chapter 11 Cases pursuant to section 503(b)(4) of the Bankruptcy Code, other than those whose claims are specifically allowed pursuant to the Plan.
Professional Fee Claim means a Claim of a Professional pursuant to sections 327, 328, 330, 331 or 503(b) for compensation
or reimbursement of costs and expenses relating to services performed after the Petition Date and prior to and including the Effective Date.
Professional Fee Estimate means, collectively, (i) with respect to any Professional employed by the Debtors or the
Committee, a good-faith estimate of such Professionals anticipated accrued unpaid Professional Fee Claims as of the Effective Date, (ii) the Supporting Noteholders Professional Fee Estimate, (iii) the Allowed Deerfield Substantial
Contribution Claim, (iv) the Allowed Committee Member Substantial Contribution Claims, and (v) the 2016 Notes Trustee Fee Claims.
Professional Fee Holdback Amount means the amount equal to 20% of fees billed to the Debtors for a given month that were
retained by the Debtors as a holdback on payment of Professional Fee Claims pursuant to the Professional Fee Order.
Professional
Fee Order means the Order Pursuant to 11 U.S.C. §§ 105(a) and 331 Establishing Interim Compensation Procedures [Docket No. 153].
Professional Fee Reserve means the reserve of Cash in the amount of the Professional Fee Estimate initially funded by the
Debtors and maintained by the Plan Administrator, on behalf
11
of the Liquidating Debtors (or the Liquidating Trust, if established), in an amount sufficient to fund (a) all Professional Fee Claims of Professionals employed by the Debtors or the
Committee, including but not limited to an amount sufficient to pay (i) all unpaid Professional Fee Holdback Amounts and other expenses billed by Professionals of the Debtors or the Committee prior to the Effective Date; (ii) all
outstanding fee applications of Professionals of the Debtors or the Committee not ruled upon by the Court as of the Effective Date; and (iii) the estimated aggregate amount of all reasonable fees and expenses due to Professionals of the Debtors
or the Committee for periods that have not been billed as of the Effective Date; (b) the Supporting Noteholders Professionals Fee Estimate; (c) the Allowed Deerfield Substantial Contribution Claim; (d) the Allowed Committee Member
Substantial Contribution Claims; and (e) the 2016 Notes Trustee Fee Claims.
Proof of Claim means the proof of claim
that must be filed before the applicable Bar Date, which term shall include a request for payment of an administrative expense claim.
Pro Rata means, at any time, the proportion that the Face Amount of a Claim in a particular Class bears to the aggregate
Face Amount of all Claims (including Disputed Claims, but excluding Disallowed Claims) in such Class, unless the Plan provides otherwise.
PSA Order means the Order (A) Authorizing the Debtors to Assume Plan Support Agreements and (B) Granting Related
Relief [Docket No. 215].
Purchaser means Drone Acquisition Sub Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of Valeant
Pharmaceuticals International, Inc., the Entity that acquired substantially all of the Debtors assets pursuant to the Asset Purchase Agreement and the Sale Order.
Released Party means each of the following (a) the Deerfield Noteholders, (b) the Unaffiliated Noteholders,
(c) the 2016 Notes Trustee, and (d) with respect to each of the foregoing persons in clauses (a) through (c), such Persons current and former subsidiaries, Affiliates, members, directors, officers, principals, agents, financial
advisors, restructuring advisors, accountants, investment bankers, consultants, attorneys, employees, partners, equity holders, representatives, and other professionals, in each case, only in their capacity as such.
Sale means the sale of substantially all of the Debtors assets to the Purchaser pursuant to the Asset Purchase
Agreement and the Sale Order.
Sale Order means the Order Pursuant to Bankruptcy Code Sections 105(a), 363, 365, 503
and Bankruptcy Rules 2002, 6004, 6006 (I) Approving the Sale of The Debtors Assets Free and Clear of All Liens, Claims, Encumbrances and Interests; (II) Authorizing the Assumption and Assignment of Certain Executory Contracts and
Unexpired Leases; and (III) Granting Certain Related Relief [Docket No. 410], entered on February 20, 2015.
Scheduled means, with respect to any Claim, the status and amount, if any, of that Claim as set forth in the Schedules.
Schedules mean the schedules of assets and liabilities, schedules of executory contracts and statements of financial
affairs Filed by each Debtor pursuant to section 521 of the Bankruptcy Code, Bankruptcy Rule 1007 and the Official Bankruptcy Forms of the Bankruptcy
12
Rules, as such schedules and statements have been or may be supplemented or amended from time to time in accordance with Bankruptcy Rule 1009 or any orders of the Court.
Secured Claim means a Claim (a) that is secured by a Lien on property in which an Estate has an interest, which Lien
is valid, perfected and enforceable under applicable law or by reason of a Final Order, or (b) that is subject to setoff under section 553 of the Bankruptcy Code and such right of setoff has been asserted by the holder of such right prior to
the Confirmation Date in a properly filed motion for relief from the automatic stay, to the extent of the value of the Claimholders interest in the Estates interest in such property or to the extent of the amount subject to setoff, as
applicable, as determined pursuant to section 506(a) of the Bankruptcy Code.
Solicitation Procedures Order means the
Order (A) Approving the Form and Manner of Notice of the Disclosure Statement Hearing; (B) Approving Disclosure Statement; (C) Authorizing the Offer and Sale of Valeant Shares Exempt from Registration Under Securities Laws Pursuant to
Bankruptcy Code Section 1145 and Pursuant to Bankruptcy Code Section 1125(e) Safe Harbor; (D) Scheduling Hearing on Confirmation of Plan; (E) Establishing Deadlines and Procedures for Filing Objections to Confirmation of Plan;
(F) Establishing Deadline and Procedures for Voting on the Plan; (G) Approving Solicitation Procedures; (H) Establishing Procedures for Tabulation of Votes; and (I) Granting Related Relief [Docket No. 596].
Subordinated Claim means any Claim subordinated pursuant to sections 510(b) or 510(c) of the Bankruptcy Code.
Substantial Contribution Claim means a Claim under subsections 503(b)(3), (b)(4) or (b)(5) of the Bankruptcy Code for
compensation or reimbursement of expenses incurred in making a substantial contribution in the Chapter 11 Cases.
Substantive
Consolidation Order means the order of the Court, which may be the Confirmation Order, authorizing substantive consolidation of the Estates pursuant to 5.1 hereof.
Supporting Noteholders means the Deerfield Noteholders and the Unaffiliated Noteholders.
Supporting Noteholders Professional means, individually, each of the following professionals employed by the Supporting
Noteholders whose fees and expenses are permitted to be paid pursuant to the PSA Order: Brown Rudnick LLP, Fox Rothschild LLP, Jefferies LLC, Willkie Farr & Gallagher LLP and Morris, Nichols, Arsht & Tunnell LLP, and, collectively,
all such professionals.
Supporting Noteholders Professional Fee Claim means a Claim of a Supporting Noteholders
Professional for compensation or reimbursement of costs and expenses relating to services performed after the Petition Date and prior to and including the Effective Date.
Supporting Noteholders Professional Fee Estimate means, individually, a good-faith estimate of each such
professionals anticipated accrued unpaid fees and expenses as of the Effective Date and, collectively, all such estimates of the Supporting Noteholders Professionals.
13
Tax or Taxes means all income, gross receipts, sales, use,
transfer, payroll, employment, franchise, profits, property, excise or other similar taxes, estimated import duties, stamp taxes and duties, value added taxes, levies, assessments or charges of any kind whatsoever (whether payable directly or by
withholding), together with any interest and any penalties, additions to tax, or additional amounts imposed by any taxing authority with respect thereto.
Total Distributable Value means the sum of the amount of Available Cash and the aggregate value of $49,500,000 of the
Valeant Shares available for distribution to the Holders of Allowed Class 3 and Class 4 Claims.
Trading Day means a
day on which shares of Valeant Pharmaceuticals International, Inc. are traded on the New York Stock Exchange.
Unaffiliated
Noteholders means certain unaffiliated holders of 2016 Notes who are party to the Unaffiliated Noteholders PSA.
Unaffiliated Noteholders PSA means that certain that certain Amended and Restated Plan Support Agreement dated
December 17, 2014, as amended from time to time, by and among the Debtors and each holder of the 2016 Notes that is a signatory thereto.
Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders has the meaning ascribed to Requisite Supporting Noteholders in
the Unaffiliated Noteholders PSA.
Unexpired Lease(s) means a lease to which any Debtor is a party that is subject to
assumption or rejection under section 365 of the Bankruptcy Code.
Unimpaired means, when used in reference to a Claim
or a Class, a Claim or a Class that is not impaired within the meaning of section 1124 of the Bankruptcy Code.
U.S. Trustee
Fees means fees payable pursuant to 28 U.S.C. § 1930.
Valeant Shares means the common shares of Valeant
Pharmaceuticals International, Inc., having an aggregate value of $49,500,000 as of the close of the market on the Trading Day immediately prior to the Effective Date, paid to the Debtors as partial consideration for the assets acquired by the
Purchaser pursuant to the Asset Purchase Agreement and the Sale Order.
Voting Deadline means May 19, 2015, at 4:00
p.m. (Eastern time), the date and time by which all Ballots to accept or reject the Plan must be received in order to be counted, as set forth by the Solicitation Procedures Order.
Wind-down Budget means a budget to be prepared by the Debtors, and reasonably acceptable to the Deerfield Requisite
Supporting Noteholders, the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders, and the Committee, which shall be filed with the Court as part of the Plan Supplement, and which may be amended from time to time after entry of the Confirmation Order,
subject to the consent of the Oversight Committee, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld, and which shall estimate the funds necessary to administer the Plan and wind down the Debtors affairs, including the costs of holding and
liquidating the Estates remaining property, objecting to Claims, making the Distributions required by the Plan,
14
prosecuting claims and Causes of Action that may be held by the Estates against third parties that are not released, waived or transferred pursuant to the Plan (including pursuant to Article
X) or otherwise, paying Taxes, filing Tax returns, paying professionals fees and expenses, paying the fees and expenses of the Oversight Committee, funding payroll and other employee costs, providing for the purchase of errors and
omissions insurance and/or other forms of indemnification for the Plan Administrator, and for all such items and other costs of administering the Plan, the Estates and the Liquidating Debtors (other than the Administrative and Priority Claims
Reserve, the Disputed Claims Reserve, and the Professional Fee Reserve).
Wind-down Reserve means the reserve account
initially funded by the Debtors in the amount of the Wind-down Budget and maintained by the Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors (or the Liquidating Trust, if established).
|
1.3 |
Rules of Interpretation |
For purposes of the Plan, (a) any reference in the Plan
to a contract, instrument, release, indenture or other agreement or document being in a particular form or on particular terms and conditions means that such document shall be substantially in such form or substantially on such terms and conditions,
(b) any reference in the Plan to an existing document or exhibit Filed or to be Filed means such document or exhibit as it may have been or may be amended, modified or supplemented, (c) unless otherwise specified, all references in the
Plan to Sections, Articles, Schedules and Exhibits are references to Sections, Articles, Schedules and Exhibits of or to the Plan, (d) the words herein, hereof, hereto, hereunder and other words
of similar import refer to the Plan in its entirety rather than to a particular portion of the Plan, (e) captions and headings to Articles and Sections are inserted for convenience of reference only and are not intended to be a part of or to
affect the interpretation of the Plan, and (f) the rules of construction set forth in section 102 of the Bankruptcy Code and in the Bankruptcy Rules shall apply.
In computing any period of time prescribed or allowed by the Plan,
the provisions of Bankruptcy Rule 9006(a) shall apply.
Unless a rule of law or procedure is supplied by federal law (including
the Bankruptcy Code and Bankruptcy Rules) and except as otherwise provided herein or therein, the laws of (i) the State of Delaware shall govern the construction and implementation of the Plan and any agreements, documents and instruments
executed in connection with the Plan and (ii) the laws of the state of incorporation of each Debtor shall govern corporate governance matters with respect to such Debtor, in either case without giving effect to the principles of conflicts of
law thereof.
15
ARTICLE II
CLASSIFICATION OF CLAIMS AND INTERESTS
All Claims and Interests, except Administrative Claims and Priority Tax
Claims, are placed in the Classes set forth below. In accordance with section 1123(a)(1) of the Bankruptcy Code, Administrative Claims and Priority Tax Claims, as described below, have not been classified.
A Claim or Interest is placed in a particular Class only to the extent that the Claim or Interest falls within the description of that Class,
and is classified in other Classes to the extent that any portion of the Claim or Interest falls within the description of such other Classes. A Claim also is placed in a particular Class for the purpose of receiving Distributions pursuant to the
Plan only to the extent that such Claim is an Allowed Claim in that Class and such Claim has not been paid, released or otherwise settled prior to the Effective Date.
|
2.2 |
Unclassified Claims (not entitled to vote on the Plan) |
(a)
Administrative Claims
(b) Priority Tax Claims
|
2.3 |
Unimpaired Classes of Claims (deemed to have accepted the Plan and not entitled to vote on the Plan) |
(a) Class 1 (Priority Non-Tax Claims): Class 1 consists of all Priority Non-Tax Claims.
(b) Class 2 (Secured Claims): Class 2 consists of all Secured Claims.
|
2.4 |
Impaired Classes of Claims (entitled to vote on the Plan) |
(a)
Class 3 (2016 Noteholder Claims): Class 3 consists of all 2016 Noteholder Claims.
(b)
Class 4 (General Unsecured Claims): Class 4 consists of all General Unsecured Claims.
|
2.5 |
Impaired Classes of Claims (not entitled to vote on the Plan) |
(a)
Class 5 (Intercompany Claims): Class 5 consists of all Intercompany Claims.
(b) Class 6
(Subordinated Claims): Class 6 consists of all Subordinated Claims.
16
|
2.6 |
Impaired Classes of Interests (not entitled to vote on the Plan) |
(a)
Class 7 (Interests): Class 7 consists of all Interests.
|
2.7 |
Unimpaired Classes of Interests (not entitled to vote on the Plan) |
(a)
Class 8 (Intercompany Interests): Class 8 consists of all Intercompany Interests.
ARTICLE III
TREATMENT OF CLAIMS AND INTERESTS
(a) Administrative Claims
On the later of (i) the Distribution Date or (ii) the date such Administrative Claim becomes an Allowed Administrative Claim (or as
soon as reasonably practicable thereafter), a Holder of an Allowed Administrative Claim (other than a Professional) shall receive, in full satisfaction, settlement and discharge of, and in exchange for, such Allowed Administrative Claim,
(a) Cash equal to the unpaid portion of the Face Amount of such Allowed Administrative Claim or (b) such other lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, shall have agreed upon in
writing; provided, however, that Allowed Administrative Claims with respect to liabilities incurred by a Debtor in the ordinary course of business during the Chapter 11 Cases may be paid in the ordinary course of business in accordance
with the terms and conditions of any agreements relating thereto (x) on or prior to the Effective Date, by the Debtors, and (y) after the Effective Date, by the Disbursing Agent. Allowed Professional Fee Claims shall be paid from the
Professional Fee Reserve pursuant to Section 5.9(a) of the Plan. For the avoidance of doubt, any payments made by the Plan Administrator on account of Allowed Administrative Claims (other than Professional Fee Claims) shall be paid
solely from the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve.
(b) Priority Tax Claims
On the later of (i) the Distribution Date or (ii) the date such Priority Tax Claim becomes an Allowed Priority Tax Claim (or as soon
as reasonably practicable thereafter), a Holder of an Allowed Priority Tax Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction, settlement and discharge of, and in exchange for, such Allowed Priority Tax Claim, (a) Cash equal to the unpaid portion of the
Face Amount of such Allowed Priority Tax Claim or (b) such other lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, shall have agreed upon in writing. For the avoidance of doubt, any payments made
by the Plan Administrator on account of Allowed Priority Tax Claims shall be paid solely from the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve.
(a) Class 1: Priority Non-Tax Claims
17
On the later of (i) the Distribution Date or (ii) the date such Priority Non-Tax Claim
becomes an Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim (or as soon as reasonably practicable thereafter), a Holder of an Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction, settlement and discharge of, and in exchange for, such Allowed Priority
Non-Tax Claim, (a) Cash equal to the unpaid portion of the Face Amount of such Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim or (b) such other treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, shall have agreed
upon in writing.
(b) Class 2: Secured Claims
On the later of (i) the Distribution Date or (ii) the date such Secured Claim becomes an Allowed Secured Claim (or as soon as
reasonably practicable thereafter), a Holder of an Allowed Secured Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction, settlement and discharge of, and in exchange for, such Allowed Secured Claim, (a) Cash equal to the value of such Allowed Secured
Claim, (b) a return of the Collateral securing the Secured Claim, (c) such treatment required under section 1124(2) of the Bankruptcy Code for such Claim to be rendered Unimpaired or (d) such other lesser treatment as to which such
Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, shall have agreed upon in writing.
Any Holder of a Secured Claim shall
retain its Lien in the Collateral or the proceeds of the Collateral (to the extent that such Collateral is sold by the Debtors or the Plan Administrator free and clear of such Lien) to the same extent and with the same priority as such Lien held as
of Petition Date until such time as (A) the Holder of such Secured Claim (i) has been paid Cash equal to the value of its Allowed Secured Claim, (ii) has received a return of the Collateral securing the Secured Claim, (iii) has
received such treatment required under section 1124(2) of the Bankruptcy Code for such Claim to be rendered Unimpaired, or (iv) has been afforded such other lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as
applicable, shall have agreed upon in writing; or (B) such purported Lien has been determined by an order of the Court to be invalid or otherwise avoidable.
|
3.3 |
Impaired Claims Entitled to Vote on the Plan |
(a) Class 3:
2016 Noteholder Claims
On the Distribution Date, and from time to time thereafter in accordance with the Plan, each Holder of an Allowed
2016 Noteholder Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction of, and in exchange for, such Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claim, (i) its Pro Rata share of 100% of the Valeant Shares (which shall be distributed immediately upon the occurrence of the
Effective Date) and (ii) its Pro Rata share of Available Cash in the amount necessary to provide such Holder its Pro Rata share of Total Distributable Value available to Holders of Class 3 Claims and Class 4 Claims, or (iii) such other
lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, shall have agreed upon in writing; provided, however, that each Holder of an Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claim shall not receive an amount
that exceeds 100% of the amount of such Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claim.
(b) Class 4: General Unsecured Claims
18
On the Distribution Date, and from time to time thereafter in accordance with the Plan, each
Holder of an Allowed General Unsecured Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction of, and in exchange for, such Allowed General Unsecured Claim, (i) its Pro Rata share of Total Distributable Value available to Holders of Class 3 Claims and Class
4 Claims, solely in the form of Available Cash or (ii) such other lesser treatment as to which such Holder and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, shall have agreed upon in writing; provided, however, that each
Holder of an Allowed General Unsecured Claim shall not receive an amount that exceeds 100% of the amount of such Allowed General Unsecured Claim.
|
3.4 |
Impaired Claims Not Entitled to Vote on the Plan |
(a) Class 5:
Intercompany Claims
In connection with, and as a result of, the substantive consolidation of the Debtors Estates and the Chapter 11
Cases, on the Effective Date, all Intercompany Claims shall be eliminated and the Holders of Intercompany Claims shall not be entitled to, and shall not receive or retain, any property or interest in property on account of such Claims.
(b) Class 6: Subordinated Claims
On the Effective Date, all Subordinated Claims shall be eliminated and the Holders of Subordinated Claims shall not be entitled to, and shall
not receive or retain, any property or interest in property on account of such Claims.
(a) Class 7: Interests
On the Effective Date, the Interests shall be deemed eliminated, cancelled and/or extinguished and each Holder thereof shall not be entitled
to, and shall not receive or retain, any property under the Plan on account of such Interest.
(a) Class 8: Intercompany Interests
On the Effective Date, the Intercompany Interests shall be reinstated and rendered Unimpaired in accordance with section 1124 of the
Bankruptcy Code.
|
3.7 |
Special Provision Regarding Unimpaired Claims |
Except as otherwise provided in the
Plan, the Confirmation Order, any other order of the Court or any document or agreement enforceable pursuant to the terms of the Plan, nothing shall affect the rights and defenses, both legal and equitable, of the Debtors and the Plan Administrator
with respect to any Unimpaired Claims, including, but not limited to, all rights with respect to legal and equitable defenses to setoffs or recoupments against Unimpaired Claims and the rights to assert all Causes of Action against the holders of
such Unimpaired Claims that the Debtors had immediately prior to the Petition Date as if the Chapter 11 Cases had not been commenced.
19
Notwithstanding any provision herein to the contrary, the Disbursing
Agent shall only make Distributions to Holders of Allowed Claims. No Holder of a Disputed Claim shall receive any Distribution on account thereof until (and then only to the extent that) its Disputed Claim becomes an Allowed Claim. The Debtors
and/or the Plan Administrator may, in their discretion, withhold Distributions otherwise due hereunder to any Claimholder until the Claims Objection Deadline, to enable a timely objection thereto to be filed. Any Holder of a Claim that becomes an
Allowed Claim after the Effective Date shall receive its Distribution in accordance with the terms and provisions of the Plan.
|
3.9 |
Special Provisions Regarding Insured Claims |
Distributions under the Plan to each
Holder of an Insured Claim shall be in accordance with the treatment provided under the Plan for the Class in which such Insured Claim is classified; provided, however, that the maximum amount of any Distribution under the Plan on
account of an Allowed Insured Claim shall be limited to an amount equal to: (a) the applicable deductible or self-insured retention under the relevant insurance policy minus (b) any reimbursement obligations of the Debtors to the insurance
carrier for sums expended by the insurance carrier on account of such Claim (including defense costs); provided further, however, that, to the extent that a Claimholder has an Allowed Insured Claim, the amount of which exceeds
the total coverage available from the relevant insurance policies of the Debtors, such Claimholder shall have an Allowed General Unsecured Claim in the amount by which such Allowed Insured Claim exceeds the coverage available from the relevant
Debtors insurance policies. Nothing in this Section shall constitute a waiver of any Cause of Action the Debtors may hold against any Person, including the Debtors insurance carriers, or is intended to, shall or shall be deemed to
preclude any Holder of an Allowed Insured Claim from seeking and/or obtaining a distribution or other recovery from any insurer of the Debtors in addition to any Distribution such Holder may receive under the Plan; provided, however,
that the Debtors do not waive, and expressly reserve their rights to assert that any insurance coverage is property of the Estates to which they are entitled.
The Plan shall not expand the scope of, or alter in any other way, the obligations of the Debtors insurers under their policies, and the
Debtors insurers shall retain any and all defenses to coverage that such insurers may have. The Plan shall not operate as a waiver of any other Claims the Debtors insurers have asserted or may assert in any Proof of Claim or the
Debtors rights and defenses to such Proofs of Claim.
20
ARTICLE IV
ACCEPTANCE OR REJECTION OF THE PLAN
|
4.1 |
Acceptance by an Impaired Class |
In accordance with section 1126(c) of the Bankruptcy
Code and except as provided in section 1126(e) of the Bankruptcy Code, an Impaired Class of Claims shall have accepted the Plan if the Plan is accepted by the Holders of at least two-thirds (2/3) in dollar amount and more than one-half
(1/2) in number of the Allowed Claims of such Class that have timely and properly voted to accept or reject the Plan.
|
4.2 |
Presumed Acceptances by Unimpaired Classes |
Classes 1, 2 and 8 are Unimpaired by the
Plan. Under section 1126(f) of the Bankruptcy Code, such Claimholders and Interest Holders are conclusively presumed to accept the Plan, and the votes of such Claimholders and Interest Holders shall not be solicited.
|
4.3 |
Classes Deemed to Reject Plan |
Holders of Claims in Classes 5 and 6 and Interest
Holders in Class 7 are not entitled to receive or retain any property under the Plan. Under section 1126(g) of the Bankruptcy Code, such Claimholders and Interest Holders are deemed to reject the Plan, and the votes of such Claimholders and Interest
Holders shall not be solicited.
|
4.4 |
Impaired Classes of Claims Entitled to Vote |
Because Claims in Class 3 and Class 4 are
Impaired under the Plan and Holders of such Claims shall receive or retain property under the Plan, Holders of Claims in Class 3 and Class 4 are entitled to vote and shall be solicited with respect to the Plan.
|
4.5 |
Elimination of Vacant Classes |
Any Class or sub-Class of Claims or Interests that does
not contain as of the date of the commencement of the Confirmation Hearing at least one Allowed Claim or Allowed Interest, as applicable, or at least one Claim or Interest, as applicable, temporarily Allowed under Bankruptcy Rule 3018, shall be
deemed deleted from the Plan for all purposes, including for purposes of (i) voting on the acceptance or rejection of the Plan and (ii) determining acceptance or rejection of the Plan by such Class under section 1129(a)(8) of the
Bankruptcy Code.
|
4.6 |
Voting Classes; Deemed Acceptance by Non-Voting Classes |
If a Class contains Claims or
Interests eligible to vote and no Holders of Claims or Interests eligible to vote in such Class vote to accept or reject the Plan, the Plan shall be deemed accepted by the Holders of such Claims or Interests in such Class.
21
|
4.7 |
Confirmation Pursuant to Section 1129(b) of the Bankruptcy Code |
Because Classes
5, 6, and 7 are deemed to reject the Plan, and Classes 3 and 4 are entitled to vote on the Plan, the Debtors shall (i) seek confirmation of the Plan from the Court by employing the cramdown procedures set forth in section 1129(b) of
the Bankruptcy Code and/or (ii) modify the Plan in accordance with Section 12.1 hereof. The Debtors reserve the right to alter, amend, modify, revoke or withdraw the Plan or any Plan Exhibit or schedule, including to amend or modify
the Plan or such exhibits or schedules to satisfy the requirements of section 1129(b) of the Bankruptcy Code, if necessary.
ARTICLE V
MEANS FOR IMPLEMENTATION OF THE PLAN
|
5.1 |
Substantive Consolidation |
(a) Consolidation of the Chapter 11
Estates
The Plan contemplates and is predicated upon entry of an order substantively consolidating the Debtors Estates and Chapter
11 Cases for all purposes, including voting, Distribution and Confirmation. On the Effective Date, (i) all Intercompany Claims, if any, between the Debtors shall be eliminated, (ii) all assets and liabilities of the Affiliate Debtors shall
be merged or treated as if they were merged with the assets and liabilities of Dendreon, (iii) any obligation of a Debtor and any guarantee thereof by the other Debtor shall be deemed to be one obligation of Dendreon, and any such guarantee
shall be eliminated, (iv) the issued and outstanding Intercompany Interests shall be reinstated, (v) each Claim Filed or to be Filed against any Debtor shall be deemed Filed only against Dendreon and shall be deemed a single Claim against
and a single obligation of Dendreon, and (vi) any joint or several liability of the Debtors shall be deemed one obligation of Dendreon. On the Effective Date, and in accordance with the terms of the Plan and the consolidation of the assets and
liabilities of the Debtors, all Claims based upon guarantees of collection, payment or performance made by one Debtor as to the obligations of another Debtor shall be released and of no further force and effect.
The substantive consolidation effected pursuant to this Section 5.1(a) of the Plan (x) shall not affect the rights of any
Holder of a Secured Claim with respect to the Collateral securing such Claims and (y) shall not, and shall not be deemed to, prejudice the Causes of Action and the Avoidance Actions (subject to the releases set forth in Section 10.4
of the Plan), which shall survive entry of the Substantive Consolidation Order, as if there had been no substantive consolidation. Notwithstanding the substantive consolidation provided for herein, each and every Debtor shall remain responsible for
the payment of fees pursuant to 28 U.S.C. § 1930 until a particular case is closed, dismissed or converted.
(b)
Substantive Consolidation Order
The Plan shall serve as, and shall be deemed to be, a motion for entry of an
order substantively consolidating the Debtors Chapter 11 Cases. If no objection to substantive consolidation is timely Filed and served by any Holder of an Impaired Claim affected by the Plan as provided herein on or before the deadline to
object to Confirmation of the Plan, or such other
22
date as may be fixed by the Court, the Substantive Consolidation Order (which may be the Confirmation Order) may be approved by the Court. If any such objections are timely Filed and served, a
hearing with respect to the substantive consolidation of the Chapter 11 Cases and the objections thereto shall be scheduled by the Court, which hearing may, but is not required to, coincide with the Confirmation Hearing.
(a) Merger and Dissolution of Debtors
Immediately following the occurrence of the Effective Date, (a) the respective boards of directors of the Debtors shall be terminated and
the members of the boards of directors of the Debtors shall be deemed to have resigned and (b) the Debtors shall continue to exist as the Liquidating Debtors after the Effective Date in accordance with the laws of the State of Delaware and
pursuant to their respective certificates of incorporation, by-laws, articles of formation, operating agreements, and other organizational documents in effect prior to the Effective Date, except to the extent such organizational documents are
amended under the Plan, for the limited purposes of liquidating all of the assets of the Estates and making Distributions in accordance with the Plan.
On December 31, 2015 (the Outside Date), and without further order of the Court, the Affiliate Debtors shall be deemed
merged with and into Dendreon, without the necessity of any other or further actions to be taken by or on behalf of the Debtors or payments to be made in connection therewith; provided, however, that the Debtors, the Liquidating
Debtors or the Plan Administrator may execute and file documents and take all other actions as they deem appropriate relating to the foregoing corporate actions under the laws of the State of Delaware and, in such event, all applicable regulatory or
governmental agencies shall take all steps necessary to allow and effect the prompt merger of the Affiliate Debtors as provided herein, without the payment of any fee, Tax or charge and without need for the filing of reports or certificates.
Moreover, on and after the first day following the Outside Date, the Affiliate Debtors (i) shall be deemed to have withdrawn their
business operations from any state in which they were previously conducting, or are registered or licensed to conduct, their business operations, and shall not be required to file any document, pay any sum or take any other action in order to
effectuate such withdrawal, and (ii) shall not be liable in any manner to any taxing or other authority for franchise, business, license or similar Taxes accruing on or after the Outside Date.
As soon as practicable after the Plan Administrator exhausts substantially all of the assets of the Debtors Estates by making the final
Distribution of Cash under the Plan, the Plan Administrator shall at the expense of the Debtors Estates (i) provide for the retention and storage of the books, records and files that shall have been delivered to or created by the Plan
Administrator until such time as all such books, records and files are no longer required to be retained under applicable law, and File a certificate informing the Court of the location at which such books, records and files are being stored;
provided that any Tax records shall be turned over to the Purchaser in accordance with the Asset Purchase Agreement no later than the issuance of the final decree in the Chapter 11 Cases; (ii) File a certification stating that the assets
of the
23
Debtors Estates have been exhausted and final Distributions of Cash have been made under the Plan; (iii) File the necessary paperwork in the state of Delaware to effectuate the
dissolution of Dendreon in accordance with the laws of such jurisdiction; and (iv) resign as the sole shareholder, officer, director and manager, as applicable, of the Liquidating Debtors. Upon the Filing of the certificate described in clause
(ii) of the preceding sentence, Dendreon shall be deemed dissolved for all purposes without the necessity for any other or further actions to be taken by or on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors or payments to be made in connection therewith
other than the filing of a motion for final decree.
In furtherance of the liquidation of the Liquidating Debtors and as necessary to
comply with section 8.1(h) of the Asset Purchase Agreement, on or prior to December 31, 2015, a liquidating trust may be established pursuant to documentation, including a liquidating trust agreement, approved by the Liquidating Debtors, the
Plan Administrator and the Oversight Committee, for the primary purpose of receiving assets of the Estates, continuing the wind down of such Estates in a commercially reasonable but expeditious manner, and distributing any such assets pursuant to
this Plan, with no objective to continue or engage in the conduct of a trade or business except to the extent reasonably necessary to and consistent with, the liquidating purpose of the trust (any such trust, the Liquidating
Trust).
If established, the Liquidating Trust shall be structured to qualify as a liquidating trust within the
meaning of Treasury Regulations Section 301.7701-4(d) and in compliance with Revenue Procedure 94-45, 1994-2 C.B. 684, and, thus, as a grantor trust within the meaning of Sections 671 through 679 of the Tax Code to the Holders of
Claims, consistent with the terms of the Plan; provided, however, that the Plan Administrator in its role as liquidating trustee, after consultation with the Oversight Committee, may make an election under Treasury Regulations
Section 1.468B-9(c)(2)(ii) to treat the Liquidating Trust (or any portion thereof) as a disputed ownership fund. Accordingly, unless an election is made to treat the Liquidating Trust as a disputed ownership fund, such Holders shall be
treated for U.S. federal income tax purposes, (i) as direct recipients of an undivided interest in the assets transferred to the Liquidating Trust and as having immediately contributed such assets to the Liquidating Trust, and
(ii) thereafter, as the grantors and deemed owners of the Liquidating Trust and thus, the direct owners of an undivided interest in the assets held by the Liquidating Trust. All parties (including Claimholders) shall report consistent with
the valuation of the assets transferred to the Liquidating Trust as established by the Plan Administrator or its designee. The Plan Administrator is hereby appointed in such instance pursuant to section 1123(b)(3)(B) of the Bankruptcy Code to
handle all of the Debtors tax matters, including without limitation, the filing of all tax returns, and the handling of tax audits and proceedings, of the Debtors. The liquidating trustee shall be responsible for filing information on behalf
of the Liquidating Trust as grantor trust pursuant to Treasury Regulation Section 1.671-4(a) or as a disputed ownership fund.
(b)
Certificate of Incorporation and By-laws
The certificate and articles of incorporation and by-laws of each Debtor
shall be amended as necessary to satisfy the provisions of the Plan and the Bankruptcy Code and shall include, among other things, a provision (a) prohibiting the issuance of non-voting equity securities under section 1123(a)(6) of the
Bankruptcy Code and (b) limiting the activities of the Liquidating Debtors to matters authorized under the Plan. The amended certificate of incorporation and by-
24
laws of each Debtor shall be reasonably acceptable to the Committee, the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders and the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders and shall be Filed on or
before the date of the Confirmation Hearing.
(c) Cancellation of Existing Securities and Agreements
Except as otherwise provided in the Plan, and in any contract, instrument or other agreement or document created in connection with the Plan,
on the Effective Date and concurrently with the applicable Distributions made pursuant to Article III hereof, any promissory notes, share certificates, whether for preferred or common stock (including treasury stock), other instruments
evidencing any Claims or Interests, other than a Claim or Interest that is being reinstated and rendered unimpaired, and all options, warrants, calls, rights, puts, awards, commitments or any other agreements of any character to acquire such
Interests shall be deemed cancelled and of no further force and effect, without any further act or action under any applicable agreement, law, regulation, order or rule, and the obligations of the Debtors under the notes, share certificates and
other agreements and instruments governing such Claims and Interests shall be discharged; provided, however, that certain instruments, documents and credit agreements related to Claims shall continue in effect solely for the purposes
of allowing the agents to make distributions to the beneficial holders and lenders thereunder. The holders of or parties to such cancelled notes, share certificates and other agreements and instruments shall have no rights arising from or relating
to such notes, share certificates and other agreements and instruments or the cancellation thereof, except the rights provided pursuant to the Plan.
The Final Order Pursuant to Bankruptcy Code Sections 105(a), 362(a)(3) and 541 and Bankruptcy Rule 3001 Establishing Notice and Hearing
Procedures for Trading in Equity Securities in Debtors [Docket No. 162], entered on December 9, 2014, shall remain in full force and effect on and after the Effective Date to enforce any violations of such order that occurred prior to the
Effective Date.
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Plan, on the Effective Date and concurrently with the applicable
Distributions made pursuant to Article III hereof, the 2016 Notes Indenture shall be cancelled except to the extent required for the purposes of permitting the 2016 Notes Trustee to enforce its right to compensation and related lien rights
under section 6.07 of the 2016 Notes Indenture, subject to Section 5.14 hereof.
(d) No Further
Action
Each of the matters provided for under the Plan involving the corporate structure of the Debtors or corporate action to be taken
by or required of the Debtors shall, as of the Effective Date, be deemed to have occurred and be effective as provided herein, and shall be authorized and approved in all respects without any requirement of further action by any Person, including
but not limited to, the Plan Administrator, Holders of Claims or Interests against or in the Debtors, or directors or officers of the Debtors, as permitted by section 303 of the Delaware General Corporation Law.
(e) Effectuating Documents
25
Prior to the Effective Date, any appropriate officer of Dendreon or the Affiliate Debtors, as the
case may be, shall be authorized to execute, deliver, file or record such contracts, instruments, releases, indentures and other agreements or documents, and take such actions as may be necessary or appropriate to effectuate and further evidence the
terms and conditions of the Plan. The secretary of Dendreon or the Affiliate Debtors, as the case may be, shall be authorized to certify or attest to any of the foregoing actions.
(f) Directors and Officers; Further Transactions
Immediately upon the occurrence of the Effective Date, the Plan Administrator shall serve as the sole shareholder, officer, director or
manager of each of the Liquidating Debtors. The Plan Administrator shall be authorized to execute, deliver, file or record such documents, instruments, releases and other agreements and to take such actions as may be necessary or appropriate to
effectuate and further evidence the terms and conditions of the Plan.
|
5.3 |
Compliance with the Asset Purchase Agreement |
Notwithstanding anything in the Plan to
the contrary, nothing herein shall eliminate any post-closing obligations of the Debtors under the Asset Purchase Agreement, including, without limitation, that (i) the Valeant Shares may be distributed proportionately solely to the Holders of
the Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims provided that the total amount of Allowed General Unsecured Claims does not exceed $200 million, and (ii) Dendreon shall liquidate as determined for U.S. federal income tax purposes no later than
December 31, 2015.
(a) Legal Representation of the Debtors and
Committee After the Effective Date
Upon the Effective Date, the attorney-client relationship between (i) the Debtors and their
current counsel, Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP, and (ii) the Committee and its current counsel, Sullivan & Cromwell LLP, and Young Conaway Stargatt & Taylor, LLP, shall be deemed terminated. No successor to
the Debtors and/or the Committee, whether under this Plan or otherwise, including but not limited to the Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator, shall be deemed to succeed to the attorney-client relationship that currently exists between the
Debtors and its counsel and the Committee and its counsel. Subject only to the applicable ethical rules governing attorneys, their receipt of confidential information and their relationship with former clients, current counsel for the Debtors or the
Committee shall not be precluded from representing any party in any action that might be brought by or against the Liquidating Debtors and/or the Plan Administrator.
(b) Transfer of Evidentiary Privileges; Document Requests
On the Effective Date, the Liquidating Debtors and the Plan
26
Administrator shall succeed to the evidentiary privileges, including attorney-client privilege, formerly held by the Debtors.
Accordingly, to the extent that documents are requested from current counsel to the Debtors by any Person, after the Effective Date, only the
Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator shall have the ability to waive such attorney-client or other privileges. In addition, unless otherwise ordered by the Court, current counsel to the Debtors shall have no obligation to produce any
documents currently in their possession as a result of or arising in any way out of their representation of the Debtors unless (i) the Person requesting such documents serves their request on the Plan Administrator; (ii) the Plan
Administrator consents in writing to such production and any waiver of the attorney-client or other privilege such production might cause; and (iii) the Plan Administrator or the Person requesting such production, agrees to pay the reasonable
costs and expenses incurred by current counsel for the Debtors in connection with such production.
|
5.5 |
Dissolution of the Committee |
The Committee shall continue in existence until the
Effective Date to exercise those powers and perform those duties specified in section 1103 of the Bankruptcy Code and shall perform such other duties as it may have been assigned by the Court prior to the Effective Date. On the Effective Date, the
Committee shall be dissolved and its members shall have no further duties, responsibilities and obligations in connection with the Chapter 11 Cases or the Plan and its implementation, and the retention or employment of the Committees
attorneys, financial advisors and other agents shall terminate, except with respect to (i) all Professional Fee Claims and (ii) any appeals of the Confirmation Order. All expenses of Committee members and the reasonable fees and expenses
of the Committees Professionals through the Effective Date shall be paid in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Professional Fee Order and/or the Plan, as applicable. Professionals employed by the Committee shall be entitled to
reasonable compensation and reimbursement of actual, necessary expenses for post-Effective Date activities, including the preparation, filing and prosecution of final fee applications.
|
5.6 |
The Plan Administrator |
(a) Appointment of the Plan
Administrator
From and after the Effective Date, a Person or Entity to be designated by the Debtors, and subject to the consent of the
Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders, the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders, and the Committee, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld, shall serve as the Plan Administrator pursuant to the Plan Administrator Agreement
and the Plan, until the resignation or discharge and the appointment of a successor Plan Administrator in accordance with the Plan Administrator Agreement and the Plan. The Debtors shall file a notice providing the information set forth in sections
1129(a)(4) and (5) of the Bankruptcy Code on a date that is not less than ten (10) days prior to the hearing to consider confirmation of the Plan designating the Person who it has selected as Plan Administrator. The appointment of the Plan
Administrator shall be approved in the Confirmation Order, and such appointment shall be as of the Effective Date. The Plan Administrator shall have and perform all of the duties, responsibilities, rights and obligations set forth in the Plan and
Plan Administrator Agreement.
(b) The Plan Administrator Agreement
27
Prior to or on the Effective Date, the Debtors shall execute a Plan Administrator Agreement in
substantially the same form as set forth in Exhibit A, which shall be reasonably acceptable to the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders, the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders, and the Committee. Any nonmaterial modifications
to the Plan Administrator Agreement made by the Debtors, and reasonably acceptable to the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders, the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders, and the Committee, prior to the Effective Date are hereby
ratified. The Plan Administrator Agreement will contain provisions permitting the amendment or modification of the Plan Administrator Agreement necessary to implement the provisions of the Plan.
(c) Rights, Powers and Duties of the Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator
The Liquidating Debtors shall retain and have all the rights, powers and duties necessary to carry out its responsibilities under the Plan.
Such rights, powers and duties, which shall be exercisable by the Plan Administrator on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors and the Estates pursuant to the Plan and the Plan Administrator Agreement, shall include, among others, (i) investigating
and, if appropriate, pursuing Causes of Action, (ii) administering and pursuing the Liquidating Debtors assets, (iii) resolving all Disputed Claims and any Claim objections pending as of the Effective Date and (iv) making
Distributions to Holders of Allowed Claims as provided for in the Plan.
(d) Compensation of the Plan
Administrator
The Plan Administrator shall be compensated from the Wind-down Reserve pursuant to the terms of the Plan Administrator
Agreement. Any professionals retained by the Plan Administrator shall be entitled to reasonable compensation for services rendered and reimbursement of expenses incurred from the Wind-down Reserve. The payment of the fees and expenses of the Plan
Administrator and its retained professionals shall be made in the ordinary course of business and shall not be subject to the approval of the Court; provided, however, that any disputes related to such fees and expenses shall be
brought before the Court.
(e) Indemnification
The Liquidating Debtors shall indemnify and hold harmless (i) the Plan Administrator (in its capacity as such and as officer and director
of the Liquidating Debtors), (ii) such individuals that may serve as officers and directors of the Liquidating Debtors, if any, and (iii) the Plan Administrator Professionals (collectively, the Indemnified Parties), from
and against and with respect to any and all liabilities, losses, damages, claims, costs and expenses, including but not limited to attorneys fees arising out of or due to their actions or omissions, or consequences of such actions or
omissions, other than acts or omissions resulting from such Indemnified Partys willful misconduct or gross negligence, with respect to the Liquidating Debtors or the implementation or administration of the Plan or Plan Administrator Agreement.
To the extent an Indemnified Party asserts a claim for indemnification as provided above, the legal fees and related costs incurred by counsel to the Plan Administrator in monitoring and participating in the defense of such claims giving rise to the
asserted right of indemnification shall be advanced to such Indemnified Party (and such Indemnified Party undertakes to repay such amounts if it
28
ultimately shall be determined that such Indemnified Party is not entitled to be indemnified therefore) out of the Wind-down Reserve or any insurance purchased using the Wind-down Reserve. The
indemnification provisions of the Plan Administrator Agreement shall remain available to and be binding upon any former Plan Administrator or the estate of any decedent of the Plan Administrator and shall survive the termination of the Plan
Administrator Agreement.
(f) Insurance
The Plan Administrator shall be authorized to obtain and pay for out of the Wind-down Reserve all reasonably necessary insurance coverage for
itself, its agents, representatives, employees or independent contractors, and the Liquidating Debtors, including, but not limited to, coverage with respect to (i) any property that is or may in the future become the property of the Liquidating
Debtors or their Estates and (ii) the liabilities, duties and obligations of the Plan Administrator and its agents, representatives, employees or independent contractors under the Plan Administrator Agreement (in the form of an errors and
omissions policy or otherwise), the latter of which insurance coverage may remain in effect for a reasonable period of time as determined by the Plan Administrator after the termination of the Plan Administrator Agreement.
(g) Revesting of Assets
Except as expressly provided elsewhere in this Plan, on the Effective Date, the property of each Debtors Estate, if any, shall revest in
the applicable Liquidating Debtor.
5.7 Distributions to Holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims and General
Unsecured Claims
(a) Initial Distributions
On the Distribution Date, the Plan Administrator shall make, or shall make adequate reserves in the Disputed Claims Reserve for, the
Distributions required to be made under the Plan to Holders of Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims and Allowed General Unsecured Claims. The Disbursing Agent shall not make any Distributions to the Holders of Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims or Allowed
General Unsecured Claims unless the Plan Administrator retains and reserves in the Disputed Claims Reserve such amounts as are required under Section 6.9(c) of the Plan.
(b) Interim Distributions
The Disbursing Agent shall make interim Distributions of Cash in accordance with this Plan (i) to Holders of Allowed 2016 Noteholder
Claims and Allowed General Unsecured Claims at least once each three-month period, unless the aggregate amount of such Distributions, except for the last anticipated Distributions, is $100,000.00 or less, and (ii) from the Disputed Claims
Reserve as Disputed General Unsecured Claims become Allowed Claims.
(c) Final Distributions
The Liquidating Debtors shall be dissolved and their affairs wound up and the Plan Administrator shall make the final Distributions on the
date when, (A) in the reasonable
29
judgment of the Plan Administrator, substantially all of the assets of the Liquidating Debtors have been liquidated and there are no substantial potential sources of additional Cash for
Distribution, and (B) there remain no substantial Disputed Claims. The date on which the Plan Administrator determines that all obligations under the Plan and Plan Administrator Agreement have been satisfied is referred to as the Plan
Termination Date. On the Plan Termination Date, the Plan Administrator shall, to the extent not already done, request that the Court enter an order closing the Chapter 11 Cases.
Upon dissolution of the Liquidating Debtors in accordance with Section 5.2(a), if the Plan Administrator reasonably determines
that any remaining assets of the Liquidating Debtors are valued at $10,000.00 or less, or exceed the amounts required to be paid under the Plan, the Plan Administrator shall transfer such remaining funds to a charitable institution selected by the
Plan Administrator, which charitable institution shall be qualified as a not-for-profit corporation under applicable federal and state laws. If the Plan Administrator determines that any remaining assets of the Liquidating Debtors are valued at more
than $10,000.00, the Plan Administrator may seek to transfer such remaining assets to a charitable institution in accordance with this Section 5.7(c) upon a motion to the Court.
|
5.8 |
Limited Release of Liens |
On the Effective Date, all mortgages, deeds of trust, liens
or other security interests against property of the Estates shall be released, subject to the requirements of Section 3.2(b).
|
5.9 |
Accounts and Reserves |
(a) Professional Fee Reserve
On or before the Effective Date, the Debtors shall create and fund the Professional Fee Reserve in Cash in the Amount of the Professional Fee
Estimate. Subject to Section 5.9(e), the Cash so transferred shall not be used for any purpose other than to pay Allowed Professional Fee Claims, Supporting Noteholders Professional Fee Claims, the Allowed Deerfield Substantial
Contribution Claim, the Allowed Committee Member Substantial Contribution Claims, and the 2016 Notes Trustee Fee Claims, and no payments on account of such claims shall be made from any source other than the Professional Fee Reserve. The Plan
Administrator (i) shall segregate and shall not commingle the Cash held in the Professional Fee Reserve, (ii) subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan, shall pay each Professional Fee Claim of a Professional employed by the Debtors
or the Committee, on or as soon as reasonably practicable after the date such Claim becomes an Allowed Claim, upon entry of a Final Order allowing such Claim, (iii) shall pay the Supporting Noteholders Professional Fee Claims upon satisfaction
of the conditions to payment provided under the PSA Order, and (iv) shall pay any other Claims permitted to be paid from the Professional Fee Reserve pursuant to the terms of the Plan. After all Professional Fee Claims are Allowed or Disallowed and
the Allowed amounts of such Claims are paid by the Plan Administrator, any remaining Cash in the Professional Fee Reserve shall be transferred to the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve until such time as all Administrative Claims (except
Professional Fee Claims), Priority Tax Claims and Priority Non-Tax Claims are Allowed or Disallowed and the Allowed amounts of such Claims are paid by the Plan Administrator, then such remaining Cash, if any, shall be available for Pro Rata
distribution to Holders of Allowed
30
Class 3 Claims and Allowed Class 4 Claims. Only Professionals employed in the Chapter 11 Cases by the Debtors or the Committee, the Supporting Noteholders Professionals, the Allowed Deerfield
Substantial Contribution Claim, the Allowed Committee Member Substantial Contribution Claims, and the 2016 Notes Trustee Fee Claims shall be entitled to payment from the Professional Fee Reserve. For the avoidance of doubt, (i) the Supporting
Noteholders Professionals shall not be required to file final fee applications and shall only be required to meet the conditions necessary to payment as set forth in the PSA Order and (ii) the 2016 Notes Trustee shall not be required to file a final
fee application and shall be paid pursuant to Section 5.14 hereof.
The Professionals employed by the Debtors and the Committee, as
applicable, the Supporting Noteholders and the 2016 Notes Trustee, shall be entitled to reasonable compensation and reimbursement of actual, necessary expenses for post-Effective Date activities, including the preparation, filing and prosecution of
final fee applications (if applicable), upon the submission of redacted invoices to the Plan Administrator for payment from the Professional Fee Reserve. Any Supporting Noteholders Professional that serves as a member of the Oversight Committee
shall be entitled to such post-Effective Date fees and expenses incurred for serving in such capacity and, separately, in its capacity as a Supporting Noteholders Professional; provided, however, that in no event shall any such
Supporting Noteholders Professional be entitled to receive fees and expenses in more than one such capacity on account of any given efforts. Any time or expenses incurred in the preparation, filing and prosecution of final fee applications shall be
disclosed by each Professional in its final fee application and shall be subject to approval of the Court.
(b)
Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve
On or before the Effective Date, the Debtors shall create and fund the
Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve in Cash in the Amount of the Administrative and Priority Claims Estimate. The Cash so transferred shall not be used for any purpose other than to pay Allowed Administrative Claims (except Professional Fee
Claims, which shall be paid from the Professional Fee Reserve), Priority Tax Claims and Priority Non-Tax Claims, and, subject to Section 5.9(e), no payments on account of the foregoing claims shall be made from any source other than the
Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve. The Plan Administrator (i) shall segregate and shall not commingle the Cash held in the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve and (ii) shall pay each Administrative Claim (except
Professional Fee Claims, which shall be paid from the Professional Fee Reserve), Priority Tax Claim and Priority Non-Tax Claim, on or as soon as reasonably practicable after the date such Claim becomes an Allowed Claim. After all Administrative
Claims (including Professional Fee Claims), Priority Tax Claims and Priority Non-Tax Claims are Allowed or Disallowed and the Allowed amounts of such Claims are paid by the Plan Administrator, any remaining Cash in the Administrative and Priority
Claims Reserve shall be available for Pro Rata distribution to Holders of Allowed Class 3 Claims and Allowed Class 4 Claims.
(c)
Disputed Claims Reserve
On or before the Effective Date, the Debtors shall create and fund the Disputed Claims
Reserve in Cash in the amount of the Disputed Claims Estimate. Subject to Section 5.9(e), no payments made on account of Disputed General Unsecured Claims that become Allowed Claims after the Effective Date shall be made from any source
other than the Disputed Claims Reserve.
(d) Wind-down Reserve
On or before the Effective Date, the Debtors shall create and fund the Wind-down Reserve in Cash in the amount of the Wind-down Budget.
Subject to Section 5.9(e), no
31
payments to the Plan Administrator and Plan Administrator Professionals shall be made from any source other than the Wind-down Reserve. Any recovery from Causes of Action shall be deposited by
the Plan Administrator into the Wind-down Reserve.
(e) Other Reserves and Modifications to Reserves
Subject to and in accordance with the provisions of the Plan Administrator Agreement and the Wind-down Budget, the Plan Administrator may
establish and administer any other necessary reserves that may be required under the Plan or Plan Administrator Agreement, subject to the consent of the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders, the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders
and the Committee prior to the Effective Date, or the Oversight Committee on and after the Effective Date, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in the Plan, the Plan Administrator may,
in consultation with the Oversight Committee, make transfers of money between the reserves established hereunder to satisfy Claims and other obligations in accordance with the Plan and the Wind-down Budget.
|
5.10 |
Exemption from Certain Transfer Taxes |
Pursuant to section 1146(a) of the Bankruptcy
Code, any transfers of property pursuant to the Plan shall not be subject to any document recording tax, stamp tax, conveyance fee, intangibles or similar tax, mortgage tax, real estate transfer tax, mortgage recording tax or other similar tax or
governmental assessment, and the Confirmation Order shall direct the appropriate state or local governmental officials or agents to forego the collection of any such tax or governmental assessment and to accept for filing and recordation instruments
or other documents without the payment of any such tax or governmental assessment.
|
5.11 |
Exemption from Securities Laws |
As provided in the Solicitation Procedures Order, the
offer and sale of the Valeant Shares pursuant to the Plan is exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act and similar state and local statutes pursuant and subject to section 1145 of the Bankruptcy Code. The Debtors are authorized
to offer the Valeant Shares pursuant to the safe harbor contained in section 1125(e) of the Bankruptcy Code. The Valeant Shares may be resold by the holders thereof without restriction except to the extent that any such holder is deemed to be
(i) an underwriter as defined in section 1145(b)(1) of the Bankruptcy Code, (ii) an issuer or an affiliate of an issuer, or (iii) a dealer.
32
|
5.12 |
Preservation of Causes of Action |
In accordance with section 1123(b) of the
Bankruptcy Code, the Debtors and their Estates shall retain all of the Causes of Action, a nonexclusive list of which is set forth on Exhibit C, annexed to this Plan. The Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors, may enforce
all rights to commence and pursue, as appropriate, the Causes of Action, and the Plan Administrators rights to commence, prosecute or settle such Causes of Action shall be preserved notwithstanding the occurrence of the Effective Date or the
dissolution of the Debtors. The Plan Administrator expressly reserves all rights to prosecute any and all Causes of Action against any Entity, except as otherwise expressly provided in the Plan. Unless any Causes of Action against an Entity are
expressly waived, relinquished, exculpated, released, compromised or settled in the Plan or a Court order, the Plan Administrator expressly reserves all Causes of Action for later adjudication, and, therefore, no preclusion doctrine, including the
doctrines of res judicata, collateral estoppel, issue preclusion, claim preclusion, estoppels (judicial, equitable or otherwise) or laches, shall apply to such Causes of Action upon, after or as a consequence of the Confirmation or
Consummation. For the avoidance of doubt, the Plan Administrator shall waive and shall not commence, pursue or prosecute claims, if any, pursuant to section 547 of the Bankruptcy Code against any non-Insiders of the Debtors.
The Plan Administrator shall be authorized to (i) enforce, (ii) prosecute, and (iii) settle or compromise (subject to the
consent of the Oversight Committee for settlements in the amount of $100,000.00 and above) the Causes of Action. The Plan Administrator may pursue such Causes of Action, with the consent of the Oversight Committee, which consent shall not be
unreasonably withheld, in accordance with the obligations of the Plan and the best interests of all of the beneficiaries of the Plan. The method of distribution of the Estates assets pursuant to the Plan shall not, and shall not be deemed to,
prejudice the Causes of Action, which shall survive entry of the Confirmation Order for the beneficiaries of the Plan. At any time after the Confirmation Date and before the Effective Date, notwithstanding anything in the Plan to the contrary, the
Debtors may settle any or all of the Causes of Action with the approval of the Court pursuant to Fed. R. Bankr. P. 9019.
The Debtors have
not conducted an investigation into the Causes of Action. Accordingly, in considering this Plan, each party in interest should understand that any and all Causes of Action that may exist against such Person or Entity may be pursued by the Plan
Administrator, regardless of whether, or the manner in which, such Causes of Action are listed on Exhibit C to this Plan or described herein. The failure of the Debtors to list a claim, right, cause of action, suit or proceeding on Exhibit
C to this Plan shall not constitute a waiver or release by the Debtors or their Estates of such claim, right of action, suit or proceeding.
The substantive consolidation of the Debtors and their Estates pursuant to the Confirmation Order and Section 5.1 of this Plan
shall not, and shall not be deemed to, prejudice any of the Causes of Action, which shall survive entry of the Confirmation Order for the benefit of the Debtors and their Estates, and, upon the Effective Date, for the benefit of the Liquidating
Debtors.
33
|
5.13 |
Effectuating Documents; Further Transactions |
The Plan Administrator, subject to the
terms and conditions of this Plan and the Plan Administrator Agreement, shall be authorized to execute, deliver, file or record such contracts, instruments, releases, indentures and other agreements or documents, and take such actions as may be
necessary or appropriate to effectuate and further evidence the terms and conditions of the Plan and the conveyance and transfer of assets and liabilities provided for by the Asset Purchase Agreement.
|
5.14 |
2016 Notes Trustee Fee Claims |
The Debtors or the Liquidating Debtors, on the Effective
Date to the extent invoiced, or as soon as reasonably practicable following receipt of redacted invoices post-Effective Date (which invoices shall also be provided to the Supporting Noteholders and the Committee), shall pay the 2016 Notes Trustee
Fee Claims incurred through the Effective Date; provided, however, if the Debtors, the Liquidating Debtors, the Committee or the Supporting Noteholders, as applicable, and the 2016 Notes Trustee cannot agree with respect to the
reasonableness of the fees and expenses to be paid, the Debtors or the Liquidating Debtors, as applicable, shall (i) pay the undisputed portion of any invoices submitted with respect to 2016 Notes Trustee Fee Claims, (ii) place the
disputed amounts of any such invoices in escrow, and (iii) notify the 2016 Notes Trustee of any dispute within ten (10) days after the presentation of such invoices. After the parties have attempted in good faith to resolve any such
dispute for at least fifteen (15) days after the notification of the dispute, the 2016 Notes Trustee may submit such dispute for resolution to the Court; provided, however, that the Courts review shall be limited to a
determination under the reasonableness standard in accordance with the 2016 Notes Indenture. Nothing herein (including, without limitation, any release, discharge or injunction provided under the Plan) shall impair, waive, discharge or negatively
affect any charging lien for any fees, costs and expenses not paid pursuant to this Plan and otherwise claimed by the 2016 Notes Trustee in accordance with the 2016 Notes Indenture.
As of the Effective Date, a post-confirmation committee (the
Oversight Committee) shall be formed. The members of the Oversight Committee shall be identified in the Plan Supplement. After the Effective Date, the Plan Administrator shall consult with the Oversight Committee regarding
(i) Causes of Action and Disputed Claims for which the Plan Administrator proposes a settlement in the amount of $100,000.00 and above) and (ii) the disposition of property of the Debtors and the Liquidating Debtors for $100,000.00 and
above in accordance with the terms of the Plan and the Plan Administrator Agreement.
The compensation of the members of the Oversight
Committee shall be provided in the Plan Supplement.
34
ARTICLE VI
PROVISIONS GOVERNING DISTRIBUTIONS
|
6.1 |
Distributions for Claims Allowed as of the Effective Date |
Except as otherwise provided
herein or as ordered by the Court, all Distributions to be made on account of Claims that are Allowed Claims as of the Effective Date shall be made on the Distribution Date by the Disbursing Agent in accordance with Section 5.7(a);
provided that the Pro Rata Distribution of the Valeant Shares to the Holders of Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims shall be made immediately upon the occurrence of the Effective Date and the Liquidating Debtors shall make reasonable efforts to
make a Pro Rata Distribution of Available Cash to Holders of Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims and Holders of Allowed General Unsecured Claims on the Effective Date. Distributions on account of Claims that first become Allowed Claims after the
Effective Date shall be made pursuant to the terms and conditions of this Plan. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan to the contrary, no Distribution shall be made on account of any Allowed Claim or portion thereof that (i) has been
satisfied after the Petition Date; (ii) is listed in the schedules as contingent, unliquidated, disputed or in a zero amount, and for which a Proof of Claim has not been timely filed; or (iii) is evidenced by a Proof of Claim that has been
amended by a subsequently filed Proof of Claim.
The Disbursing Agent shall make all Distributions required under this
Plan, subject to the terms and provisions of this Plan. If the Disbursing Agent is an independent third party designated to serve in such capacity, such Disbursing Agent shall receive, without further Court approval, reasonable compensation from the
Wind-down Reserve for distribution services rendered pursuant to the Plan and reimbursement of reasonable out-of-pocket expenses. No Disbursing Agent shall be required to give any bond or surety or other security for the performance of its duties.
The Disbursing Agent shall be authorized and directed to rely upon the Debtors Books and Records and the Plan Administrators representatives and professionals in determining Allowed Claims not entitled to Distributions under the Plan in
accordance with the terms and conditions of this Plan. Class 3 Distributions of the Valeant Shares on account of Allowed 2016 Noteholder Claims shall be made immediately upon the occurrence of the Effective Date to such Holders.
|
6.3 |
Delivery of Distributions and Undeliverable or Unclaimed Distributions |
(a)
Delivery of Distributions in General
Distributions to Holders of Allowed Claims shall be made by the Disbursing
Agent (a) at the addresses set forth on the Proofs of Claim filed by such Holders (or at the last known addresses of such Holders if no Proof of Claim is filed or if the Debtors have been notified of a change of address), (b) at the
addresses set forth in any written notices of address changes delivered to the Disbursing Agent after the date of any related Proof of Claim, after sufficient evidence of such addresses as may be requested by the Disbursing Agent is provided,
(c) at the addresses reflected in the Schedules if no Proof of Claim has been filed and the Disbursing Agent has not received a written notice of a change of address, (d) at the addresses set forth in the other records of the Debtors or
the Disbursing
35
Agent at the time of the Distribution or (e) in the case of the Holder of a Claim that is governed by an agreement and is administered by an agent or servicer, at the addresses contained in
the official records of such agent or servicer.
In making Distributions under the Plan, the Disbursing Agent may rely upon the accuracy
of the Claims register maintained by the Claims Agent in the Chapter 11 Cases, as modified by any Final Order of the Court disallowing Claims in whole or in part.
(b) Undeliverable and Unclaimed Distributions
If the Distribution to any Holder of an Allowed Claim is returned to the Disbursing Agent as undeliverable or is otherwise unclaimed, no
further Distributions shall be made to such Holder unless and until the Disbursing Agent is notified in writing of such Holders then-current address and such Holder provides sufficient evidence of such address as may be requested by the
Disbursing Agent, at which time all missed Distributions shall be made to such Holder without interest, subject to the time limitations set forth below. Amounts in respect of undeliverable Distributions made by the Disbursing Agent shall be returned
to the Disbursing Agent until such Distributions are claimed. The Disbursing Agent shall segregate and, with respect to Cash, deposit in a segregated account designated as an unclaimed Distribution reserve undeliverable and unclaimed Distributions
for the benefit of all such similarly-situated Persons until such time as a Distribution becomes deliverable or is claimed, subject to the time limitations set forth below.
Any Holder of an Allowed Claim that does not assert a claim pursuant to this Plan for an undeliverable or unclaimed Distribution within ninety
(90) days after the date such Distribution was returned undeliverable shall be deemed to have forfeited its Claim for such undeliverable or unclaimed Distribution and shall be forever barred and enjoined from asserting any such claim for an
undeliverable or unclaimed Distribution against the Debtors and their Estates, the Liquidating Debtors, the Plan Administrator, and their respective agents, attorneys, representatives, employees or independent contractors, and/or any of its or their
property. In the case of undeliverable or unclaimed Distributions on account of Administrative Claims, Priority Tax Claims or Priority Non-Tax Claims, any Cash otherwise reserved for undeliverable or unclaimed Distributions shall revert to the
Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve. In the case of undeliverable or unclaimed Distributions on account of Allowed General Unsecured Claims, any Cash otherwise reserved for undeliverable or unclaimed Distributions shall revert to the Disputed
Claims Reserve, and all title to and all beneficial interests in the Available Cash represented by any such undeliverable Distributions shall revert to and/or remain in the Liquidating Debtors and shall be distributed in accordance with the Plan.
The reversion of such Cash to the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve or the Disputed Claims Reserve, as applicable, shall be free of any restrictions thereon and notwithstanding any federal or state escheat laws to the contrary and shall be
treated in accordance with the terms of this Plan. Nothing contained in this Plan or the Plan Administrator Agreement shall require the Debtors, the Liquidating Debtors, the Plan Administrator, or any Disbursing Agent to attempt to locate any Holder
of an Allowed Claim.
36
This Section 6.3(b) is not applicable to the 2016 Notes Trustee or the holders of the
2016 Notes.
Except as otherwise provided in this Plan or in the Confirmation Order, the
Debtors or the Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors, as applicable, shall have the right to prepay, without penalty, all or any portion of an Allowed Administrative Claim, Allowed Priority Tax Claim, Allowed Priority Non-Tax
Claim or Allowed Secured Claim at any time.
|
6.5 |
Means of Cash Payment |
Cash payments made pursuant to this Plan shall be in U.S.
dollars and shall be made at the option and in the sole discretion of the Disbursing Agent by (i) checks drawn on or (ii) wire transfers from a domestic bank selected by the Disbursing Agent. In the case of foreign creditors, Cash payments
may be made, at the option of the Disbursing Agent, in such funds and by such means as are necessary or customary in a particular jurisdiction.
Unless otherwise specifically provided for in this Plan or the
Confirmation Order, or required by applicable bankruptcy law, postpetition interest shall not accrue or be paid on any Claims, and no Claimholder shall be entitled to interest accruing on or after the Petition Date on any Claim. Interest shall not
accrue or be paid upon any Disputed Claim in respect of the period from the Petition Date to the date a final Distribution is made thereon if and after such Disputed Claim becomes an Allowed Claim.
|
6.7 |
Withholding and Reporting Requirements |
In connection with the Plan and all
Distributions thereunder, the Disbursing Agent or the Plan Administrator, as applicable, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors, is authorized to take any and all actions that may be necessary or appropriate to comply with all withholding, payment and
reporting requirements imposed by any federal, state, local or foreign taxing authority, and all Allowed Claims and Distributions hereunder shall be subject to any such withholding and reporting requirements. The Disbursing Agent or the Plan
Administrator, as applicable, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors, shall be authorized to take any and all actions that may be necessary or appropriate to comply with such withholding, payment and reporting requirements. All Holders of Claims shall
be required to provide any information necessary to allow the Plan administrator to comply with all withholding, payment and reporting requirements with respect to such Taxes. The Disbursing Agent or the Plan Administrator shall withhold the full
amount required by law on any Distribution on account of any Holder of an Allowed Claim that fails to timely provide to the Disbursing Agent or the Plan Administrator the required information.
Subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan Administrator Agreement, the
Debtors and/or the Plan Administrator may, but shall not be required to, set off against any Claim and the payments or other Distributions to be made under the Plan on account of the Claim, claims of
37
any nature whatsoever that the Debtors may have against the Holder thereof, provided that any such right of
setoff that is exercised shall be allocated, first, to the principal amount of the related Claim, and thereafter to any interest portion thereof, but neither the failure to do so nor the allowance of any Claim hereunder shall constitute a waiver or
release by the Debtors, the Liquidating Debtors or the Plan Administrator of any such claim that the Debtors may have against such Holder.
6.9 Procedure for Treating and Resolving Disputed, Contingent and/or Unliquidated Claims
(a) Objection Deadline; Prosecution of Objections
Except as set forth in the Plan with respect to Professional Fee Claims, all objections to Claims must be filed and served on the Holders of
such Claims by the Claims Objection Deadline, as the same may be extended by the Court. If an objection has not been filed to a Proof of Claim or the Schedules have not been amended with respect to a Claim that (i) was Scheduled by the Debtors
but (ii) was not Scheduled as contingent, unliquidated and/or disputed, by the Claims Objection Deadline, as the same may be extended by order of the Court, the Claim to which the Proof of Claim or Scheduled Claim relates shall be treated as an
Allowed Claim if such Claim has not been Allowed earlier. Notice of any motion for an order extending the Claims Objection Deadline shall be required to be given only to those persons or entities that have requested notice in the Chapter 11 Cases in
accordance with Bankruptcy Rule 2002.
Notwithstanding any requirements that may be imposed pursuant to Bankruptcy Rule 9019, on and after
the Effective Date, the Plan Administrator shall have the authority to: (1) file, withdraw or litigate to judgment objections to and requests for estimation of Claims; (2) settle or compromise any Disputed Claim without any further notice
to or action, order or approval by the Court, subject to the consent of the Oversight Committee for proposed settlements in the amount of $100,000.00 and above, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld; and (3) administer and adjust the
Claims register to reflect any such settlements or compromises without any further notice to or action, order or approval by the Court; provided, however, that the objection to and settlement of Professional Fee Claims shall not be
subject to this Section 6.9(a), but rather shall be governed by Section 9.1(a) of the Plan. In the event that any objection filed by the Debtors or the Committee remains pending as of the Effective Date, the Plan
Administrator shall be deemed substituted for the Debtors or the Committee, as applicable, as the objecting party.
The Plan Administrator
shall be entitled to assert all of the Debtors rights, claims, defenses, offsets, rights of recoupment, setoffs, rights of disallowance, subrogation, recharacterization and/or equitable subordination and counter-claims with respect to Claims.
(b) No Distributions Pending Allowance
Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan or the Plan Administrator Agreement, no payments or Distributions shall be made with respect
to all or any portion of a Disputed Claim unless and until all objections to such Disputed Claim have been settled or withdrawn or have been determined by Final Order, and the Disputed Claim, or some portion thereof, has become an Allowed Claim. To
the extent that a Claim is not a Disputed Claim but is held by a Holder
38
that is or may be liable to the Debtors or the Liquidating Debtors on account of a Cause of Action, no payments or Distributions shall be made with respect to all or any portion of such Claim
unless and until such Claim and liability have been settled or withdrawn or have been determined by Final Order of the Court or such other court having jurisdiction over the matter.
(c) Disputed Claims Reserve
On the Distribution Date and on each subsequent Periodic Distribution Date, the Plan Administrator shall withhold on a Pro Rata basis from
property that would otherwise be distributed to Holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims and Holders of General Unsecured Claims entitled to Distributions under the Plan on such date, in a separate Disputed Claims Reserve, such amounts or property as may
be necessary to equal one hundred percent (100%) of Distributions to which Holders of such Disputed General Unsecured Claims would be entitled under this Plan if such Disputed General Unsecured Claims were allowed in their Disputed Claim
Amounts. The Plan Administrator may request, if necessary, estimation for any Disputed General Unsecured Claim that is contingent or unliquidated, or for which the Plan Administrator determines to reserve less than the Face Amount. The Plan
Administrator shall withhold the applicable Disputed Claim Amounts with respect to such Claims based upon the estimated amount of each such Claim as estimated by the Court. If practicable, the Plan Administrator shall invest any Cash that is
withheld as the Disputed Claims Reserve in an appropriate manner to ensure the safety of the investment, in accordance with the Plan Administrator Agreement. Nothing in this Plan, the Disclosure Statement or the Plan Administrator Agreement shall be
deemed to entitle the Holder of a Disputed General Unsecured Claim to postpetition interest on such Claim.
(d) Distributions After Allowance or Disallowance
Payments and Distributions to Holders of Disputed Claims that ultimately become Allowed Claims shall be made in accordance with provisions of
the Plan that govern Distributions to Holders of 2016 Noteholder Claims and Allowed General Unsecured Claims and Holders of Allowed Administrative Claims, Allowed Priority Tax Claims and Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claims. The Plan Administrator shall
no longer reserve for and shall distribute to the Holders of Allowed Class 3 Claims and Allowed Class 4 Claims, on the next Periodic Distribution Date and pursuant to the Plan, their Pro Rata shares of the funds held in the Disputed Claims Reserve
on account of any Disputed General Unsecured Claim that becomes a Disallowed Claim.
(e) De Minimis Distributions
The Plan Administrator shall not be required to make any distributions to Holders of Allowed Claims (other than Priority Tax Claims or
Administrative Claims) aggregating less than fifty dollars ($50.00). Cash that otherwise would be payable under the Plan to Holders of Allowed General Unsecured Claims but for this Section 6.9(e) shall be available for Distributions to
Holders of Allowed Class 3 Claims and Allowed Class 4 Claims. Subject to Section 5.9(e), Cash that otherwise would be payable under the Plan to Holders of Administrative Claims, Priority Tax Claims and Priority Non-Tax Claims but for
this Section 6.9(e)
39
shall remain in the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve until such time as all such Claims are Allowed or Disallowed and the Allowed amounts of such Claims are paid.
(f) Fractional Dollars
Any other provision of this Plan notwithstanding, the Disbursing Agent shall not be required to make Distributions or payments of fractions of
dollars. Whenever any payment of a fraction of a dollar under this Plan would otherwise be called for, the actual payment shall reflect a rounding of such fraction to the nearest whole dollar (up or down), with half dollars being rounded down.
(g) Allocation of Plan Distributions Between Principal and Interest
To the extent that any Allowed Claim entitled to a Distribution under this Plan is composed of indebtedness and accrued but unpaid interest
thereon, such Distribution shall, for all income tax purposes, be allocated to the principal amount of the Claim first and then, to the extent the consideration exceeds the principal amount of the Claim, to the portion of such Claim representing
accrued but unpaid interest.
(h) Distribution Record Date
The Disbursing Agent shall have no obligation to recognize the transfer of or sale of any participation in any Allowed Claim that occurs after
the close of business on the Distribution Record Date. Instead, the Disbursing Agent shall be entitled to recognize and deal for all purposes under this Plan with only those record Holders stated on the official Claims register or the Debtors
Books and Records, as applicable, as of the close of business on the Distribution Record Date.
ARTICLE VII
TREATMENT OF EXECUTORY CONTRACTS AND UNEXPIRED LEASES
|
7.1 |
Rejected Contracts and Leases |
Except as otherwise provided in the Plan, the Sale
Order, or in any contract, instrument, release or other agreement or document entered into in connection with the Plan, each of the Executory Contracts and Unexpired Leases to which any Debtor is a party shall be deemed automatically rejected by the
applicable Debtor as of the Effective Date, unless such contract or lease (i) previously has been assumed or rejected by the Debtors, (ii) expired or terminated pursuant to its own terms, (iii) is the subject of a motion to assume or
reject pending before the Court as of the Confirmation Date or (iv) is identified on Exhibit B hereto as a contract to be assumed; provided, however, that nothing contained in this Plan shall constitute an admission by any
Debtor that any such contract or lease is an Executory Contract or Unexpired Lease or that any Debtor or its successors and assigns has any liability thereunder; and, provided further, that the Debtors reserve their right, at any time
before the Confirmation Date, to assume any Executory Contract or Unexpired Lease that was not already rejected prior to the Confirmation Date. The Confirmation Order shall constitute an order of the Court approving the rejections
40
described in this Section 7.1, pursuant to section 365 of the Bankruptcy Code, as of the Effective Date.
|
7.2 |
Rejection Damages Bar Date |
If the rejection of an Executory Contract or Unexpired
Lease pursuant to Section 7.1 above gives rise to a Claim by the other party or parties to such contract or lease, such Claim shall be forever barred and shall not be enforceable against the applicable Debtor or its Estate, the
Liquidating Debtors or their respective successors or properties unless a Proof of Claim is filed with the Court and served on counsel for the Plan Administrator within thirty (30) days after service of notice of entry of the Confirmation
Order.
|
7.3 |
Assumed Contracts and Leases |
Except as otherwise provided in the Confirmation Order,
this Plan, the Plan Administrator Agreement or any other document entered into after the Petition Date or in connection with this Plan, the Confirmation Order shall constitute an order under Bankruptcy Code section 365 assuming, as of the Effective
Date, those contracts listed on Exhibit B to this Plan; provided, however, that the Debtors may amend such Exhibit at any time prior to the Confirmation Date; provided further, however, that listing an
insurance agreement on such Exhibit shall not constitute an admission by a Debtor that such agreement is an executory contract or that any Debtor has any liability thereunder.
Any monetary amounts by which each executory contract and unexpired lease to be assumed pursuant to the Plan is in default, if any, shall be
satisfied, under section 365(b)(1) of the Bankruptcy Code, by Cure, with such Cure being provided by, at the option of the Liquidating Debtors or the Plan Administrator, either (x) Dendreon or (y) the assignee to whom such contract or
lease is being assigned. If there is a dispute regarding (a) the nature or amount of any Cure, (b) the ability of Dendreon or any assignee to provide adequate assurance of future performance (within the meaning of section 365
of the Bankruptcy Code) under the contract or lease to be assumed, or (c) any other matter pertaining to assumption, Cure shall occur following the entry of a Final Order resolving the dispute and approving the assumption or assumption and
assignment, as the case may be; provided that if there is a dispute as to the amount of Cure that cannot be resolved consensually among the parties, the Liquidating Debtors or the Plan Administrator shall have the right to reject the
contract or lease for a period of five (5) days after entry of a Final Order establishing a Cure amount in excess of that provided by the Debtors. The Confirmation Order, if applicable, shall contain provisions providing for notices of proposed
assumptions and proposed cure amounts to be sent to applicable third parties and for procedures for objecting thereto (which shall provide not less than twenty (20) days notice of such procedures and any deadlines pursuant thereto) and
resolution of disputes by the Court.
|
7.4 |
Indemnification Obligations |
Any obligations of the Debtors pursuant to their corporate
charters and bylaws or agreements, including amendments, entered into any time prior to the Effective Date, to indemnify, reimburse or limit the liability of any Person pursuant to the Debtors certificates of incorporation, bylaws, policy of
providing employee indemnification, applicable state law or
41
specific agreement in respect of any claims, demands, suits, causes of action or proceedings against such Persons based upon any act or omission related to such Persons service with, for or
on behalf of the Debtors prior to the Effective Date with respect to all present and future actions, suits and proceedings relating to the Debtors shall survive confirmation of the Plan and except as set forth herein, remain unaffected thereby, and
shall not be discharged, irrespective of whether such defense, indemnification, reimbursement or limitation of liability accrued or is owed in connection with an occurrence before or after the Petition Date; provided, however, that all
obligations under this Section 7.4 shall be limited solely to available insurance coverage and neither the Liquidating Debtors, the Plan Administrator nor any of their assets shall be liable for any such obligations. Any Claim based on
the Debtors obligations set forth in this Section 7.4 shall not be a Disputed Claim or subject to any objection in either case by reason of section 502(e)(1)(B) of the Bankruptcy Code. This provision for indemnification obligations
shall not apply to or cover any Claims, suits or actions against a Person that result in a final order determining that such Covered Person is liable for fraud, willful misconduct, gross negligence, bad faith, self-dealing or breach of the duty of
loyalty.
ARTICLE VIII
CONDITIONS PRECEDENT TO CONFIRMATION
AND CONSUMMATION OF THE PLAN
|
8.1 |
Conditions to Confirmation |
The following are conditions precedent to confirmation of
the Plan, each of which must be satisfied or waived in accordance with Section 8.3 of the Plan:
(a) the Confirmation Order shall be in form and substance reasonably acceptable to the Debtors, the Committee, the
Unaffiliated Noteholders and the Deerfield Noteholders and shall, among other things:
(i) provide
that the Debtors are authorized and directed to take all actions necessary or appropriate to enter into, implement and consummate the agreements or documents created under or in connection with the Plan; and
(ii) provide that, notwithstanding Bankruptcy Rule 3020(e), the Confirmation Order shall be
immediately effective, subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan; and
(b) The amounts of the Administrative
and Priority Claims Estimate, the Disputed Claims Estimate, the Wind-down Reserve, the Professional Fee Estimate, and the Wind-down Budget shall be reasonably acceptable to the Committee, the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders and the
Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders.
(c) The Plan Administrator Agreement shall be in form and
substance reasonably acceptable to the Committee, the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders, and the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders; and
42
(d) the Confirmation Order shall have been entered by the Court.
|
8.2 |
Conditions to Effective Date |
The following are conditions precedent to the occurrence
of the Effective Date, each of which must be satisfied or waived in accordance with Section 8.3 of the Plan:
(a) the Confirmation Order shall not then be stayed pending appeal, vacated or reversed and shall not have been
amended without the agreement of the Debtors, the Committee, the Unaffiliated Noteholders and the Deerfield Noteholders;
(b) the Professional Fee Reserve, the Administrative and Priority Claims Reserve and the Disputed Claims Reserve shall
have been funded in Cash in full and the Wind-down Reserve shall have been funded with the amount agreed pursuant to Section 5.9(d) of the Plan;
(c) the Plan Administrator shall have been appointed and assumed its rights and responsibilities under the Plan and
the Plan Administrator Agreement, as applicable;
(d) the Debtors shall have retained and pre-paid appropriate
professionals for the preparation of the Debtors tax returns for 2014 and 2015;
(e) all actions, documents
and agreements necessary to implement the provisions of the Plan to be effectuated on or prior to the Effective Date shall be reasonably satisfactory to the Debtors, the Committee, the Unaffiliated Noteholders and the Deerfield Noteholders, and such
actions, documents and agreements shall have been effected or executed and delivered. The Plan Administrator Agreement shall be completed and in final form and, as applicable, executed by the parties thereto and all conditions precedent contained in
any of the foregoing shall have been satisfied or waived; and
(f) the Debtors shall have received the Valeant
Shares.
Each of the conditions to the Effective Date set forth in
Section 8.2 of the Plan may be waived in whole or in part by the Debtors without any other notice to parties in interest or the Court, provided that the Debtors have received the consent of the Committee, the Deerfield
Requisite Supporting Noteholders, and the Unaffiliated Requisite Supporting Noteholders, which consent shall not unreasonably be withheld, provided further that it shall be deemed reasonable to withhold consent if the Debtors are not
in receipt of the Valeant Shares. The failure of any party to exercise any of its foregoing rights shall not be deemed a waiver of any of its other rights, and each such right shall be deemed an ongoing right that may be asserted thereby at any
time.
|
8.4 |
Consequences of Non-Occurrence of Effective Date |
If the Effective Date does not occur
within 180 days of the Confirmation Date, or by such date, after notice and a hearing, as approved by the Court, (a) the Plan shall be null and void in
43
all respects; (b) any settlement of claims shall be null and void without further order of the Court; and (c) the time within which the Debtors may assume and assign or reject all
Executory Contracts shall be extended for a period of thirty (30) days after such motion is granted.
ARTICLE IX
ALLOWANCE AND PAYMENT OF CERTAIN ADMINISTRATIVE CLAIMS
|
9.1 |
Professional Fee Claims |
(a) Final Fee Applications
All final requests for payment of Professional Fee Claims (the Final Fee Applications) must be filed no later than
forty-five (45) days after the Effective Date. Objections, if any, to Final Fee Applications of such Professionals must be filed and served on the Liquidating Debtors, the Plan Administrator, counsel to the Deerfield Noteholders, counsel to the
Unaffiliated Noteholders, the requesting Professional and the Office of the United States Trustee no later than twenty (20) days from the date on which each such Final Fee Application is served and filed. After notice and a hearing in
accordance with the procedures established by the Bankruptcy Code and prior orders of the Court, the Allowed amounts of such Professional Fee Claims shall be determined by the Court.
(b) Employment of Professionals after the Effective Date
From and after the Effective Date, any requirement that professionals comply with sections 327 through 331 of the Bankruptcy Code or any order
previously entered by the Court in seeking retention or compensation for services rendered or expenses incurred after such date shall terminate.
9.2 Substantial Contribution Compensation and Expenses Bar Date
Any Person who wishes to make a Substantial Contribution Claim based on facts or circumstances arising after the Petition Date must file an
application with the clerk of the Court, on or before the Administrative Claims Bar Date, and serve such application on the Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator and as otherwise required by the Court and the Bankruptcy Code on or before
the Administrative Claims Bar Date, or be forever barred from seeking such compensation or expense reimbursement. Objections, if any, to the Substantial Contribution Claim must be filed no later than the Claims Objection Deadline, unless otherwise
extended by Order of the Court. For the avoidance of doubt, this Section 9.2 shall not apply to the Committee Member Substantial Contribution Claim and the Deerfield Substantial Contribution Claim.
9.3 Other Administrative Claims
All other requests for payment of an Administrative Claim arising after the Petition Date, other than Professional Fee Claims and Claims
arising under section 503(b)(9) of the Bankruptcy Code, must be filed with the Court and served on the Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator no later than the Administrative Claims Bar Date. Unless the Plan Administrator or any other party
in interest objects to an Administrative Claim by the Claims Objection
44
Deadline, such Administrative Claim shall be deemed Allowed in the amount requested. In the event that the Plan Administrator or any other party in interest objects to an Administrative Claim,
the Court shall determine the Allowed amount of such Administrative Claim.
ARTICLE X
EFFECTS OF CONFIRMATION
10.1 Satisfaction of Claims
Distributions made under the Plan on account of Claims or Interests shall satisfy the obligations of the Debtors and the Liquidating Debtors,
as adjusted by the Plan, in respect of such Claims or Interests. The entry of the Confirmation Order shall constitute the Courts approval of such treatment and satisfaction of all such Claims and Interests, as well as a finding by the Court
that such treatment and satisfaction is in the best interests of the Debtors, their Estates and Holders of Claims and Interests and is fair, equitable and reasonable.
10.2 Binding Effect
The Plan shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the Debtors, all present and former Holders of Claims and Interests, whether or not
such Holders shall receive or retain any property or interest in property under the Plan, and their respective successors and assigns, including, but not limited to, the Liquidating Debtors and the Plan Administrator and all other parties in
interest in the Chapter 11 Cases.
10.3 Effects of Confirmation
No Claimholder or Interest Holder may, on account of a Claim or Interest, seek or receive any payment or other Distribution from, or seek
recourse against, any Debtor or its respective successors, assigns and/or property, except as expressly provided in this Plan.
10.4 Releases
(a) Releases by the Debtors
Pursuant to section 1123(b) of the Bankruptcy Code, to the fullest extent permissible under applicable law, and except as otherwise
specifically provided in the Plan, upon the Effective Date, each of the Debtors shall release unconditionally, and hereby is deemed to forever release unconditionally (i) the Committee and, solely in their respective capacities as members or
representatives of the Committee, (and not as individual lenders or creditors to or on behalf of the Debtors), each member of the Committee; (ii) the Released Parties; (iii) each of the respective agents, advisors, accountants, investment
bankers, consultants, attorneys and other representatives of any of the foregoing or of the Debtors, solely in their respective capacities as such; and (iv) all individuals serving, or who have served, since the Petition Date, as a director or
officer of the Debtors, from any and all claims, obligations, suits, judgments, damages, rights, causes of action and liabilities whatsoever (other than the right to enforce the performance of their respective obligations, if any, to the Debtors or
the Liquidating Debtors under the Plan, the Plan Administrator Agreement
45
and the contracts, instruments, releases and other agreements delivered under the Plan and the Plan Administrator Agreement), whether liquidated or unliquidated, fixed or contingent, matured or
unmatured, known or unknown, foreseen or unforeseen, then existing or thereafter arising, in law, equity or otherwise that are based in whole or in part on any act or omission, transaction, event or other occurrence taking place on or prior to the
Effective Date in any way relating to the Debtors, the Chapter 11 Cases, the Plan or the Disclosure Statement, other than Claims or liabilities arising out of or relating to any act or omission that constitutes a failure to perform the duty to act
in good faith and where such failure to perform constitutes willful misconduct, gross negligence, or fraud.
(b) Release by Holders of Claims
Except as otherwise specifically provided in the Plan and to the fullest extent permissible under applicable law, on the Effective Date,
the Released Parties and each Holder of a Claim (excluding any of the Debtors), including each Claimholder deemed to accept the Plan pursuant to section 1126(f) of the Bankruptcy Code, shall release unconditionally, and hereby is deemed to forever
release unconditionally (i) the Released Parties, (ii) the Committee, (iii) each of their respective agents, advisors, accountants, investment bankers, consultants, attorneys and other representatives, solely in their respective
capacities as such, and only with respect to their activities and conduct during or in connection with the Chapter 11 Cases, (iv) all individuals serving, or who have served, since the Petition Date, as a manager, director, managing member,
officer, partner, agent, employee, attorney or other advisor of the Debtors and (v) any successors or assigns of the foregoing, from any and all claims, obligations, suits, judgments, damages, rights, causes of action and liabilities whatsoever
(other than the right to enforce the performance of their respective obligations, if any, to the Debtors under the Plan, the Plan Administrator Agreement and the contracts, instruments, releases and other agreements delivered under the Plan and the
Plan Administrator Agreement), whether liquidated or unliquidated, fixed or contingent, matured or unmatured, known or unknown, foreseen or unforeseen, then existing or thereafter arising, in law, equity or otherwise, whether or not by or in the
right of any of the Debtors, that are based in whole or in part on any act or omission, transaction, event or other occurrence taking place on or prior to the Effective Date in any way relating to the Debtors, the Chapter 11 Cases, the Plan or the
Disclosure Statement other than Claims or liabilities arising out of or relating to any act or omission that constitutes a failure to perform the duty to act in good faith and where such failure to perform constitutes willful misconduct, gross
negligence, or fraud; provided, that this subsection shall not release any Person from any Claim or cause of action existing as of the Effective Date, based on (x) the Internal Revenue Code or any other domestic state, city or
municipal tax code, (y) the environmental laws of the United States or any domestic state, city or municipality or (z) any criminal laws of the United States or any domestic state, city or municipality. Notwithstanding anything to the
contrary in this Section 10.4(b), a Holder of a Claim (other than a Released Party) shall be deemed not to provide the releases in this section if such Holder (i) votes to reject the Plan and (ii) opts out of the
releases provided in Section 10.4(b) of the Plan in a timely submitted, valid Ballot. For the avoidance of doubt, each Released Party that is the Holder of a Claim shall be deemed to have given the releases in this
Section 10.4(b).
46
|
10.5 |
Exculpation and Limitation of Liability |
Except as otherwise specifically
provided in the Plan, to the maximum extent permitted by the Bankruptcy Code and applicable law, none of (i) the Debtors, (ii) the Liquidating Debtors, (iii) the Plan Administrator, (iv) the Committee, (v) the Supporting
Noteholders, nor (vi) any of their respective members, officers, directors, shareholders, employees, advisors, attorneys or agents acting in such capacity on or after the Petition Date, shall have or incur any liability to, or be subject to any
right of action by, any Holder of a Claim or an Interest, or (with respect to such Claims or Interests) any of their respective agents, affiliates, or any of their successors or assigns, for any act or omission in connection with, relating to, or
arising out of, the Debtors Chapter 11 Cases, the pursuit of confirmation of the Plan, the consummation of the Plan or the administration of the Plan or the property to be distributed under the Plan, except for their
willful misconduct or gross negligence, and in all respects shall be entitled to rely reasonably upon the advice of counsel with respect to their duties and responsibilities under the Plan.
Except as otherwise expressly provided in the Plan, the Plan
Supplement or related documents, or for obligations issued pursuant to the Plan, all Persons who have held, hold or may hold Claims against or Interests in the Debtors are permanently enjoined, from and after the Effective Date, from taking any of
the following actions against any of the Estate(s), the Plan Administrator, any of the property of the foregoing, the property of the Liquidating Debtors, or any successors or assigns of the foregoing on account of any such Claims or Interests:
(A) commencing or continuing, in any manner or in any place, any action or other proceeding; (B) enforcing, attaching, collecting or recovering in any manner any judgment, award, decree or order; (C) creating, perfecting or enforcing
any lien or encumbrance; (D) asserting a setoff or right of subrogation of any kind against any debt, liability or obligation due to the Debtors; and (E) commencing or continuing, in any manner or in any place, any action that does not
comply with or is inconsistent with the provisions of the Plan. By accepting Distributions pursuant to the Plan, each Holder of an Allowed Claim receiving any Distribution pursuant to the Plan will be deemed to have specifically consented to the
injunctions set forth in this Section 10.6.
The releases pursuant to Article X of this Plan shall also act as a
permanent injunction against any party that has provided such releases from commencing or continuing any action, employment of process, or act to collect, offset, or recover any Claim released under this Plan to the fullest extent authorized by
applicable law.
|
10.7 |
Satisfaction of Subordination Rights |
All Claims against the Debtors and all rights and
claims between or among Claimholders relating in any manner whatsoever to Distributions on account of Claims against the Debtors based upon any subordination rights, whether asserted or unasserted, legal or equitable, shall be deemed satisfied by
the Distributions under the Plan to Claimholders having such subordination rights, and such subordination rights shall be deemed waived, released, discharged and terminated as of the Effective Date. Distributions to the various Classes of Claims
hereunder
47
shall not be subject to levy, garnishment, attachment or like legal process by any Claimholder by reason of any subordination rights or otherwise, so that each Claimholder shall have and receive
the benefit of the Distributions in the manner set forth in the Plan.
ARTICLE XI
RETENTION OF JURISDICTION
|
11.1 |
Retention of Jurisdiction by the Court |
Under sections 105(a) and 1142 of the
Bankruptcy Code, and notwithstanding entry of the Confirmation Order, substantial consummation of the Plan and occurrence of the Effective Date, the Court shall retain exclusive jurisdiction over all matters arising out of, and related to, the
Chapter 11 Cases, the Plan, and the Plan Administrator Agreement to the fullest extent permitted by law, including, among other things, jurisdiction to:
(a) To the extent not otherwise determined by the Plan, determine (i) the allowance, classification or priority
of Claims upon objection by any party in interest entitled to file an objection, or (ii) the validity, extent, priority and nonavoidability of consensual and nonconsensual Liens and other encumbrances against assets of the Estates, Causes of
Action, or property of the Estates or the Liquidating Debtors;
(b) Issue injunctions or take such other actions
or make such other orders as may be necessary or appropriate to restrain interference with the Plan or its execution or implementation by any Entity or Person, construe and to take any other action to enforce and execute the Plan, the Confirmation
Order or any other order of the Court, issue such orders as may be necessary for the implementation, execution, performance and consummation of the Plan and all matters referred to herein, and determine all matters that may be pending before the
Court in the Chapter 11 Cases on or before the Effective Date with respect to any Entity or Person;
(c) Protect
the assets or property of the Estates and/or the Liquidating Debtors, including Causes of Action, from claims against, or interference with, such assets or property, including actions to quiet or otherwise clear title to such property or to resolve
any dispute concerning Liens or other encumbrances on any assets of the Estates;
(d) Determine any and all
applications for allowance of Professional Fee Claims;
(e) Determine any Priority Tax Claims, Priority Non-Tax
Claims or Administrative Claims, entitled to priority under section 507(a) of the Bankruptcy Code;
(f) Resolve
any dispute arising under or related to the implementation, execution, consummation or interpretation of the Plan and the making of Distributions hereunder;
(g) Determine any and all motions related to the rejection, assumption or assignment of Executory Contracts or
Unexpired Leases or determine any issues arising from
48
the deemed rejection of Executory Contracts and Unexpired Leases set forth in Article VII of the Plan;
(h) Except as otherwise provided herein, determine all applications, motions, adversary proceedings, contested
matters, actions and any other litigated matters instituted in and prior to the closing of the Chapter 11 Cases, including any remands;
(i) Enter a Final Order closing each of the Chapter 11 Cases;
(j) Modify the Plan under section 1127 of the Bankruptcy Code, remedy any defect, cure any omission or reconcile any
inconsistency in the Plan or the Confirmation Order so as to carry out their intent and purposes;
(k) Issue such
orders in aid of consummation of the Plan and the Confirmation Order notwithstanding any otherwise applicable non-bankruptcy law, with respect to any Entity or Person, to the full extent authorized by the Bankruptcy Code;
(l) Determine any Tax liability pursuant to section 505 of the Bankruptcy Code;
(m) Enter and implement such orders as may be appropriate in the event the Confirmation Order is for any reason
stayed, revoked, modified or vacated;
(n) Resolve any disputes concerning whether an Entity or Person had
sufficient notice of the Chapter 11 Cases, the applicable Bar Date, the hearing to consider approval of the Disclosure Statement or the Confirmation Hearing or for any other purpose;
(o) Resolve any dispute or matter arising under or in connection with any order of the Court entered in the Chapter 11
Cases;
(p) Authorize, as may be necessary or appropriate, sales of assets as necessary or desirable and resolve
objections, if any, to such sales;
(q) Resolve any disputes concerning any release, injunction, exculpation or
other waiver or protection provided in the Plan;
(r) Approve, if necessary, any Distributions, or objections
thereto, under the Plan;
(s) Approve, as may be necessary or appropriate, any Claims settlement entered into or
offset exercised by the Plan Administrator;
(t) Resolve any dispute or matter arising under or in connection with
the Liquidating Debtors or the Plan Administrator;
(u) Order the production of documents, disclosures or
information, or to appear for deposition demanded pursuant to Bankruptcy Rule 2004; and
49
(v) Determine such other matters, and for such other purposes, as may be
provided in the Confirmation Order or as may be authorized under provisions of the Bankruptcy Code.
|
11.2 |
Retention of Non-Exclusive Jurisdiction by the Court |
Notwithstanding anything else in
the Plan, the Court shall retain non-exclusive jurisdiction over all Causes of Action prosecuted by the Plan Administrator on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors.
|
11.3 |
Failure of Court to Exercise Jurisdiction |
If the Court abstains from exercising, or
declines to exercise, jurisdiction or is otherwise without jurisdiction over any matter arising in, arising under, or related to the Chapter 11 Cases, including the matters set forth in Section 11.1 of the Plan, the provisions of this
Article XI shall have no effect upon and shall not control, prohibit or limit the exercise of jurisdiction by any other court having jurisdiction with respect to such matter.
ARTICLE XII
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS
|
12.1 |
Modifications and Amendments |
The Debtors may alter, amend or modify the Plan or any
Exhibits thereto under section 1127(a) of the Bankruptcy Code at any time prior to the Confirmation Date provided that the Debtors have received the prior consent of the Committee, the Deerfield Requisite Supporting Noteholders, and the Unaffiliated
Requisite Supporting Noteholders which consent shall not unreasonably be withheld. After the Confirmation Date and prior to substantial consummation of the Plan as defined in section 1101(2) of the Bankruptcy Code, the Debtors may, under section
1127(b) of the Bankruptcy Code, institute proceedings in the Court to remedy any defect or omission or reconcile any inconsistencies in the Plan, the Disclosure Statement or the Confirmation Order, and such matters as may be necessary to carry out
the purpose and effect of the Plan so long as such proceedings do not adversely affect the treatment of Holders of Claims under the Plan; provided, however, that prior notice of such proceedings shall be served in accordance with the
Bankruptcy Rules or order of the Court.
|
12.2 |
Severability of Plan Provisions |
If, prior to Confirmation, any term or provision of
the Plan is held by the Court to be invalid, void or unenforceable, then the Court, at the request of the Debtors, shall have the power to alter and interpret such term or provision to make it valid or enforceable to the maximum extent practicable,
consistent with the original purpose of the term or provision held to be invalid, void or unenforceable, and such term or provision shall then be applicable as altered or interpreted. Notwithstanding any such holding, alteration or interpretation,
the remainder of the terms and provisions of the Plan shall remain in full force and effect and shall in no way be affected, impaired or invalidated by such holding, alteration or interpretation. The Confirmation Order shall constitute a judicial
determination and shall provide that each term and provision of
50
the Plan, as it may have been altered or interpreted in accordance with the foregoing, is valid and enforceable pursuant to its terms.
|
12.3 |
Successors and Assigns |
The rights, benefits and obligations of any Person named or
referred to in the Plan shall be binding on, and shall inure to the benefit of, any heir, executor, administrator, successor or assign of that Person.
|
12.4 |
Payment of Statutory Fees |
All fees payable through the Effective Date pursuant to 28
U.S.C. § 1930 shall be paid on the Effective Date. The Debtors, prior to the Effective Date, and the Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors, from and after the Effective Date, shall pay U.S. Trustee Fees in accordance with 28
U.S.C. § 1930 until the Chapter 11 Cases are closed or converted and/or the entry of final decrees. In addition, the Plan Administrator shall file post-confirmation quarterly reports or any pre-confirmation monthly operating reports not filed
as of the Confirmation Hearing in conformance with the U.S. Trustee Guidelines. The U.S. Trustee shall not be required to file a request for payment of its quarterly fees.
|
12.5 |
Revocation, Withdrawal or Non-Consummation |
The Debtors reserve the right to revoke or
withdraw the Plan as to any or all of the Debtors prior to the Confirmation Date and to file subsequent plans. If the Debtors revoke or withdraw the Plan as to any or all of the Debtors, or if Confirmation or consummation of the Plan as to any or
all of the Debtors does not occur, then, with respect to such Debtors, (a) the Plan shall be null and void in all respects, (b) any settlement or compromise embodied in the Plan (including the fixing or limiting to an amount certain any
Claim or Class of Claims), assumption or rejection of executory contracts or leases effected by the Plan, and any document or agreement executed pursuant to the Plan, shall be deemed null and void, and (c) nothing contained in the Plan, and no
acts taken in preparation for consummation of the Plan, shall (i) constitute or be deemed to constitute a waiver or release of any Claims by or against, or any Interests in, such Debtors or any other Person, (ii) prejudice in any manner
the rights of such Debtors or any other Person or (iii) constitute an admission of any sort by such Debtors or any other Person.
The Debtors or the Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating
Debtors, may cancel, terminate, or surrender any insurance policies in accordance with the terms thereof and the applicable insurer is authorized to accept such cancelation, termination, or surrender of any such policy. Any insurer is authorized to
pay, and the Debtors or the Plan Administrator, on behalf of the Liquidating Debtors, may collect any proceeds of such cancellation, termination or surrender.
|
12.7 |
Service of Documents |
Any notice, request or demand required or permitted to be made or
provided to or upon a Debtor, a Liquidating Debtor, the Committee, or the Plan Administrator shall be (a) in writing,
51
(b) served by (i) certified mail, return receipt requested, (ii) hand delivery, (iii) overnight delivery service, or (iv) facsimile transmission, (c) deemed to have
been duly given or made when actually delivered or, in the case of notice by facsimile transmission, when received and telephonically confirmed and (d) addressed as follows:
The Debtors:
Dendreon
Corporation
601 Union Street
Suite 4900
Seattle, WA 98101
Attn: Rob Crotty, Esq.
Title: General Counsel and Secretary
Telephone: (888) 369-8915
with a copy to:
Ken Ziman,
Esq.
Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meager & Flom LLP
Four Times Square
New York,
New York 10036-6522
Telephone: (212) 735-3000
Fax: (212) 735-2000
with
a copy to:
Felicia Gerber Perlman, Esq.
Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meager & Flom LLP
155 N. Wacker Dr.
Chicago, IL
60606-1720
Telephone: (312) 407-0700
Fax: (312) 407-0411
The
Liquidating Debtors:
Dendreon Corporation
601 Union Street
Suite 4900
Seattle, WA 98101
Attn:
Rob Crotty, Esq.
Title: General Counsel and Secretary
Telephone: (888) 369-8915
52
Committee:
c/o Michael Torkin, Esq.
Mark
Schneiderman, Esq.
Sullivan & Cromwell LLP
125 Broad Street
New York, New
York 10004
Telephone: (212) 558-4000
Facsimile: (212) 558-3588
Deerfield Noteholders:
c/o
John C. Longmire, Esq.
Willkie Farr & Gallagher LLP
787 Seventh Avenue
New York,
New York 10019
Telephone: (212) 728-8000
Facsimile: (212) 728-8111
Unaffiliated Noteholders:
c/o Steven D. Pohl, Esq.
Brown Rudnick LLP
One
Financial Center
Boston, Massachusetts 02111
Telephone: (617) 856-8200
Facsimile: (617) 856-8201
and
c/o John
Storz, Esq.
Seven Times Square
New York, NY 10036
Telephone:
(212) 209-4800
Facsimile: (212) 209-4801
Plan Administrator:
Name
Address
Telephone:
Facsimile:
Exhibits to the Plan not attached hereto shall be filed in one or
more Plan Supplements by the
53
Plan Supplement Filing Date. Any Plan Supplement (and amendments thereto) filed by the Debtors shall be deemed an integral part of the Plan and shall be incorporated by reference as if fully set
forth herein. Substantially contemporaneously with their filing, the Plan Supplements may be viewed at the Debtors case website (https://cases.primeclerk.com/dendreon/) or the Courts website (http://www.deb.uscourts.gov).
Copies of case pleadings, including the Plan Supplements, also may be examined between the hours of 8:00 a.m. and 4:00 p.m., Monday through Friday, excluding federal holidays, at the Office of the Clerk of the Court, 824 N. Market St., 3rd Floor,
Wilmington, Delaware 19801. Finally, copies of case pleadings also may be obtained by written request to the Claims Agent, at dendreoninfo@primeclerk.com. The documents contained in any Plan Supplements shall be approved by the Court pursuant
to the Confirmation Order.
54
|
|
|
Dated: |
|
Wilmington, Delaware |
April 16, 2015 |
|
|
|
DENDREON CORPORATION, et al.,
Debtors and Debtors-in-Possession |
|
|
By: |
|
/s/ Robert L. Crotty |
Name: Robert L. Crotty |
Title: President, General Counsel and Secretary |
|
SKADDEN, ARPS, SLATE, MEAGHER
& FLOM LLP |
|
|
By: |
|
/s/ Sarah E. Pierce |
Anthony W. Clark (I.D. No. 2051) |
Sarah E. Pierce (I.D. No. 4648) |
One Rodney Square |
P.O. Box 636 |
Wilmington, Delaware 19899-0636 |
Telephone: (302) 651-3000 |
Fax: (302) 651-3001 |
|
- and - |
|
Kenneth S. Ziman |
Raquelle L. Kaye |
Four Times Square |
New York, New York 10036-6522 |
Telephone: (212) 735-3000 |
Fax: (212) 735-2000 |
|
- and - |
|
Felicia Gerber Perlman |
155 N. Wacker Drive |
Chicago, Illinois 60606-1720 |
Telephone: (312) 407-0700 |
Fax: (312) 407-0411 |
|
Counsel for Debtors and Debtors in Possession |
1
IN THE UNITED STATES BANKRUPTCY COURT
FOR THE DISTRICT OF DELAWARE
|
|
|
|
|
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - |
|
x |
|
|
In re:
DENDREON CORPORATION, et al.,
Debtors.1 |
|
:
: :
: :
: :
: |
|
Chapter 11
Case No. 14-12515 (LSS)
Jointly Administered |
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - |
|
x |
|
|
PLAN SUPPLEMENT TO FIRST AMENDED PLAN OF LIQUIDATION PURSUANT
TO CHAPTER 11 OF THE BANKRUPTCY CODE PROPOSED BY THE DEBTORS
|
|
|
|
|
SKADDEN, ARPS, SLATE, MEAGHER & FLOM LLP |
Anthony W. Clark (I.D. No. 2051)
Sarah E. Pierce (I.D. No. 4648)
One Rodney Square
P.O. Box 636
Wilmington, DE 19899
Telephone: (302) 651-3000
Fax: (302) 651-3001 |
|
Kenneth S. Ziman Raquelle L. Kaye
Four Times Square New York, NY 10036
Telephone: (212) 735-3000 Fax: (212) 735-2000 |
|
Felicia Gerber Perlman Candice Korkis
155 N. Wacker Dr. Chicago, IL 60606
Telephone: (312) 407-0700 Fax: (312) 407-0411 |
Counsel for Debtors and Debtors in Possession
Dated: [], 2015
1 |
The Debtors and the last four digits of their respective taxpayer identification numbers are as follows: Dendreon Corporation (3193), Dendreon Holdings, LLC (8047), Dendreon Distribution, LLC (8598) and Dendreon
Manufacturing, LLC (7123). The address of the Debtors corporate headquarters is 601 Union Street, Suite 4900, Seattle, Washington 98101. |
1
TABLE OF EXHIBITS
|
|
|
Exhibit |
|
Title |
A |
|
Plan Administrator Agreement |
B |
|
Contracts To Be Assumed Under Plan |
C |
|
Non-Exclusive List of Retained Claims and Causes of Action |
THE DEBTORS RESERVE THE RIGHT TO REVISE THIS
PLAN SUPPLEMENT AT ANY TIME PRIOR TO THE HEARING
ON CONFIRMATION OF THE DEBTORS PLAN OF LIQUIDATION
1
EXHIBIT A
Plan Administrator Agreement
EXHIBIT B
Contracts To Be Assumed Under Plan3
The Debtors will assume under the Plan any and all insurance policies maintained by the Debtors that have not expired or terminated pursuant to their own
terms on or before the Effective Date of the Debtors plan of liquidation, including but not limited to policies issued by [] or their respective affiliates providing directors and officers
insurance coverage, products liability insurance coverage, fiduciary liability insurance coverage or employment practices liability insurance coverage.
3 |
The inclusion by the Debtors of an agreement on this Exhibit B does not constitute an admission by the Debtors that such agreement is an executory contract or unexpired lease. |
EXHIBIT C
Non-Exclusive List of Retained Claims and Causes of Action
The following is a non-exclusive list of potential or actual parties against whom the Debtors could assert or have asserted a claim or cause of action, which
claims and causes of action are being retained by the Debtors under the Plan and pursuant to the authority of Bankruptcy Code section 1123(b)(3)(B). Capitalized terms not defined herein are used as defined in the Plan of Liquidation Pursuant to
Chapter 11 of the Bankruptcy Code Proposed by the Debtors to which this Exhibit C is attached. The Debtors reserve their rights to modify this list to amend parties or otherwise update this list, but disclaim any obligation to do so. In
addition to possible causes of action and claims against the persons or entities listed herein, the Debtors may have, in the ordinary course of business, causes of action, claims, or rights against vendors or others with whom they deal in the
ordinary course of business (Ordinary Course Claims) to the extent such causes of action, claims or rights have not been assigned to a third party. The Plan Administrator reserves its right to enforce, sue on, settle or compromise
(or decline to do any of the foregoing) the Ordinary Course Claims and all other claims and causes of action of the Debtors and the Estates, including but not limited to the specific claims and causes of action described below, subject to any
release, exculpations and/or indemnifications in the Plan and/or the Sale Order:
Exhibit 99.3
IN THE UNITED STATES BANKRUPTCY COURT
FOR THE DISTRICT OF DELAWARE
|
|
|
|
|
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - |
|
x |
|
|
In re:
DENDREON CORPORATION, et al.,
Debtors.1 |
|
:
: :
: :
: :
: :
: |
|
Chapter 11
Case No. 14-12515 (LSS)
Jointly Administered |
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - |
|
x |
|
|
ORDER (A) APPROVING THE FORM AND MANNER OF
NOTICE OF THE DISCLOSURE STATEMENT HEARING; (B) APPROVING
DISCLOSURE STATEMENT; (C) AUTHORIZING THE OFFER AND SALE OF
VALEANT SHARES EXEMPT FROM REGISTRATION UNDER SECURITIES LAWS
PURSUANT TO BANKRUPTCY CODE SECTION 1145 AND PURSUANT TO
BANKRUPTCY CODE SECTION 1125(e) SAFE HARBOR; (D) SCHEDULING
HEARING ON CONFIRMATION OF PLAN; (E) ESTABLISHING DEADLINES AND
PROCEDURES FOR FILING OBJECTIONS TO CONFIRMATION OF PLAN; (F)
ESTABLISHING DEADLINES AND PROCEDURES FOR VOTING ON THE PLAN; (G) APPROVING SOLICITATION PROCEDURES; (H) ESTABLISHING PROCEDURES
FOR TABULATION OF VOTES; AND (I) GRANTING RELATED RELIEF
Upon the motion (the
Motion)2 of the debtors and debtors-in-possession in the above-captioned cases (collectively, the Debtors) for entry of an order, pursuant to sections 105, 1125, 1126, 1128 and 1145 of
title 11 of the United States Code, 11 U.S.C. §§101-1532 (the Bankruptcy Code), Rules 2002, 3003, 3017, 3018, 3020 and 9006 of the Federal Rules of Bankruptcy Procedure (the Bankruptcy Rules), and Rule
3017-1 of the Local Rules of
1 |
The Debtors and the last four digits of their respective taxpayer identification numbers are as follows: Dendreon Corporation (3193), Dendreon Holdings, LLC (8047), Dendreon Distribution, LLC (8598) and Dendreon
Manufacturing, LLC (7123). The address of the Debtors corporate headquarters is 601 Union Street, Suite 4900, Seattle, Washington 98101. |
2 |
Capitalized terms used but not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings set forth in the Motion.
|
Bankruptcy Practice and Procedure of the United States
Bankruptcy Court for the District of Delaware (the Local Rules), (a) approving the form and manner of notice of the hearing on the Disclosure Statement;
(b) approving the Disclosure Statement; (c) authorizing the offer and sale of the Valeant Shares exempt from registration under securities laws pursuant to Bankruptcy Code section 1145 and pursuant to Bankruptcy Code section 1125(e) safe
harbor; (d) scheduling a hearing on confirmation of plan; (e) establishing deadlines and procedures for filing objections to confirmation of plan; (f) establishing deadlines and procedures for voting on the plan (g) approving
solicitation procedures; (h) establishing procedures for tabulation of votes; and (i) granting related relief; and the Debtors having filed the First Amended Plan Of Liquidation Pursuant To Chapter 11 Of The Bankruptcy Code Proposed By The
Debtors [Docket No. 575] (as may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified, the Plan) and the Disclosure Statement With Respect to the First Amended Plan Of Liquidation Pursuant To Chapter 11 Of The Bankruptcy Code Proposed
By The Debtors [Docket No. 576] (the Disclosure Statement); and the Court having determined that (a) Valeant is a successor to the Debtors under the Plan for purposes of section 1145 of the Bankruptcy Code; (b) issuance
of the Valeant Shares is an inextricable part of the Plan; and (c) the issuance of the Valeant Shares pursuant to the Plan is exempt from the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of section 5 of the Securities Act, as amended, and
any state or local laws requiring registration for offer or sale of a security or registration or licensing of an issuer of, underwriter of, or broker dealer in, a security pursuant to and subject to the limitations in section 1145(a) of the
Bankruptcy Code; and this Court having jurisdiction to consider the Motion and the relief requested therein in accordance with 28 U.S.C. § 1334; and the relief requested therein being a core proceeding pursuant to 28 U.S.C. § 157(b); and
venue being proper in this District pursuant to 28 U.S.C. §§ 1408 and 1409; and due
2
and proper notice of the Motion having been provided; and it appearing that no other or
further notice need be provided; and all objections to the Disclosure Statement having been withdrawn or overruled for reasons stated on the record at the hearing to consider approval of the Disclosure Statement and on the Motion; and the Court
having determined that the relief sought in the Motion is in the best interests of the Debtors, their creditors and all other parties in interest; and this Court having determined that the legal and factual bases set forth in the Motion establish
just cause for the relief granted herein; and upon the proceedings had before this Court and after due deliberation and sufficient cause appearing therefore, it is hereby
ORDERED, ADJUDGED AND DECREED THAT:
1.
The Motion is GRANTED as set forth herein.
2.
The form of notice, attached hereto as Exhibit A-1 (the Disclosure Statement Hearing Notice) and the manner utilized by the Debtors to provide such notice of the Disclosure
Statement Hearing are hereby APPROVED in all respects pursuant to Bankruptcy Rules 3017(a) and 2002(b).
3.
The Disclosure Statement is hereby APPROVED in all respects pursuant to 11 U.S.C. § 1125 and Fed. R. Bankr. P. 3017(b).
4.
Exemption from Registration. Valeant is a successor to the Debtors under the Plan for purposes of section 1145 of the Bankruptcy Code. The offer and sale of the Valeant Shares pursuant to the Plan is exempt from the registration
requirements of the Securities Act and similar state and local statutes pursuant and subject to section 1145 of the Bankruptcy Code. The Debtors are hereby authorized to offer the Valeant Shares pursuant to the safe harbor contained in section
1125(e) of the Bankruptcy Code. The Valeant Shares may be resold by the holders thereof without restriction except to the extent that any such holder is deemed to be
(i) an
3
underwriter as defined in section 1145(b)(1) of the
Bankruptcy Code, (ii) an issuer or an affiliate of an issuer, or (iii) a dealer.
5. Confirmation Hearing Date. The hearing (the Confirmation Hearing) to consider confirmation of the Plan shall commence
on June 2, 2015 at 10:00 a.m. (Eastern Time) (the Confirmation Hearing Date), or as soon
thereafter as counsel can be heard before the Honorable Laurie Selber Silverstein, United States Bankruptcy Judge, United States Bankruptcy Court for the District of Delaware, 824 North Market Street, 6th Floor, Courtroom No. 2, Wilmington,
Delaware 19801. The Confirmation Hearing may be adjourned from time to time by way of announcement of such continuance in open court or otherwise, without further notice to parties in interest.
6. Deadline and Procedures for Filing Objections to Confirmation. The deadline for filing and serving objections to confirmation of the Plan
(the Plan Objection Deadline) shall be May 19, 2015 at 4:00 p.m. (Eastern Time). In order to be considered, objections, if any, to confirmation of the Plan must (a) be made in writing; (b) comply with the
Bankruptcy Code, the Bankruptcy Rules and the Local Rules; (c) state the name and address of the objecting party and the nature and amount of any claim or interest asserted by such party against the Debtors, their estates or property;
(d) state with particularity the legal and factual bases and nature of any objection to the Plan; (e) be filed with the Court, and served on the following, so as to be received on or before the Plan Objection Deadline:
(i) Debtors counsel, Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP, Four Times Square, New York, NY 10036, Attn: Ken Ziman, Esq., 155 N. Wacker Drive, Chicago, IL 60606, Attn: Felicia Perlman, Esq., and One Rodney Square, 920 N. King
Street, Wilmington, DE 19801, Attn: Sarah E. Pierce, Esq.; (ii) counsel to the Official Committee of Unsecured Creditors, Sullivan & Cromwell LLP, 125
4
Broad Street, New York, NY 10004, Attn: Michael H. Torkin, Esq. and Young Conaway
Stargatt & Taylor, LLP, Rodney Square, 1000 North King Street, Wilmington, DE 19801, Attn: Pauline K. Morgan, Esq.; (iii) counsel to the Unaffiliated Noteholders, Brown Rudnick LLP, One Financial Center, Boston, MA 02111, Attn: Steven
D. Pohl, Esq., Seven Times Square, New York, NY 10036, Attn: John Storz, Esq.; (iv) counsel to the Deerfield Noteholders, Willkie Farr & Gallagher LLP, 787 Seventh Avenue, New York, NY 10019, Attn: John C. Longmire, Esq.; and
(v) the Office of the United States Trustee, 844 King Street, Suite 2207, Lockbox 35, Wilmington, DE 19801, Attn: David Buchbinder, Esq. (collectively, the Notice Parties). Confirmation objections shall be filed and served so
as to be received by the Notice Parties no later than the Plan Objection Deadline.
7.
Objections to confirmation of the Plan not timely filed and served in accordance with the provisions of the prior paragraph shall not be considered by the Court and shall be overruled.
8. Record Date. The record date for purposes of determining (a) creditors and equity holders entitled to receive Solicitation Packages
and related materials, if any, and (b) creditors entitled to vote to accept or reject the Plan, as well as any such creditors corresponding claims, shall be April 7, 2015 (the Record Date).
9. Deadline and Procedures for Temporary Allowance of Claims for Voting Purposes. The deadline for filing and serving motions pursuant to
Bankruptcy Rule 3018(a) seeking temporary allowance of claims for the purpose of accepting or rejecting the Plan (Rule
5
3018(a) Motions) shall be May 12,
2015 at 4:00 p.m. (Eastern Time) (the Rule 3018(a) Motion Deadline).3
10. In order to be considered, Rule 3018(a) Motions must: (a) be made in writing;
(b) comply with the Bankruptcy Code, the Bankruptcy Rules and the Local Rules; (c) state the name and address of the party asserting the 3018(a) Motion; (d) state with particularity the legal and factual bases for the Rule 3018(a)
Motion; and (e) be filed with the Court, and served on the Notice Parties, so as to be received no later than the Rule 3018(a) Motion Deadline. Rule 3018(a) Motions not timely filed and served in accordance with the foregoing provision shall
not be considered by the Court and shall be overruled.
11. Any party timely filing and serving a Rule 3018(a) Motion shall be provided a Ballot (as defined
below) and shall be permitted to cast a provisional vote to accept or reject the Plan, pending a final determination by the Court. If, and to the extent that, the Debtors and such party are unable to resolve the issues raised by the Rule 3018(a)
Motion prior to the Confirmation Hearing, such Rule 3018(a) Motion shall be considered by the Court at the Confirmation Hearing, and the Court shall determine whether the provisional ballot should be counted as a vote on the Plan, and, if so, the
amount, if any, in which the party filing the Rule 3018(a) Motion will be entitled to vote.4
12.
Voting Deadline. To be counted, Ballots (including Master Ballots) for accepting or rejecting the Plan must be received by the Voting Agent by May 19, 2015 at 4:00 p.m. (Eastern Time) (the Voting
Deadline). The Debtors are hereby authorized to extend, in
3 |
If no objection to a claim has been filed by May 5, 2015, the holder of such claim is entitled to vote such claim in its Face Amount (as defined in the Plan). |
4 |
Claims will be determined for distribution purposes in accordance with the procedures set forth in the Plan.
|
6
their sole discretion, by oral or written notice to the Voting Agent, the period of time
during which Ballots will be accepted for any reason from any creditor or class of creditors.
13.
Treatment of Certain Unliquidated, Contingent or Disputed Claims for Voting and Distribution Purposes. Creditors whose claims are not scheduled or who hold claims that are scheduled as disputed, contingent or unliquidated
are required to timely file proofs of claim by the applicable Bar Date in order to be treated as creditors with respect to such claims for voting and distribution purposes. Non-Voting Claims shall mean claims which are not the subject of
a timely-filed proof of claim, or a proof of claim deemed timely filed with the Bankruptcy Court pursuant to either the Bankruptcy Code or other order of the Court, or otherwise deemed timely filed under applicable law and (a) are scheduled in
Debtors Schedules as disputed, contingent or unliquidated; or (b) are not scheduled. Creditors holding Non-Voting Claims shall be denied treatment as creditors with respect to such claims for purposes of (a) voting on the Plan and
(b) receiving distributions under the Plan.
14. Voting Procedures. For purposes of voting, the amount of a claim used to calculate
acceptance or rejection of the Plan under section 1126 of the Bankruptcy Code shall be determined in accordance with the following hierarchy:
|
(a) |
if an order has been entered by the Court determining the amount of such claim, whether pursuant to Bankruptcy Rule 3018 or otherwise, then in
the amount prescribed by the order; |
|
(b) |
if no such order has been entered, then in the liquidated amount contained in a timely-filed proof of claim that is not the subject of a
timely-filed objection; and |
|
(c) |
if no such proof of claim has been timely filed, then in the liquidated, noncontingent and undisputed amount contained in the Debtors
Schedules. |
15. For purposes of voting, the following conditions shall apply to determine the amount and/or classification of a claim:
7
|
(a) |
if a claim is partially liquidated and partially unliquidated, such claim shall be allowed for voting purposes only in the liquidated
amount; |
|
(b) |
if a scheduled or filed claim has been paid, such claim shall be disallowed for voting purposes;
and |
|
(c) |
the holder of a timely-filed proof of claim that is filed in a wholly unliquidated, contingent, disputed, and/or unknown amount, and is not the
subject of a timely-filed objection, is entitled to vote in the amount of $1.00. |
|
(d) |
claims filed for $0.00 are not entitled to vote. |
16.
Notice and Transmittal of Solicitation Packages Including Ballots and Non-Voting Packages. Within five (5) business days after the date an order approving the Disclosure Statement as containing adequate information is
entered by the Court, the Debtors shall mail or cause to be mailed by first-class mail to all of their known creditors, equity security holders as of the Record Date, the indenture trustee under the 2016 Notes, and all other entities required to be
served under Bankruptcy Rules 2002 and 3017, notice of, inter alia, the Confirmation Hearing substantially in the form attached hereto as Exhibit A-2 (the Confirmation Hearing Notice), which form is hereby
approved.
17. Non-Voting Packages. In addition, the Debtors shall mail or cause to be mailed by first-class mail to (a) holders of claims in Class
1 (Priority Non-Tax Claims), Class 2 (Secured Claims) and Class 8 (Intercompany Interests) under the Plan, which classes are unimpaired, are deemed to have accepted the Plan and are not entitled to vote, a copy of the Notice Of Non-Voting Status
With Respect To Unimpaired Classes, substantially in the form attached hereto as Exhibit B-1; and (b) holders of claims or interests in Class 5 (Intercompany Claims), Class 6 (Subordinated Claims) and Class 7 (Interests), which classes
are impaired, are deemed to have rejected the Plan and are not entitled to vote, a copy of the Notice of Non-Voting Status With Respect To Impaired Classes, substantially in the form attached hereto as Exhibit
B-
8
2. The Debtors shall also mail or cause to be mailed by first-class mail to holders of Non-Voting Claims, a copy of the Notice of Non-Voting Status with Respect to Certain Claims, substantially in
the form attached hereto as Exhibit B-3 (the Notice of Non-Voting Status with Respect to Certain Claims, the Notice Of Non-Voting Status With Respect To Unimpaired Classes and the Notice of Non-Voting Status With Respect To Impaired Classes,
each a Non-Voting Notice and, each Non-Voting Notice together with the Confirmation Hearing Notice, a Non-Voting Package); provided, however, that each Debtor with a Class 5 (Intercompany
Claim) and Class 8 (Intercompany Interest) will be deemed to have received the Non-Voting Package without actually mailing such Non-Voting Package to such Debtor. The Notice of Non-Voting Status With Respect To Unimpaired Classes, substantially in
the form of Exhibit B-1, the Notice of Non-Voting Status With Respect To Impaired Classes, substantially in the form of Exhibit B-2, and the Notice of Non-Voting Status with Respect to Certain Claims substantially in the form of
Exhibit B-3, are hereby approved. Further, the Non-Voting Packages are hereby deemed to constitute adequate alternative disclosure statements to impaired non-voting classes under 11 U.S.C. § 1125(c) and summary plans under Bankruptcy
Rule 3017(d).
18. Solicitation Packages. The Debtors shall mail or cause to be mailed by first-class mail to holders of claims in Class 3 (2016 Noteholders
Claims) and Class 4 (General Unsecured Claims) under the Plan, who are entitled to vote on the Plan, an information and solicitation package (the Solicitation Package). The Solicitation Package shall contain copies or conformed
printed versions of: (i) the Disclosure Statement, including a copy of the Plan as an Exhibit; (ii) a copy of the Order approving the Disclosure Statement (without exhibits) (the Solicitation Procedures Order);
(iii) the Confirmation Hearing Notice; and (iv) at the option of the Committee, a letter from the Committee setting forth its recommendations with respect to the
9
Plan. In addition, each Solicitation Package also shall contain one or more ballots (and a
pre-addressed, postage-prepaid return envelope) appropriate for the specific creditor, in substantially the forms of the proposed ballots collectively attached hereto as Exhibits C-1 through C-2 (as such ballots may be modified for particular
classes and with instructions attached to thereto, the Ballots), which forms of Ballots are hereby approved.
19.
The Debtors, at their discretion, may provide the Disclosure Statement, including the Plan as Exhibit A, and the Solicitation Procedures Order in the form of a CD-ROM in an Adobe Acrobat (PDF) standard format, rather than in
paper copies. Parties may submit a request to the Voting Agent (as defined below) if they prefer paper copies of the Disclosure Statement and Plan and all such requests shall be fulfilled promptly.5
20. Creditors holding (i) unclassified claims or unimpaired claims and also (ii) claims in
a class that is designated as impaired and entitled to vote under the Plan shall receive only the Solicitation Package appropriate for the applicable impaired class; and creditors who have filed duplicate claims in any given class (i) shall
receive only one Solicitation Package and one Ballot for voting in the amount of a single claim with respect to that class; and (ii) shall be entitled to vote their claim only once with respect to that class whether or not an objection is
pending with respect to such claim.
21. Procedures for Transmittal to Record Holders of Public Securities. The Solicitation
Package shall be mailed in accordance with the procedures outlined above to (a) each directly registered holder of the Debtors 2.875% Convertible Senior Notes with a maturity date of January 15, 2016 (the 2016
Notes) as of the Record Date, and (b) each broker,
5 |
The Disclosure Statement and Plan and all other documents filed in these Chapter 11 Cases are available free of charge on the Debtors case website at https://cases.primeclerk.com/dendreon/. |
10
commercial bank, transfer agent, trust company, dealer or other intermediary or nominee,
or their mailing agent thereof (each a Nominee) identified by the Debtors Voting Agent as an entity through which beneficial holders indirectly hold the 2016 Notes. The Debtors are authorized to send Solicitation Packages to
Nominees in paper and/or via electronic transmission in accordance with customary requirements of each Nominee.
22.
Labels for Record Holders. The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., as indenture trustee for the 2016 Notes shall, at the request of the Debtors, timely cooperate in providing the Voting Agent with the names,
addresses, account numbers and holdings of the respective directly registered holders as of the Record Date, in an electronic file or disk, or confirming that there are no directly registered holders as of the Record Date other than Cede &
Co., as nominee for the Depository Trust Company (DTC).
23.
Dissemination to Beneficial Holders. The Nominees through which beneficial holders hold 2016 Notes shall promptly distribute Solicitation Packages to such holders, and cooperate with the Voting Agent to accomplish such
distribution, in any case no later than five (5) business days after receipt by the Nominees of the Solicitation Packages.
24.
Voting By Beneficial Holders of 2016 Notes. Nominees shall obtain the votes of beneficial holders of 2016 Notes by forwarding the Solicitation Package to each beneficial holder of the 2016 Notes for whom it acts as a Nominee
for voting so that the beneficial holder may return its vote directly to its Nominee. The Voting Agent shall send Solicitation Packages in paper format or via electronic transmission in accordance with the customary requirements of each Nominee.
Each Nominee shall then distribute the Solicitation Packages, as appropriate, in accordance with their customary practices and obtain votes to accept or reject the Plan also in accordance with their customary practices. If it is the
Nominees
11
customary and accepted practice to submit a voting instruction form to the
beneficial holders for the purpose of recording the beneficial holders vote, the Nominee is authorized to send the voting instruction form; provided, however, that the Nominee also distribute to the beneficial holder the appropriate Beneficial
Holder Ballot approved by this Order. Nominees shall summarize the individual votes of their respective beneficial holders cast on their Beneficial Holder Ballots on a master Ballot, in substantially the form of the Master Ballot attached hereto as
Exhibit C-3 (each, a Master Ballot, and, together, the Master Ballots), as applicable, and then return the Master Ballot to the Voting Agent. The Master Ballot substantially in the form attached hereto as
Exhibit C-3 is hereby approved. The Master Ballots shall be distributed to Nominees approximately seven calendar days after the initial distribution of the Solicitation Packages to the Nominees.
25. The Debtors are authorized to reimburse such Nominees for their reasonable, actual and necessary out-of-pocket expenses incurred in performing
the tasks described above upon written request by such entities, with supporting documentation (subject to this Court retaining jurisdiction to resolve any disputes regarding any request for reimbursement).
26. When No Notice or Transmittal Necessary. Notwithstanding any provision of this Order to the contrary, no notice or service of any kind
shall be required to be made upon any person to whom the Debtors mailed a notice of the meeting of creditors under section 341 of the Bankruptcy Code or notice of the bar date for filing proofs of claim and received either of such notices returned
by the United States Postal Service marked undeliverable as addressed, moved left no forwarding address, forwarding order expired or similar marking or reason, unless the Debtors have been informed in
writing by such person of that persons new address.
12
27. The Debtors shall not re-mail undelivered Solicitation Packages or other undeliverable solicitation-related notices that were returned marked
undeliverable as addressed, moved left no forwarding address, forwarding order expired or similar marking or reason, unless the Debtors have been informed in writing by such person of that persons new
address.
28. Publication Notice. The Debtors shall publish notice of the Confirmation Hearing, substantially in the form attached hereto as Exhibit D, once within five (5) business days
after the entry of the Solicitation Procedures Order in the national and global edition of The Wall Street Journal, USA Today, The New York Times or The Financial Times.
29. Voting Agent. In connection with the solicitation of votes with respect to the plan, Prime Clerk LLC (Prime Clerk) shall serve as voting agent for all creditors entitled
to vote on the plan (the Voting Agent). The Voting Agent is authorized and directed to assist the Debtors in (a) mailing the Solicitation Packages and other notices, (b) soliciting votes on the Plan, (c) receiving
and tabulating Ballots cast on the Plan, (d) certifying to the Court the results of the balloting, and (e) responding to inquiries from creditors relating to the Plan, the Disclosure Statement, the Ballots and matters related thereto.
Ballots not received by the Voting Agent shall be deemed invalid and shall not be counted.
30. Procedures for Vote Tabulation; Votes Counted. Any Ballot or Master Ballot, as appropriate, that is properly executed and timely received, and that is cast as either an acceptance or
rejection of the Plan, shall be counted and shall be deemed to be cast as an acceptance or rejection, as the case may be, of the Plan. The failure of a holder of a claim in Classes 3 or 4 to timely deliver an executed Ballot shall be deemed to
constitute an abstention by
13
such holder with respect to voting on the Plan, and such abstention will not be counted as
a vote for or against the Plan.
31. For purposes of voting, classification and treatment under the Plan, at the election of the
Debtors, (i) each holder of a claim that holds or has filed more than one non-duplicative claim against one or more of the Debtors in an impaired class shall be treated as if such holder has only one claim for the applicable class;
(ii) the claims filed by such holder shall be aggregated in each applicable class; and (iii) the total dollar amount of such holders claims in each applicable class against each Debtor shall be the sum of the aggregated claims of
such holder against those Debtors in each applicable class.
32.
Each record holder or beneficial holder of 2016 Notes shall be deemed to have voted the full principal amount of its claim relating to such 2016 Notes, as of the Record Date, notwithstanding anything to the contrary on the
Ballot.
33. For purposes of the Record Date, no transfer of claims pursuant to Bankruptcy Rule 3001 shall be recognized unless either
(i) (a) documentation evidencing such transfer was filed with the Court on or before twenty-one (21) days prior to the Record Date and (b) no timely objection with respect to such transfer was filed by the transferor; or
(ii) the parties to such transfer waived the twenty-one (21) day period in the evidence of transfer and the evidence of transfer was docketed prior to the Record
Date.
34. Procedures for Vote Tabulation, Votes Not Counted. Unless otherwise ordered by the Court after notice and a hearing, the following Ballots
or Master Ballots shall not be counted or considered for any purpose in determining whether the Plan has been accepted or rejected:
|
(a) |
any Ballot or Master Ballot received after the Voting Deadline (as extended by the Debtors as provided herein); |
14
|
(b) |
any Ballot or Master Ballot that is illegible or contains insufficient information to permit the identification of the claimant; |
|
(c) |
any Ballot cast by a person or entity that does not hold a claim in a class that is entitled to vote to accept or reject the Plan; |
|
(d) |
any Ballot cast for a scheduled claim designated as contingent, unliquidated or disputed or as zero or unknown in amount and for which no Rule
3018(a) Motion has been filed by the Rule 3018(a) Motion Deadline; |
|
(e) |
any Ballot that indicates neither an acceptance nor a rejection, or indicates both an acceptance or rejection, of the Plan; |
|
(f) |
any Ballot (other than a Master Ballot) that casts part of its vote in the same class to accept the Plan and part to reject the
Plan; |
|
(g) |
any form of Ballot or Master Ballot other than the official form sent by the Voting Agent, or a copy thereof; |
|
(h) |
any Ballot received that the Voting Agent cannot match to an existing database record;
|
|
(i) |
any Ballot or Master Ballot that does not contain an original signature; or
|
|
(j) |
any Ballot or Master Ballot that is submitted by facsimile, email or by other electronic means.
|
35.
The following procedures and general assumptions shall govern tabulation of the Ballots:
|
(a) |
Any creditor who has filed or purchased duplicate claims within the same class shall be provided with only one Solicitation Package and one
ballot for voting a single claim in such class, regardless of whether the Debtors have objected to such duplicate claim; |
|
(b) |
Ballots postmarked prior to the Voting Deadline, but received after the Voting Deadline, shall not be counted; |
|
(c) |
If a creditor simultaneously casts inconsistent duplicate ballots with respect to the same claim, such ballots cannot be counted; |
|
(d) |
The Debtors, in their discretion, may waive any defect in any Ballot. |
15
36. Neither the Debtors, the Voting Agent nor any other person or entity shall be under any duty to provide notification of defects or irregularities
with respect to delivered Ballots. Rather, the Voting Agent may either disregard, with no further notice, defective Ballots, or it may attempt to have defective Ballots cured.
37.
Withdrawal of Vote. Any party who has delivered a valid Ballot for the acceptance or rejection of the Plan may withdraw, subject to the Debtors right to contest the validity of such withdrawal, such acceptance or
rejection by delivering a written notice of withdrawal to the Voting Agent at any time prior to the Voting Deadline. A notice of withdrawal, to be valid, shall (a) contain the description of the claim(s) to which it relates and the aggregate
principal amount represented by such claim(s), (b) be signed by the withdrawing party in the same manner as the Ballot being withdrawn, (c) contain a certification that the withdrawing party owns the claim(s) and possesses the right to
withdraw the Ballot sought to be withdrawn, and (d) be timely received by the Voting Agent prior to the Voting Deadline.
38.
Changing Votes. Notwithstanding Bankruptcy Rule 3018(a), whenever two or more Ballots or Master Ballots are cast voting the same claim(s) prior to the Voting Deadline, the last valid Ballot or Master Ballot received prior to
the Voting Deadline shall be deemed to reflect the voters intent and thus supersede any prior Ballots or Master Ballots, as the case may be, without prejudice to the Debtors right to object to the validity of the later Ballot or Master
Ballot on any basis permitted by law, including under Bankruptcy Rule 3018(a), and, if the objection is sustained, to count the first dated Ballot or Master Ballot for all purposes.
39. No Division of Claims or Votes. Except as it may relate to the procedures implemented with respect to the Master Ballots, (a) a
creditor who votes must vote the full amount of each claim voted either to accept or reject the Plan; and (b) each creditor who votes
16
and holds multiple claims within a particular class must vote all such claims to either
accept or reject the Plan. The Ballots of creditors failing to vote in the manner specified in this paragraph shall not be counted for any purpose.
40.
Procedures for Counting Ballots from Holders of 2016 Notes. Nominees through which beneficial holders hold 2016 Notes shall receive and summarize on a Master Ballot all beneficial holder Ballots cast by the beneficial
holders they serve and then return the Master Ballot to the Voting Agent on or before the Voting Deadline.
41.
Nominees shall be required to retain for inspection by the Court for one (1) year following the Voting Deadline the Ballots cast by their beneficial holders.
42. Nominees may elect to pre-validate the Beneficial Holder Ballot (a Pre-Validated Ballot) by (i) signing the applicable
Beneficial Holder Ballot and including its DTC Participant Number, (ii) indicating on the Beneficial Holder Ballot the account number of such holder, and the principal amount of 2016 Notes held by the Nominee for such beneficial holder, and
(iii) forwarding the Beneficial Holder Ballot (together with the full Solicitation Package) to the beneficial holder for voting. The beneficial holder must then complete the information requested in the Beneficial Holder Ballot (including
indicating a vote to accept or reject the Plan), review the certifications contained therein, and return the Beneficial Holder Ballot directly to the Voting Agent in the pre-addressed, postage paid envelope included with the Solicitation Package so
that it is actually received by the Voting Agent on or before the Voting Deadline. A list of beneficial holders to whom the Nominee sent Pre-Validated Ballots shall be maintained by the Nominee for inspection for at least one year following the
Voting Deadline.
43. Votes cast by the beneficial holders through a Nominee and transmitted by means of a Master
Ballot or a Pre-Validated Ballot shall be applied against the positions held by
17
such Nominees as evidenced by the list of record holders of the 2016 Notes or provided by
the applicable securities depository. Votes submitted by a Nominee on a Master Ballot shall not be counted in excess of the position maintained by the respective Nominee on the Record Date.
44. To the extent that conflicting, double or over-votes are submitted on Master Ballots, the Voting Agent shall attempt to resolve such votes prior
to the vote certification in order to ensure that the votes of beneficial holders of 2016 Notes are accurately tabulated. Further, to the extent that such conflicting, double or over-votes are not reconciled prior to the vote certification, the
Voting Agent shall count votes in respect of each Master Ballot in the same proportion as the votes of the beneficial holders or entitlement holders to accept or reject the Plan submitted on such Master Ballot, but only to the extent of the
applicable Nominees position on the Record Date in the 2016 Notes.
45.
For the purposes of tabulating votes, each beneficial holder shall be deemed (regardless of whether such holder includes interest in the amount voted on its Ballot) to have voted only the principal amount of its public securities;
any principal amounts thus voted may be thereafter adjusted by the Voting Agent, on a proportionate basis to reflect the corresponding claim amount, including any accrued but unpaid prepetition interest, with respect to the securities thus
voted.
46. Nominees are authorized to complete multiple Master Ballots, and the votes reflected by such multiple Master Ballots should be counted, except to
the extent that they are duplicative of the other Master Ballots. If two or more Master Ballots submitted are inconsistent in whole or in part, the last valid Master Ballot received prior to the Voting Deadline will, to the extent of such
inconsistency, supersede and revoke any prior Master Ballot, subject to the Debtors rights to object to the validity of any subsequently-received Master Ballot on any
18
basis permitted by law, including Bankruptcy Rule 3018(a) and, if such objection is
sustained, the prior Master Ballot then shall be counted.
47.
Classes Deemed to Reject. The holders of claims in Classes 5, 6, 7, and 8 shall be deemed to have rejected the Plan, and the Debtors are not required to solicit votes on the Plan from such holders.
48. Voting Classes; Deemed Acceptance by Non-Voting Classes. If a class contains claims or interests eligible to vote and no holders of claims
or interests eligible to vote in such class vote to accept or reject the Plan, the Plan will be deemed accepted by the holders of such claims or interests in such class.
49.
Certification of Vote. The Voting Agent shall file its voting certification (the Voting Certification) on or before May 26, 2015. The Debtors shall serve such Voting Certification on all
parties having requested notice in the Chapter 11 Cases pursuant to Bankruptcy Rule 2002, and post such Voting Certification on the Debtors case website as soon as practicable after the Voting Certification is filed.
50. Service and Notice Adequate and Sufficient. Service of all notices and documents described herein in the time and manner set forth herein
shall constitute due, adequate and sufficient notice, and no other or further notice shall be necessary.
51.
The Debtors are authorized to make nonsubstantive changes to the Disclosure Statement, the Plan, Ballots, Master Ballot and related documents without further order of the Court, including without limitation, changes to correct
typographical and grammatical errors and to make conforming changes among the Disclosure Statement, the Plan and any other related materials prior to their mailing to parties in interest.
19
52. The Court shall retain jurisdiction to implement, interpret and effectuate the provisions of this Order.
Dated: |
Wilmington, Delaware |
April 14, 2015
|
|
/s/ Laurie Selber Silverstein |
Honorable Laurie Selber Silverstein United
States Bankruptcy Judge |
20